Suzuki Automobile 2010 SX4 User Manual

Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This owner’s manual applies to the SX4 series:  
SX4  
SX4 SEDAN  
80J2059  
NOTE: The illustrated models are examples of the SX4 series.  
© 2009  
All rights reserved.  
No part of this document may be reproduced or transmitted in any form or by any means, electronic or  
mechanical, for any purpose, without the express written permission of Suzuki Motor Corporation.  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IF YOU HAVE ANY PROBLEMS WITH  
YOUR SUZUKI:  
If you purchased your SUZUKI in Canada  
please contact the Suzuki Canada Cus-  
tomer Relations Department by telephone  
at 1-905-889-2677 extension 2254 or in  
writing at:  
FOREWORD  
Please review the New Vehicle Warranty  
Information booklet supplied with your  
SUZUKI. Should you have a question or  
problem regarding the warranty or service  
of your vehicle, please take the following  
action:  
All information in this manual is based  
on the latest product information avail-  
able at the time of publication. Due to  
improvements or other changes, there  
may be discrepancies between informa-  
tion in this manual and your vehicle.  
Suzuki Canada Inc.  
Customer Relations  
100 East Beaver Creek Road  
Richmond Hill, On  
L4B 1J6  
Consult the Service Manager and the  
Owner of the Suzuki Automotive Dealer-  
ship. Explain your problem and ask for  
their assistance in resolving your problem.  
The Owner of the dealership is in the very  
best position to assist you as he or she is  
vitally concerned with your continued satis-  
faction.  
SUZUKI  
MOTOR  
CORPORATION  
reserves the right to make production  
changes at any time, without notice and  
without incurring any obligation to  
make the same or similar changes to  
vehicles previously built or sold.  
In the event you require assistance related  
to your SUZUKI, while temporarily travel-  
ling in either the United States or Canada,  
you may wish to contact the Suzuki Cus-  
tomer Relations Department directly of the  
country in which you are temporarily oper-  
ating your vehicle.  
If you are still in need of additional informa-  
tion, or if you are dissatisfied, request that  
your dealer arrange a meeting with your  
District Service Manager.  
SUZUKI  
MOTOR  
CORPORATION  
Please be certain to provide us with the fol-  
lowing information: the model, Vehicle  
Identification Number, mileage, accesso-  
ries involved, event dates, your concern,  
and any other comments which you may  
have. When we receive your correspon-  
dence, we will be pleased to contact the  
Owner of your dealership and assist in  
resolving your concern.  
believes in conservation and protection of  
Earth’s natural resources.  
To that end, we encourage every vehicle  
owner to recycle, trade in, or properly dis-  
pose of, as appropriate, used motor oil,  
coolant, and other fluids, batteries and  
tires.  
If, after doing so, you still require further  
assistance, and you purchased your  
SUZUKI in the continental United States,  
please contact the American Suzuki Cus-  
tomer Relations Department by telephone  
at 1-800-934-0934 or in writing at:  
For owners outside the continental United  
States, please refer to the distributor’s  
address listed in your Warranty Information  
booklet.  
American Suzuki Motor Corporation  
Automotive Customer Relations  
3251 East Imperial Highway  
Brea, CA 92821-6795  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
IMPORTANT  
MODIFICATION WARNING  
WARNING/CAUTION/NOTE  
Please read this manual and follow its  
instructions carefully. To emphasize spe-  
cial information, the symbol  
words WARNING, CAUTION and NOTE  
have special meanings. Pay special atten-  
tion to the messages highlighted by these  
signal words:  
WARNING  
Do not modify this vehicle. Modifica-  
tion could adversely affect safety,  
handling, performance or durability  
and may violate governmental regula-  
tions. In addition, damage or perfor-  
mance problems resulting from  
modification may not be covered  
under warranty.  
and the  
WARNING  
Indicates  
a
potential hazard that  
could result in death or injury.  
75F135  
CAUTION  
The circle with a slash in this manual  
means “Don’t do this” or “Don’t let this hap-  
pen”.  
Improper installation of mobile com-  
munication equipment such as cellu-  
lar telephones or CB (Citizen’s Band)  
radios may cause electronic interfer-  
ence with your vehicle’s ignition sys-  
tem, resulting in vehicle performance  
problems. Consult your SUZUKI  
dealer or qualified service technician  
for advice on installing such mobile  
communication equipment.  
CAUTION  
Indicates  
a
potential hazard that  
could result in vehicle damage.  
NOTE:  
Indicates special information to make  
maintenance easier or instructions clearer.  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
LEAK DETECTION PUMP  
NOTE:  
Your vehicle has a pump to regularly check  
the vehicle’s evaporative emission control  
system for leaks. This check is performed  
approximately five hours after the engine is  
turned off. During this leak check, you may  
hear a sound coming from the vehicle for  
several minutes. This sound is normal and  
does not indicate a malfunction.  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
MEMO  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INTRODUCTION  
Thank you for choosing SUZUKI and welcome to our growing family. Your choice was a wise one; SUZUKI products are a great value  
that will give you years of driving pleasure.  
This Owner’s Manual was prepared to help you have a safe, enjoyable, and trouble-free experience with your SUZUKI. In it you will learn  
about the vehicle’s operation, its safety features and maintenance requirements. Please read it carefully before operating your vehicle.  
Afterwards, keep this Manual in the glove box for future reference.  
Should you resell the vehicle, please leave this Manual with it for the next owner.  
In addition to the Owner’s Manual, the other booklets provided with your SUZUKI explain the vehicle’s warranties. We recommend you  
read them as well to familiarize yourself with this important information.  
When planning the regular scheduled maintenance of your SUZUKI, we recommend you visit your local SUZUKI dealership. Their fac-  
tory-trained technicians will provide the best possible service and use only genuine SUZUKI parts and accessories.  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SERVICE STATION GUIDE  
1. Fuel (see section 1)  
2. Engine hood (see section 5)  
3. Tire changing tools (see section 8)  
4. Engine oil dipstick <Yellow>  
(see section 7)  
5. CVT fluid dipstick <Red or Orange>  
(see section 7)  
6. Engine coolant (see section 7)  
7. Windshield washer fluid  
(see section 7)  
7
8. Battery (see section 7)  
9. Tire pressure (see Tire Information  
Label on driver’s door lock pillar)  
10. Spare tire (see section 7)  
3
4
2
10  
6
5
8
2
1
9
80J2007  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TABLE OF CONTENTS  
FUEL RECOMMENDATION  
BEFORE DRIVING  
1
California Proposition 65 Warning  
2
WARNING  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
DRIVING TIPS  
3
Engine exhaust, some of its constitu-  
ents, and certain product compo-  
nents contain or emit chemicals  
known to the State of California to  
cause cancer and birth defects or  
other reproductive harm.  
4
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
EMERGENCY SERVICE  
APPEARANCE CARE  
5
6
7
8
9
GENERAL INFORMATION  
FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS  
SPECIFICATIONS  
10  
11  
12  
13  
INDEX  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ILLUSTRATED TABLE OF CONTENTS  
EXTERIOR  
SX4  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1. Rear Window Wiper (if equipped)  
(P.2-80)  
2. High-mount Stop Light (if equipped)  
(P.7-45)  
3. Radio Antenna (P.5-15)  
4. Engine Hood (P.5-44)  
5. Head Light (P2-75, P7-41)  
6. Windshield Wiper (P.2-78)  
7. Roof Rail (if equipped) (P.5-55)  
8. Fuel Filler Cap (P.5-43)  
9. License Plate Light (P.7-44)  
10. Tailgate (if equipped) (P.2-3)  
11. Rear Combination Light (P.7-43)  
12. Front Fog Light (if equipped)  
(P.2-77, 7-42)  
9
10  
11  
12  
13 14  
13. Outside Rearview Mirror (P.2-20)  
14. Door Locks (P.2-1)  
15. Trunk (if equipped) (P.2-4)  
SX4 SEDAN  
3
15  
EXAMPLE  
80J2058  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ILLUSTRATED TABLE OF CONTENTS  
INTERIOR  
EXAMPLE  
1. Seat Belts (P.2-28)  
2. Side Curtain Air Bags (if equipped)  
(P.2-50)  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
3. Interior Light (P.5-45, 7-40)  
4. Assist Grip (if equipped) (P.5-48)  
5. Power Mirror Control Switch  
(if equipped) (P.2-20)/  
Power Window Controls (P.2-17)  
6. Sun Visor (P.5-45)  
7. Spot Light (P.5-47, 7-40)  
8. Inside Rearview Mirror (P.2-19)  
9. Luggage Compartment Light  
(if equipped) (P.5-46, 7-45)  
10. Luggage Compartment Cover  
(if equipped) (P.5-52)  
11. Rear Seat (P.2-24)  
12. Side Air Bags (if equipped) (P.2-50)  
13. Armrest (if equipped) (P. 5-51)  
14. Parking Brake Lever (P.3-6)  
15. Front Seats (P.2-21)  
16. Gearshift Lever (P.3-10)  
9
10  
11  
12  
13 14 15  
16  
80J2062  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ILLUSTRATED TABLE OF CONTENTS  
INSTRUMENT PANEL  
EXAMPLE  
1. Lighting Control Lever (P.2-75)/  
Turn Signal Control Lever (P.2-77)  
2. Shift Paddles (if equipped) (P.3-14)  
3. Front Air Bags (P.2-49)  
4. Instrument Cluster (P.2-59)  
5. Windshield Wiper and Washer Lever  
(P.2-78)/Rear Window Wiper and  
Washer Switch (if equipped) (P.2-80)  
6. Hazard Warning Switch (P.2-78)  
7. Audio (P.5-15)  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
3
8. Front Fog Light Switch (if equipped)  
(P.2-77)  
9. Fuse Box (P.7-36)  
10. Engine Hood Release Handle  
(P.5-44)  
11. Remote Audio Controls (if equipped)  
(P.5-37)  
12. Ignition Switch (P.3-2)  
13. Cruise Control Switch (if equipped)  
(P.3-18)  
8
9
10 11  
12  
13  
14  
18  
15  
16  
17  
14. Heating and Air Conditioning System  
(P.5-1)  
15. Accessory Socket (if equipped)  
(P.5-47)/Cigarette Lighter  
(if equipped) (P.5-47)  
16. Heated Rear Window and Heated  
Outside Rearview Mirrors Switch  
(if equipped) (P.2-81)  
17. Glove Box (P.5-49)  
18. ESP OFF Switch (if equipped)  
(P.3-26)  
19. 2WD/i-AWD (intelligent All Wheel  
Drive) Switch (if equipped) (P.3-16)  
20. Front Seat Heater Switch  
(if equipped) (P.2-23)  
19  
20  
20  
80J2074  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ILLUSTRATED TABLE OF CONTENTS  
TIRE CHANGING TOOL  
SX4  
1
2
1. Jack Handle (P.8-1)  
2. Wheel Brace (P.8-1)  
3. Spare Tire (P.7-31, 8-1)  
4. Jack (P.8-1)  
3
4
1
SX4 SEDAN  
2
3
4
EXAMPLE  
80JM121  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
LOCATION OF WARNING  
MESSAGES  
11  
12  
Read and follow all of the warnings (labels  
etc.) on your vehicle. Make sure you  
understand all of them. Keep them on the  
vehicle. Do not remove the messages for  
any reason. If a label comes off or the  
messages become difficult to be read,  
have it corrected by your SUZUKI dealer.  
1
9
Driver  
Passenger  
1. Air bag warning labels  
(on both sun visors)  
2. Jacking warning label  
3
3. Fuel filler cap message  
4. Brake fluid cap message  
5. Engine cooling fan warning label  
6. Radiator cap warning label  
7. Air conditioner warning label  
8. Battery label  
10  
10  
7
9. Compact spare tire warning label  
10. Side air bag warning label  
11. Luggage compartment cover warning  
label  
10  
8
12. Jacking instruction warning label  
4
2
6
5
80J2075  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUEL RECOMMENDATION  
FUEL RECOMMENDATION  
1
Fuel Recommendation ........................................................ 1-1  
65D394  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuel Recommendation: 1, 2  
FUEL RECOMMENDATION  
Gasoline Containing MTBE  
Fuel Pump Labeling  
Fuel Recommendation  
Unleaded gasoline containing MTBE  
(methyl tertiary butyl ether) may be used in  
your vehicle if the MTBE content is not  
greater than 15%. This oxygenated fuel  
does not contain alcohol.  
In some states, pumps that dispense oxy-  
genated fuels are required to be labeled for  
the type and percentage of oxygenate and  
whether important additives are present.  
Such labels may provide enough informa-  
tion for you to determine if a particular  
blend of fuel meets the requirements listed  
above. In other areas, pumps may not be  
clearly labeled as to the content or type of  
oxygenate and additives. If you are not  
sure that the fuel you intend to use meets  
these requirements, check with the service  
station operator or the fuel supplier.  
Gasoline/Ethanol blends  
Blends of unleaded gasoline and ethanol  
(grain alcohol), also known as gasohol,  
may be used in your vehicle if the ethanol  
content is not greater than 10%.  
Gasoline/Methanol blends  
Fuels containing 5% or less methanol  
(wood alcohol) may be suitable for use in  
your vehicle if they contain cosolvents and  
corrosion inhibitors. Do NOT USE fuels  
containing more than 5% methanol under  
any circumstances. Fuel system damage  
or vehicle performance problems resulting  
from the use of such fuels are not the  
responsibility of SUZUKI and may not be  
covered under the New Vehicle Limited  
Warranty.  
NOTE:  
60A004  
To help clean the air, SUZUKI recom-  
mends you use the oxygenated fuels.  
However, if you are not satisfied with the  
driveability or fuel economy of your vehicle  
when you are using an oxygenated fuel,  
switch back to the regular unleaded gaso-  
line.  
Your vehicle requires regular unleaded  
gasoline with a minimum rating of 87 pump  
octane ((R + M)/2 method). In some areas,  
the only fuels that are available are oxy-  
genated fuels.  
Oxygenated fuels which meet the mini-  
mum octane requirement and the require-  
ments described below may be used in  
your vehicle without jeopardizing the New  
Vehicle Limited Warranty.  
CAUTION  
Be careful not to spill fuel containing  
alcohol while refueling. If fuel is  
spilled on the vehicle body, wipe it up  
immediately. Fuels containing alco-  
hol can cause paint damage, which is  
not covered under the New Vehicle  
Limited Warranty.  
NOTE:  
Oxygenated fuels are fuels which contain  
oxygen-carrying additives such as MTBE  
or alcohol.  
1-1  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Keys ...................................................................................... 2-1  
Door Locks .......................................................................... 2-1  
Keyless Start System Remote Controller/  
2
Keyless Entry System Transmitter .................................... 2-6  
Theft Deterrent Light ........................................................... 2-17  
Windows .............................................................................. 2-17  
Mirrors .................................................................................. 2-19  
Front Seats .......................................................................... 2-21  
Front Seat Heater (if equipped) .......................................... 2-23  
Rear Seats ............................................................................ 2-24  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems ........................... 2-28  
Supplemental Restraint System (air bags) ....................... 2-47  
Instrument Cluster .............................................................. 2-59  
Warning and Indicator Lights ............................................ 2-60  
Speedometer ....................................................................... 2-68  
Tachometer .......................................................................... 2-69  
Fuel Gauge ........................................................................... 2-69  
Temperature Gauge ............................................................ 2-70  
Information display ............................................................. 2-70  
Lighting Control Lever ........................................................ 2-75  
Front Fog Light Switch (if equipped) ................................ 2-77  
Turn Signal Control Lever .................................................. 2-77  
Hazard Warning Switch ...................................................... 2-78  
Windshield Wiper and Washer Lever ................................ 2-78  
Tilt Steering Lock Lever (if equipped) ............................... 2-81  
Horn ...................................................................................... 2-81  
Heated Rear Window and Heated Outside Rearview  
60G404  
Mirrors (if equipped) Switch ............................................... 2-81  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys: 8  
Door Locks: 3, 5, 8  
BEFORE DRIVING  
To unlock a front door from outside the  
vehicle, insert the key and turn the top of  
the key toward the front of the vehicle.  
Keys  
Door Locks  
WARNING  
EXAMPLE  
Always lock all doors when driving.  
Locking the doors helps to prevent  
occupants from being thrown from  
the vehicle in the event of an acci-  
dent. It also helps prevent unin-  
tended opening of the doors.  
EXAMPLE  
UNLOCK  
LOCK  
Side Door Locks  
LOCK  
54G489  
UNLOCK  
Your vehicle comes with a pair of identical  
keys. Keep the spare key in a safe place.  
One key can open all of the locks on the  
vehicle.  
79J021  
To lock a door from inside the vehicle, turn  
the lock knob forward. Turn the lock knob  
rearward to unlock the door.  
Rear  
The key identification number is stamped  
on a metal tag provided with the keys.  
Keep the tag in a safe place. If you lose  
your keys, you will need this number to  
have new keys made. Write the number  
below for your future reference.  
To lock a rear door from outside the vehi-  
cle, turn the lock knob forward and close  
the door. You do not need to pull and hold  
the door handle as you close the door.  
Front  
60A009  
To lock a front door from outside the vehi-  
cle:  
KEY NUMBER:  
• Insert the key and turn the top of the key  
toward the rear of the vehicle, or  
Turn the lock knob forward, then pull and  
hold the door handle as you close the  
door.  
Ignition Key Reminder  
A buzzer sounds to remind you to remove  
the ignition key if it is in the ignition switch  
when the driver’s door is opened.  
2-1  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Door Locks: 3, 5, 8  
BEFORE DRIVING  
To unlock all the doors simultaneously,  
insert the key in a front door lock and turn  
the top of the key toward the front of the  
vehicle twice.  
Front passenger’s side  
EXAMPLE  
Power Door Locking System  
You can lock and unlock all the doors  
(including the tailgate of SX4) simulta-  
neously by:  
Turning the key in a front door lock, or  
• Pushing the power door locking switch  
located on the driver’s side or the front  
passenger’s side door panel.  
To unlock only one of the front doors, insert  
the key in that door lock and turn the top of  
the key toward the front of the vehicle  
once.  
Driver’s side  
EXAMPLE  
LOCK  
UNLOCK  
(2)  
80JC092  
Rear  
(when using the power door locking  
switch)  
To lock or unlock all the doors simulta-  
neously, depress the front or rear of the  
switch (1) or (2), respectively.  
UNLOCK  
LOCK  
(1)  
Front  
54G294  
(when using the key)  
To lock all the doors simultaneously, insert  
the key in a front door lock and turn the top  
of the key toward the rear of the vehicle  
once.  
80JC091  
2-2  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Door Locks: 3, 5, 8  
BEFORE DRIVING  
NOTE:  
Child Lock System (rear doors)  
EXAMPLE  
Tailgate (SX4)  
EXAMPLE  
• If your vehicle is equipped with the key-  
less entry system, you can also lock or  
unlock all doors by operating the remote  
controller/transmitter. Refer to “Keyless  
Start System Remote Controller/Key-  
less Entry System Transmitter” in this  
section.  
(2)  
• If your vehicle is equipped with the key-  
less start system, you can also lock or  
unlock all doors by pushing the request  
switch on the door handle. Refer to “Key-  
less Start System Remote Controller/  
Keyless Entry System Transmitter” in  
this section.  
(1)  
(1)  
80JM019  
80JC059  
(1) LOCK  
(2) UNLOCK  
(1) Tailgate unlatch switch  
You can lock and unlock the tailgate by  
using the key in the driver’s door lock.  
Each of the rear doors is equipped with a  
child lock which can be used to help pre-  
vent unwanted opening of the door from  
inside the vehicle. When the lock lever is in  
the “LOCK” position (1), the rear door can  
only be opened from outside. When the  
lock lever is in the “UNLOCK” position (2),  
the rear door can be opened from inside or  
outside.  
To open the tailgate, push and hold the tail-  
gate unlatch switch (1) and lift the tailgate.  
NOTE:  
When the tailgate is closed incompletely,  
follow the procedure below:  
1) Push the tailgate unlatch switch (1) and  
open the tailgate a little.  
2) After a few seconds, close the tailgate.  
3) Make sure that the tailgate is closed  
completely.  
WARNING  
Be sure to place the child lock in the  
“LOCK” position whenever children  
are seated in the rear.  
2-3  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Door Locks: 3, 5, 8  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Trunk Lid (SX4 SEDAN)  
WARNING  
Always make sure that the tailgate is  
closed and latched securely. Com-  
pletely closing the tailgate helps pre-  
vent occupants from being thrown  
from the vehicle in the event of an  
accident. Completely closing it also  
helps keep exhaust gases from enter-  
ing the car.  
If you cannot unlatch the tailgate by push-  
ing the unlatch switch (1) due to a dis-  
charged battery or malfunction, follow the  
procedures below to unlatch the tailgate  
from inside the vehicle.  
1) Fold the rear seat forward for easier  
access. Refer to “Folding Rear Seats”  
section for details on how to fold the  
rear seat forward.  
(2)  
EXAMPLE  
80J092  
55KS005  
2) Push open the tailgate from inside by  
pushing up on the emergency lever (2)  
using a flat blade screwdriver or the  
jack handle. The tailgate will be latched  
again by closing the tailgate simply.  
If your vehicle is equipped with a trunk lid  
key lock, you can open the trunk lid by  
using the key in the trunk lid lock. To open  
the trunk lid, insert the key and turn it  
clockwise to unlatch and lift the trunk lid.  
If the tailgate cannot be unlatched by push-  
ing the unlatch switch (1), have the vehicle  
inspected by your SUZUKI dealer.  
CAUTION  
Do not use the key to lift up the lid, or  
the key may break off in the lock.  
WARNING  
• To avoid injury, do not use your fin-  
ger to push the emergency lever.  
• Make sure there is no one near the  
tailgate when pushing open the tail-  
gate from inside the vehicle.  
2-4  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Door Locks: 3, 5, 8  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Internal Trunk Release  
(SX4 SEDAN)  
EXAMPLE  
(1)  
EXAMPLE  
56KN010  
80JC005  
If your vehicle is equipped with a trunk lid  
unlatch switch (1), push and hold the trunk  
lid unlatch switch (1) and lift the trunk lid to  
open the trunk lid.  
You can unlock the lid by pulling the  
release lever located to the outboard side  
of the driver’s seat.  
54G297  
There is a release lever located inside the  
trunk, on the rear part of the trunk lid. This  
lever is for emergency use so that if a per-  
son, such as a child, gets trapped in the  
trunk compartment, he can exit the vehicle.  
The lever glows in the dark, after a brief  
exposure to ambient light, so it can be  
found easily. It is operated by pushing it  
down in the direction of the arrow.  
WARNING  
The trunk lid unlatch switch (1) operates  
when the keyless start system remote con-  
troller is within the switch’s operating  
range.  
The trunk lid unlatch switch (1) operates  
only to open the trunk lid.  
If you close the trunk lid with the keyless  
start system remote controller left in the  
trunk with all the doors locked, the trunk  
will be automatically unlatched.  
Always make sure that the trunk lid is  
closed and latched securely. Other-  
wise, it may open unexpectedly while  
driving. Completely closing it also  
helps keep exhaust gases from enter-  
ing the car.  
WARNING  
To help avoid situations where some-  
one might get trapped in the trunk,  
keep your vehicle locked when unat-  
tended, and do not allow anyone to  
play in the trunk.  
2-5  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Door Locks: 3, 5, 8  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Keyless Start System Remote  
Controller (Type A)  
“LOCK” button (1) / “UNLOCK” button  
(2) function  
You can lock or unlock all doors (including  
the tailgate of SX4) simultaneously by  
operating the remote controller near the  
vehicle.  
Keyless Start System Remote  
Controller/Keyless Entry  
System Transmitter  
The remote controller enables the following  
operations:  
You can lock or unlock the doors by  
operating the LOCK/UNLOCK buttons  
on the remote controller. Refer to the  
explanation in this section.  
You can lock or unlock the doors by  
pushing the request switch on the door  
handle. For details, refer to the explana-  
tion in this section.  
You can start the engine without using  
an ignition key. For details, refer to “Igni-  
tion Switch” in the “OPERATING YOUR  
VEHICLE” section.  
Type A  
Type B  
To lock the doors, push the “LOCK” but-  
ton (1).  
To unlock the driver’s door, push the  
“UNLOCK” button (2) once.  
To unlock other doors, wait a second or  
two, then push the “UNLOCK” button (2)  
a second time. If you “double-click” too  
fast, the doors will not unlock.  
The turn signal lights will flash once when  
the doors are locked.  
When the doors are unlocked:  
66J111  
(1)  
• The turn signal lights will flash twice.  
• If the interior light switch is in the  
“DOOR” position, the interior light will  
turn on for about 15 seconds and then  
fade out. If you push in the ignition  
switch or insert the key during this time,  
the light will start to fade out immedi-  
ately.  
Your vehicle is equipped with either a key-  
less start system remote controller (Type  
A) or a keyless entry system transmitter  
(Type B). The remote controller has a key-  
less entry system and a keyless start sys-  
tem. The transmitter has only a keyless  
entry system. For details, refer to the fol-  
lowing explanations.  
(2)  
(3)  
Be sure the doors are locked after you  
operate the “LOCK” button (1).  
If no door is opened within about 30 sec-  
onds after the “UNLOCK” button (2) is  
operated, the doors will automatically lock  
again.  
66J114  
(1) “LOCK” button  
(2) “UNLOCK” button  
(3) “PANIC” button  
2-6  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Door Locks: 3, 5, 8  
BEFORE DRIVING  
NOTE:  
PANIC” button (3) function  
Keyless unlocking/locking using the  
request switches  
• The maximum operating distance of the  
remote controller is about 5 m (16 ft.),  
but this can vary depending on the sur-  
roundings, especially near other trans-  
mitting devices such as radio towers or  
CB (Citizen’s Band) radios.  
This function is to get the attention of oth-  
ers.  
SX4  
Press the “PANIC” button (3) for more than  
1 second. The headlights and taillights will  
blink for about 30 seconds. Also, the horn  
will sound intermittently for about 30 sec-  
onds at the same time.  
To cancel the “PANIC” mode, press any  
button (PANIC, LOCK or UNLOCK) on the  
remote controller. You can also insert the  
key in the ignition switch and turn to the  
“ON” position to cancel the “PANIC” mode.  
• The door locks cannot be operated with  
the remote controller if the ignition switch  
is in a position other than “LOCK”, or the  
ignition key is inserted in the ignition  
switch, or if any door is open.  
If any door is open, you cannot lock the  
door by operating the remote controller,  
however unlock the door.  
NOTE:  
(1)  
You cannot lock the door unless all of the  
door are closed completely.  
The “PANIC” button function will not acti-  
vate when the key is in the ignition switch.  
EXAMPLE  
80JC054  
• If you lose one of the remote controllers,  
ask your SUZUKI dealer as soon as pos-  
sible for a replacement. Be sure to have  
your dealer program the new remote  
controller code in your vehicle’s memory  
so that the old code is erased, or per-  
form the programming procedure your-  
self according to the instructions in this  
section.  
SX4 SEDAN  
(1)  
EXAMPLE  
56KN008  
2-7  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windows: 3, 8  
BEFORE DRIVING  
When the remote controller is within the  
NOTE:  
NOTE:  
• If the remote controller is outside the  
request switch operating range  
described above, you will not be able to  
operate the request switch.  
• If the battery of the remote controller  
runs down or there are strong radio  
waves or noise, the request switch oper-  
ating range may be reduced or the  
remote controller may be inoperative.  
• If the remote controller is too close to the  
door glass, the request switches may not  
operate.  
operating range described in this section,  
you can lock or unlock the doors by push-  
ing the request switch (1) on the door han-  
dle of the driver’s door, front passenger’s  
door or tailgate of SX4.  
• The door locks cannot be operated by  
the request switch under the following  
conditions:  
– If any door is open or is not completely  
closed.  
– If the ignition switch is in a position  
other than “LOCK”.  
– If the ignition key is inserted in the igni-  
tion switch.  
• If no doors are opened within about 30  
seconds after unlocking the doors by  
pushing the request switch, the doors  
will be locked again automatically.  
To lock all doors when all doors are  
unlocked:  
• Push the request switch on one of the  
door handles once.  
The turn signal lights will flash once when  
the doors are locked.  
• If a spare remote controller is in the vehi-  
cle, the request switches may not oper-  
ate normally.  
To unlock a door or all doors:  
• Push the request switch on the door  
handle once to unlock only one door.  
• Push the request switch on the door  
handle twice to unlock all doors.  
EXAMPLE  
• The remote controller will only operate a  
request switch if it is within the switch’s  
operating range. For example, if the  
remote controller is within the operating  
range of the driver’s door request switch  
but not the front passenger’s door  
request switch or the tailgate request  
switch, the driver’s door switch can be  
operated but the front passenger’s door  
switch or tailgate switch cannot be oper-  
ated.  
(1)  
When the doors are unlocked:  
• The turn signal lights will flash twice.  
• If the interior light switch is in the  
“DOOR” position, the interior light will  
turn on for about 15 seconds and then  
fade out. If you push in the ignition  
switch or insert the key during this time,  
the light will start to fade out immedi-  
ately.  
(1)  
(1)  
80JM020  
Be sure the doors are locked after you  
operate the request switch to lock the  
doors.  
(1) 80 cm (2 1/2 feet)  
When the remote controller is within  
approximately 80 cm (2 1/2 feet) from a  
front door handle or the tailgate switch, you  
can lock or unlock the doors by pushing  
the request switch.  
2-8  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windows: 3, 8  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Some additional precautions you should  
take and information you should be aware  
of are:  
• Make sure the ignition key is stowed in  
the remote controller. If the remote con-  
troller becomes unreliable, you will not  
be able to lock or unlock the doors or  
start the engine.  
CAUTION  
The remote controller is a sensitive  
electronic instrument. To avoid dam-  
aging the remote controller:  
• Do not expose it to impacts, mois-  
ture or high temperature such as by  
leaving it on the dashboard under  
direct sunlight.  
• Keep the remote controller away  
from magnetic objects such as a  
television.  
80JC026  
• Be sure that the driver always carries the  
remote controller.  
To stow the ignition key into the remote  
controller, push the key in the remote con-  
troller until you hear a click.  
• If you lose one of the remote controllers,  
ask your SUZUKI dealer as soon as pos-  
sible for a replacement. Be sure to have  
your dealer program the new remote  
controller code in your vehicle’s memory  
so that the old code is erased, or per-  
form the programming procedure your-  
self according to the instructions in this  
section.  
You can use up to four remote controllers  
and ignition keys for your vehicle. Ask  
your SUZUKI dealer for details.  
• The battery life of the remote controller  
is about two years, but it can vary  
depending on usage conditions.  
NOTE:  
The keyless start system may not function  
correctly in certain environments or under  
certain operating conditions such as the  
following:  
• When there are strong signals coming  
from a television, power station or a cel-  
lular phone.  
• When the remote controller is in contact  
with or covered by a metal object.  
• When a radio wave type remote keyless  
entry is used nearby.  
(A)  
80JC027  
To remove the key from the remote control-  
ler, push the button (A) in the direction of  
the arrow and pull the key out from the  
remote controller.  
• When the remote controller is placed  
near an electronic device such as per-  
sonal computer.  
2-9  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windows: 3, 8  
Mirrors: 3, 8  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Reminder function  
• If you open the driver’s door and lock the  
door by turning the lock knob forward or  
pushing the power door locking switch,  
the driver’s door will be automatically  
unlocked.  
• If you open a door other than the driver’s  
door and lock the front passenger’s door  
by turning the lock knob forward or push-  
ing the power door locking switch, the  
front passenger’s door will be automati-  
cally unlocked.  
Replacement of the battery  
If the remote controller becomes unreli-  
able, replace the battery.  
To replace the battery of the remote con-  
troller:  
For SX4 SEDAN, if you close the trunk lid  
with the remote controller left in the trunk  
with all the doors locked, the trunk will be  
automatically unlatched.  
EXAMPLE  
80J2016  
If the remote controller is not in the vehicle  
under the following conditions, a buzzer  
sounds intermittently for about 2 seconds  
and the keyless start system indicator light  
on the instrument cluster blinks in red:  
• When the vehicle speed is over 10 km/h  
(6 mph).  
• When one or more doors are opened  
and all of the doors are later closed with  
the ignition switch in a position other  
than “LOCK”.  
NOTE:  
• The reminder will not operate when the  
remote controller is on the instrument  
panel, in the glove box, in a storage  
compartment, in the sun visor or on the  
floor etc.  
66J016  
1) Insert a flat blade screwdriver covered  
with a soft cloth in the slot of the remote  
controller and pry it open.  
• Be sure that the driver always carries the  
remote controller.  
• Do not leave the remote controller in the  
vehicle when leaving the vehicle.  
The red indicator light will turn off within  
several seconds after the remote controller  
is returned to an area of the vehicle other  
than the rear luggage area.  
If the remote controller is left in the vehicle  
and you lock the driver’s door or front pas-  
senger’s door as described below, the door  
will be automatically unlocked.  
2-10  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mirrors: 3, 8  
Seat Adjustment: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Programming/erasing the remote con-  
troller code yourself  
WARNING  
Your new vehicle was originally equipped  
with two remote controllers.  
Swallowing a lithium battery may  
cause serious internal injury. Do not  
allow anyone to swallow a lithium  
battery. Keep lithium batteries away  
from children and pets. If swallowed,  
contact a physician immediately.  
If you have lost one of the remote control-  
lers, you should change the remote con-  
troller code in your vehicle’s memory as  
soon as possible for security. If you pur-  
chase additional remote controllers, the  
new remote controllers need to be pro-  
grammed into your vehicle’s memory. You  
can perform this yourself by using the fol-  
lowing procedure:  
(1)  
CAUTION  
The transmitter/remote controller is a  
sensitive electronic instrument. To  
avoid damaging it, do not expose it to  
dust or moisture or tamper with inter-  
nal parts.  
80J2076  
NOTE:  
(1) Lithium disc type battery:  
CR2032 or equivalent  
You can program up to four remote con-  
troller codes into your vehicle’s memory.  
The four codes may be the same or dif-  
ferent.  
2) Replace the battery (1) so its + terminal  
faces the bottom of the case as shown  
in the illustration.  
3) Close the remote controller firmly.  
4) Make sure the door locks can be oper-  
ated with the remote controller.  
5) Dispose of the used battery properly  
according to applicable rules or regula-  
tions. Do not dispose of lithium batter-  
ies with ordinary household trash.  
• If you try to program a fifth code, the four  
remote controller codes that are pro-  
grammed will be cleared automatically.  
• If you program a new remote controller  
code, all of the old remote controller  
codes that are in your vehicle’s memory  
will be erased automatically. When you  
program a new remote controller, you  
should reprogram any additional remote  
controllers at the same time.  
To purchase new remote controllers, see  
your SUZUKI dealer.  
• Before you begin programming, have all  
of your remote controllers available.  
2-11  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Adjustment: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
To program a new remote controller  
7. Proceed to step 5) within 60 seconds  
after the engine has started.  
8) Make sure that the keyless start system  
and keyless entry system operate prop-  
erly by operating each remote control-  
ler.  
1) Close all the doors of the vehicle.  
2) Sit in the driver’s seat and confirm that  
the driver’s door is unlocked.  
NOTE:  
3) Insert the key into the ignition switch.  
4) Complete steps 1 through 6 described  
below within 25 seconds after step 3).  
You cannot program the remote controller  
if you don’t complete steps 1 through 6  
within 25 seconds.  
You cannot program the remote controller  
if you do not proceed to step 5) within 60  
seconds after the engine has started.  
If you cannot operate the keyless start sys-  
tem and/or keyless entry system, repeat  
this programming procedure again.  
If you still cannot operate the systems, see  
your SUZUKI dealer.  
5) Turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK”  
position.  
A buzzer will sound twice and the door  
lock switch will be activated from the  
lock position to the unlock position  
automatically.  
UNLOCK  
(2)  
LOCK  
(1)  
6) Press the “LOCK”, “UNLOCK” or  
PANIC” button on the remote controller.  
A buzzer will sound twice and the door  
lock switch will be activated from the  
lock position to the unlock position  
automatically.  
80JC093  
1. Push the power door locking switch  
of the driver’s door to the lock posi-  
tion and then push it to the unlock (2)  
position.  
2. Repeat step 1 two more times.  
3. Push the power door locking switch  
of the driver’s door to the lock (1)  
position.  
4. Remove the key from the ignition  
switch and then insert it again.  
5. Repeat step 4 three more times.  
6. To start the engine, turn the ignition  
switch to the “START” position.  
Wait for 3 seconds.  
If you want to program an additional  
remote controller, repeat the procedure  
of step 6) using the additional remote  
controller.  
NOTE:  
Complete step 6) within 30 seconds.  
You can program up to four remote control-  
lers.  
7) To complete programming, remove the  
key from the ignition switch or turn the  
ignition switch to the “ON” position.  
2-12  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Adjustment: 3  
Head Restraints: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
To change the old remote controller  
codes in your vehicle’s memory  
If you have lost one of the remote control-  
lers, you should change the remote con-  
troller codes in your vehicle’s memory as  
soon as possible for security.  
1. For USA  
Keyless Entry System Transmitter  
(Type B)  
This device complies with Part 15 of the  
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the fol-  
lowing two conditions:  
1) This device may not cause harmful  
interference, and  
2) This device must accept any interfer-  
ence received, including interference  
that may cause undesired operation.  
(1)  
(2)  
To erase the remote controller code(s) in  
your vehicle’s memory, you should pro-  
gram the new remote controller code. The  
old codes in your vehicle’s memory will be  
erased automatically. If you have more  
remote controller(s), you must program all  
of the remote controller codes at the same  
time. You cannot operate the keyless start  
system and keyless entry system using  
any remote controller that is not pro-  
grammed at the same time.  
For details on how to program, refer to the  
programming procedure in this section.  
When you complete programming, make  
sure that the keyless start system and key-  
less entry system operate properly by  
operating each remote controller.  
NOTE:  
(3)  
Changes or modifications not expressly  
approved by the party responsible for com-  
pliance could void the user’s authority to  
operate the equipment.  
52D209  
2. For Canada  
(1) “LOCK” button  
(2) “UNLOCK” button  
(3) “PANIC” button  
This device complies with Industry Canada  
Standard RSS-210. Operation is subject to  
the following two conditions:  
1) This device may not cause interference,  
and  
“LOCK” button (1) / “UNLOCK” button  
(2) function  
You can lock or unlock all doors (including  
the tailgate of SX4) simultaneously by  
operating the transmitter near the vehicle.  
2) This device must accept any interfer-  
ence, including interference that may  
cause undesired operation of the  
device.  
To lock the doors, push the “LOCK” but-  
ton (1).  
To unlock the driver’s door, push the  
“UNLOCK” button (2) once.  
To unlock other doors, wait a second or  
two, then push the “UNLOCK” button (2)  
a second time. If you “double-click” too  
fast, the doors will not unlock.  
The term “IC:” before the certification/reg-  
istration number only signifies that the  
Industry Canada technical specifications  
were met.  
2-13  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Head Restraints: 3  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
The turn signal lights will flash once when  
the doors are locked.  
Replacement of the battery  
If the transmitter becomes unreliable,  
replace the battery.  
CAUTION  
When the doors are unlocked:  
The transmitter is a sensitive elec-  
tronic instrument. To avoid damaging  
the transmitter:  
• Do not expose it to impacts, mois-  
ture or high temperature such as by  
leaving it on the dashboard under  
direct sunlight.  
• Keep the transmitter away from  
magnetic objects such as a televi-  
sion.  
• The turn signal lights will flash twice.  
• If the interior light switch is in the  
“DOOR” position, the interior light will  
turn on for about 15 seconds and then  
fade out. If you insert the key into the  
ignition switch during this time, the light  
will start to fade out immediately.  
To replace the battery of the transmitter:  
Be sure the doors are locked after you  
operate the “LOCK” button (1).  
If no door is opened within about 30 sec-  
onds after the “UNLOCK” button (2) is  
operated, the doors will automatically lock  
again.  
PANIC” button (3) function  
This function is to get the attention of oth-  
ers.  
Press the “PANIC” button (3) for more than  
1 second. The headlights and taillights will  
blink for about 30 seconds. Also, the horn  
will sound intermittently for about 30 sec-  
onds at the same time.  
To cancel the “PANIC” mode, press any  
button (PANIC, LOCK or UNLOCK) on the  
transmitter. You can also insert the key in  
the ignition switch and turn to the “ON”  
position to cancel the “PANIC” mode.  
NOTE:  
52D210  
• The maximum operating distance of the  
keyless entry system transmitter is about  
5 m (16 ft.), but this can vary depending  
on the surroundings, especially near  
other transmitting devices such as radio  
towers or CB (Citizen’s Band) radios.  
• The door locks cannot be operated with  
the transmitter, if the ignition key is  
inserted in the ignition switch.  
1) Put the edge of a coin or a flat blade  
screwdriver in the slot of the transmitter  
and pry it open.  
NOTE:  
• If you lose one of the transmitters, ask  
your SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible  
for a replacement. Be sure to have your  
dealer program the new transmitter code  
in your vehicle’s memory so that the old  
code is erased, or perform the program-  
ming procedure yourself according to the  
instructions in this section.  
The “PANIC” button function will not acti-  
vate when the key is in the ignition switch.  
2-14  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
To program a new transmitter  
1) Confirm that all the doors are closed  
and the ignition key is out of the ignition  
switch.  
CAUTION  
The transmitter/remote controller is a  
sensitive electronic instrument. To  
avoid damaging it, do not expose it to  
dust or moisture or tamper with inter-  
nal parts.  
2) Open the driver’s door.  
(1)  
3) Insert the key, turn the ignition switch to  
the “ON” position, turn the ignition  
switch to the “LOCK” position and  
remove the key within 10 seconds.  
Programming/removing  
code yourself  
Your new vehicle was originally equipped  
with two transmitters.  
a
transmitter  
If you have lost one of the transmitters, you  
should change the transmitter code in your  
vehicle’s memory as soon as possible for  
security. If you purchase additional trans-  
mitters, the new transmitters need to be  
programmed into your vehicle’s memory.  
You can perform this yourself by using the  
following procedure:  
80J2077  
(1) Lithium disc type battery:  
CR2025 or equivalent  
2) Replace the battery (1) so its + terminal  
faces the “+” mark of the transmitter.  
3) Close the transmitter firmly.  
4) Make sure the door locks can be oper-  
ated with the transmitter.  
(1)  
NOTE:  
66J018  
You can program up to three transmitter  
codes into your vehicle’s memory. The  
three codes may be the same or differ-  
ent.  
• If you try to program a fourth code, the  
oldest code will be cleared automatically.  
To purchase new transmitters, see your  
SUZUKI dealer.  
5) Dispose of the used battery properly  
according to applicable rules or regula-  
tions. Do not dispose of lithium batter-  
ies with ordinary household trash.  
4) Push and release the driver’s door  
switch (1) 3 times, insert the key, and  
turn the ignition switch to the “ON” posi-  
tion within 20 seconds.  
5) Turn the ignition switch to the “LOCK”  
position and remove the key within 10  
seconds. All doors will lock/unlock to  
confirm that this procedure has been  
properly completed.  
WARNING  
Swallowing a lithium battery may  
cause serious internal injury. Do not  
allow anyone to swallow a lithium  
battery. Keep lithium batteries away  
from children and pets. If swallowed,  
contact a physician immediately.  
• Before you begin programming, have all  
of your transmitters available.  
2-15  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
To change the old transmitter codes in  
your vehicle’s memory  
If you have lost one of the transmitters, you  
should change the transmitter codes in  
your vehicle’s memory as soon as possible  
for security.  
1. For USA  
This device complies with Part 15 of the  
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the fol-  
lowing two conditions:  
(2)  
1) This device may not cause harmful  
interference, and  
To remove one of the transmitter codes  
from your vehicle’s memory, first replace all  
three of the transmitter codes in your vehi-  
cle’s memory, then program additional  
transmitters as follows:  
2) This device must accept any interfer-  
ence received, including interference  
that may cause undesired operation.  
NOTE:  
Changes or modifications not expressly  
approved by the party responsible for com-  
pliance could void the user’s authority to  
operate the equipment.  
1) Program one of your transmitters three  
times, by repeating the programming  
procedure shown in this section. This  
will replace all the old transmitter codes  
in the vehicle’s memory with the code  
for the transmitter you are using.  
2) If you want to program up to two addi-  
tional transmitters, repeat the program-  
ming procedure shown in this section.  
3) Make sure that the keyless entry sys-  
tem operates properly by operating  
each transmitter.  
52D212  
6) Press the “UNLOCK” button (2) on the  
transmitter one time within 20 seconds  
(after step 5). All the doors will lock/  
unlock to confirm that the procedure  
has been completed and the transmitter  
has been programmed.  
7) If you want to program an additional  
transmitter, repeat the procedure from  
step 1) through step 6).  
2. For Canada  
This device complies with Industry Canada  
Standard RSS-210. Operation is subject to  
the following two conditions:  
1) This device may not cause interference,  
and  
2) This device must accept any interfer-  
ence, including interference that may  
cause undesired operation of the  
device.  
8) Make sure that the keyless entry sys-  
tem operates properly by operating  
each transmitter.  
The term “IC:” before the certification/reg-  
istration number only signifies that the  
Industry Canada technical specifications  
were met.  
2-16  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Passenger’s door  
EXAMPLE  
Theft Deterrent Light  
Windows  
Power Window Controls  
Driver’s side  
(3)  
EXAMPLE  
(1)  
(4)  
(2)  
80JC096  
(5)  
80JM022  
The passenger’s door has a switch (3) to  
operate the passenger’s window.  
This light will blink with the ignition switch  
in the “OFF” or “ACC” position. The blink-  
ing light is intended to deter theft by lead-  
ing others to believe that the vehicle is  
equipped with a security system.  
80JC095  
The power windows can only be operated  
when the ignition switch is in the “ON” posi-  
tion.  
The driver’s door has switches (1), (2), (4),  
(5), to operate the driver’s window, the  
front passenger’s window, the rear left win-  
dow and the rear right window, respec-  
tively.  
2-17  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
WARNING  
Lock switch  
EXAMPLE  
CLOSE  
You should always lock the passen-  
ger’s window operation when there  
are children in the vehicle. Children  
can be seriously injured if they get  
part of their body caught by the  
window during operation.  
• To avoid injuring an occupant by  
window entrapment, be sure no  
part of the occupant’s body such  
as hands or head is in the path of  
the electric windows when closing  
them.  
• Always remove the ignition key  
when leaving the vehicle even if  
only for a short time. Also do not  
leave children alone in a parked  
vehicle. Unattended children could  
use the electric window switches  
and get trapped by the window.  
OPEN  
81A009  
80JC097  
To open a window, push the top part of the  
switch and to close a window lift up the top  
part of the switch.  
The driver’s door also has a lock switch for  
the passenger’s window(s). When you  
push in the lock switch, the passenger’s  
window(s) cannot be raised or lowered by  
operating any of the switches (2), (3), (4) or  
(5). To restore normal operation, release  
the lock switch by pushing the switch  
again.  
The driver’s window has an auto-down fea-  
ture for added convenience (at toll booths  
or drive-through restaurants, for example).  
This means you can open the window with-  
out holding the window switch in the  
“Down” position. Press the driver’s window  
switch completely down and release it. To  
stop the window before it reaches the bot-  
tom, pull the switch up briefly.  
2-18  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
EXAMPLE  
Mirrors  
WARNING  
Inside Rearview Mirror  
• Always adjust the mirror with the  
selector set to the day position.  
• Only use the night position if it is  
necessary to reduce glare from the  
headlights of vehicles behind you.  
Be aware that in this position you  
may not be able to see some  
objects that could be seen in the  
day position.  
65D410  
52LM012  
NOTE:  
The rear door windows are not designed to  
open fully. They can be opened about 2/3  
of the way down.  
(1)  
Day driving  
Night driving  
65D409  
You can adjust the inside rearview mirror  
by hand so as to see the rear of your vehi-  
cle in the mirror. To adjust the mirror, set  
the selector tab (1) to the day position,  
then move the mirror up, down or sideways  
by hand to obtain the best view.  
NOTE:  
If you drive with one of the rear windows  
open, you may hear a loud sound caused  
by air vibration. To reduce the sound, open  
the driver’s or front passenger’s window, or  
narrow the rear window opening.  
When driving at night, you can move the  
selector tab to the night position to reduce  
glare from the headlights of vehicles  
behind you.  
2-19  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
NOTE:  
Outside Rearview Mirrors  
Power Mirror Control (if equipped)  
If your vehicle is equipped with the heated  
outside rearview mirrors, refer to “Heated  
Rear Window and Heated Outside Rear-  
view Mirrors (if equipped) Switch” in this  
section.  
(1)  
(1)  
(4)  
(2)  
(3)  
(2)  
(3)  
(4)  
79J033  
79J034  
Adjust the outside rearview mirrors so you  
can just see the side of your vehicle in the  
mirrors.  
The switch to control the power rearview  
mirrors is located on the driver’s door  
panel. You can adjust the mirrors when the  
ignition switch is in the “ACC” or “ON” posi-  
tion. To adjust the mirrors:  
The passenger’s side mirror is a convex  
(curved surface) mirror. Objects seen in  
this mirror will look smaller and appear far-  
ther away than when seen in a flat mirror.  
1) Move the selector switch to the left or  
right to select the mirror you wish to  
adjust.  
2) Press the outer part of the switch that  
corresponds to the direction you wish to  
move the mirror.  
3) Return the selector switch to the center  
position to help prevent unintended  
adjustment.  
WARNING  
Be careful when judging the size or  
distance of a vehicle or other object  
seen in the side convex mirror. Be  
aware that objects look smaller and  
appear farther away than when seen  
in a flat mirror.  
2-20  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Adjusting Seat Position  
Front Seats  
Seat Adjustment  
WARNING  
Never attempt to adjust the driver’s  
seat or seatback while driving. The  
seat or seatback could move unex-  
pectedly, causing loss of control.  
Make sure that the driver’s seat and  
seatback are properly adjusted  
before you start driving.  
80JM024  
WARNING  
80JM023  
If the driver’s seat is equipped with a seat  
height adjuster lever on the outboard side  
of the seat, raise or lower the seat by pull-  
ing up or down the adjuster lever.  
To avoid excessive seat belt slack,  
which reduces the effectiveness of  
the seat belts as a safety device,  
make sure that the seats are adjusted  
before the seat belts are fastened.  
The adjustment lever for each front seat is  
located under the front of the seat. To  
adjust the seat position, pull up on the  
adjustment lever and slide the seat forward  
or rearward. After adjustment, try to move  
the seat forward and rearward to ensure  
that it is securely latched.  
2-21  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
WARNING  
Adjusting Seatbacks  
WARNING  
Head Restraints  
All head restraints must be rein-  
stalled to properly protect vehicle  
occupants.  
All seatbacks should always be in an  
upright position when driving, or seat  
belt effectiveness may be reduced.  
Seat belts are designed to offer maxi-  
mum protection when seatbacks are  
in the upright position.  
WARNING  
• Never drive the vehicle with the  
head restraints removed.  
• Do not attempt to adjust the head  
restraint while driving.  
Front  
80J001  
Head restraints are designed to help  
reduce the risk of neck injuries in case of  
an accident.  
Adjust the head restraint to the position  
which places the center of the head  
restraint closest to the top of your ears. If  
this is not possible for very tall passengers,  
adjust the head restraint as high as possi-  
ble.  
80JM025  
To adjust the seatback angle of front seats,  
pull up the lever on the outboard side of  
the seat, move the seatback to the desired  
position, and release the lever to lock the  
seatback in place. After adjustment, try  
moving the seatback to make sure it is  
securely locked.  
WARNING  
All occupants, including the driver,  
should not operate a vehicle or sit in  
80J2060  
Each front seats is equipped with a head  
restraint.  
a
vehicle’s seat until the head  
restraints are placed in their proper  
positions in order to minimize the  
risk of severe injury in the event of a  
crash.  
2-22  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Front Seat Heater  
(if equipped)  
EXAMPLE  
(1)  
(3)  
(2)  
(4)  
80J2012  
80J2013  
(1) head restraint  
(2) bars  
(3) release knob  
To reinstall the head restraint, insert the  
head restraint bars into the holes (4) and  
push the head restraint down.  
79J076  
With the ignition switch in the “ON” posi-  
tion, push in one or both of the seat heater  
switches to warm the corresponding  
seat(s). The indicator light below the switch  
will also come on. To turn off the seat  
heater, push in the switch again. The indi-  
cator light below the switch will go off.  
To raise the head restraint, pull upward on  
the restraint until it clicks. To lower the  
restraint, push down on the restraint while  
holding in the release knob (3). If a head  
restraint must be removed (for cleaning,  
replacement, etc.), push in the release  
knob and pull the head restraint all the way  
out.  
NOTE:  
It may be necessary to recline the seat-  
back to provide enough overhead clear-  
ance to remove the head restraint.  
2-23  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Rear Seats  
CAUTION  
Head Restraints  
To avoid damaging the heater ele-  
ment:  
• Do not subject the front seats to  
heavy impacts, such as children  
jumping on them.  
• Do not cover the seat with any  
insulating materials such as blan-  
kets or cushions.  
Head restraints are designed to help  
reduce the risk of neck injuries in the case  
of an accident.  
WARNING  
All occupants, including the driver,  
should not operate a vehicle or sit in  
a
vehicle’s seat until the head  
restraints are placed in their proper  
positions in order to minimize the  
risk of severe injury in the event of a  
crash.  
86G064  
WARNING  
WARNING  
Improperly using the seat heater can  
be hazardous. An occupant can suf-  
fer burns even if the heating tempera-  
ture is fairly low, if the occupant is  
wearing thin pants, a thin skirt or  
shorts and leaves the heater on for  
long periods.  
Avoid using the seat heater for these  
occupants:  
• People who have reduced feeling in  
their legs, including the elderly or  
those with certain disabilities.  
• Small children, or anyone with sen-  
sitive skin.  
All head restraints must be rein-  
stalled to properly protect vehicle  
occupants.  
WARNING  
• Never drive the vehicle with the  
head restraints removed.  
• Do not attempt to adjust the head  
restraint while driving.  
• People who are asleep or under the  
influence of alcohol or other drugs  
which make them tired.  
2-24  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
NOTE:  
Rear  
To raise the rear head restraint, pull  
upward on the restraint until it clicks. To  
lower the restraint, push down on the  
restraint while holding in the release knob  
(3). If a head restraint must be removed  
(for cleaning, replacement, etc.), push in  
the release knob and pull the head  
restraint all the way out.  
It may be necessary to fold forward the  
seatback to provide enough overhead  
clearance to remove the head restraint.  
Adjust the head restraint to the position  
which places the center of the head  
restraint closest to the top of your ears. If  
this is not possible for very tall passengers,  
adjust the head restraint as high as possi-  
ble.  
When installing a child restraint system,  
raise the head restraint to the most upper  
position.  
For SX4 SEDAN, if the distance between  
the child restraint system and the anchor  
bracket is too close to properly tighten the  
child restraint top strap, lower the head  
restraint to the lowest position and connect  
the top strap to the anchor bracket by  
passing it over the top of the head  
restraint.  
EXAMPLE  
80J2061  
Your vehicle is equipped with three head  
restraints on the rear seat.  
EXAMPLE  
(3)  
(1)  
(2)  
80J2005  
(1) head restraint  
(2) bars  
(3) release knob  
2-25  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
1) Hook the webbing of the outboard lap-  
shoulder belts in the belt hangers.  
SX4  
EXAMPLE  
Folding Rear Seats  
The rear seats of your vehicle can be folded  
forward to provide additional cargo space.  
CAUTION  
To fold the rear seats forward:  
• When you move a seatback, make  
sure the belt webbing is hooked in  
the seat belt hangers so the seat  
belts are not caught by the seat-  
back, seat hinge, or seat latch. This  
helps prevent damage to the belt  
system.  
SX4  
EXAMPLE  
• Make sure the belt webbing is not  
twisted.  
80JM027  
2) Lower the adjustable head restraint  
fully.  
SX4 SEDAN  
EXAMPLE  
80JM026  
SX4 SEDAN  
EXAMPLE  
80JC087  
80JC086  
2-26  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
3) For SX4, pull the release lever on the  
top of each split seat, and fold the seat-  
backs forward.  
To return the seat to the normal position,  
follow the procedure below.  
SX4  
EXAMPLE  
UNLOCK  
Red  
For SX4 SEDAN, push the release but-  
ton on the top of each split seat, and  
fold the seatbacks forward.  
WARNING  
When returning the rear seatback to  
the normal position, be careful that  
your finger is not caught between the  
lock and the striker.  
CAUTION  
After folding the rear seatback for-  
ward, do not allow any foreign mate-  
rial to enter the lock opening. This  
may cause damage to the inside of  
the lock and prevent the seatback  
from being locked securely.  
LOCK  
CAUTION  
When returning the rear seatback to  
the normal position, make sure that  
there is nothing around the striker.  
Any foreign materials prevent the  
seatback from being locked securely.  
80J1219  
SX4 SEDAN  
EXAMPLE  
WARNING  
Luggage or other cargo should be  
stowed in the luggage compartment  
with the rear seat in an upright posi-  
tion, whenever possible. If you need  
to carry cargo in the passenger com-  
partment with the rear seat back  
folded forward, be sure to secure the  
cargo or it may be thrown about,  
causing injury. Never pile cargo  
higher than the seatbacks.  
UNLOCK  
Red  
LOCK  
80J1022  
Raise the seatback until it locks into place.  
After returning the seat, try moving the  
seatback to make sure they are securely  
latched.  
2-27  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint  
Systems  
WARNING  
Do not put your hand into the rear  
seatback lock opening, or your finger  
may get caught and be injured.  
Above the pelvis  
CAUTION  
After securing the rear seatback,  
make sure that it is locked securely. If  
it is not, red will appear in the release  
lever (SX4) or around the release but-  
ton (SX4 SEDAN).  
65D606  
CAUTION  
WARNING  
65D231  
• When returning the rear seatback  
to the normal position, do not allow  
any foreign material to enter the  
lock opening. This may prevent the  
• Never allow persons to ride in the  
cargo area of a vehicle. In the event  
of an accident, there is a much  
greater risk of injury for persons  
who are not riding in a seat with  
their seat belt securely fastened.  
• Seat belts should always be  
adjusted as follows:  
– the lap portion of the belt should  
be worn low across the pelvis,  
not across the waist.  
– the shoulder straps should be  
worn on the outside shoulder  
only, and never under the arm.  
– the shoulder straps should be  
away from your face and neck,  
but not falling off your shoulder.  
(Continued)  
WARNING  
An air bag supplements, or adds to,  
the frontal crash protection offered  
by seat belts. The driver and all pas-  
sengers must be properly restrained  
by wearing seat belts at all times,  
whether or not an air bag is mounted  
at their seating position, to minimize  
the risk of severe injury or death in  
the event of a crash.  
seatback  
securely.  
from  
being  
locked  
• When returning the rear seatback  
to the normal position, be sure to  
handle it carefully by hand to avoid  
any damage to the lock itself. Do  
not push it by using some material  
or by applying excessive force.  
• As the lock is designed exclusively  
for securing the rear seatback, do  
not use it for any other purpose.  
Incorrect use of it may cause dam-  
age to the inside of the lock and  
prevent the seatback from being  
locked securely.  
2-28  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
WARNING  
(Continued)  
• Do not wear your seat belt over  
hard or breakable objects in your  
pockets or on your clothing. If an  
accident occurs, objects such as  
glasses, pens, etc. under the seat  
belt can cause injury.  
as low as possible  
across the hips  
Across the pelvis  
• Never use the same seat belt on  
more than one occupant and never  
attach a seat belt over an infant or  
child being held on an occupant’s  
lap. Such seat belt use could cause  
serious injury in the event of an  
accident.  
• Periodically inspect seat belt  
assemblies for excessive wear and  
damage. Seat belts should be  
replaced if webbing becomes  
frayed, contaminated, or damaged  
in any way. It is essential to replace  
the entire seat belt assembly after it  
has been worn in a severe impact,  
even if damage to the assembly is  
not obvious.  
65D201  
65D199  
WARNING  
WARNING  
(Continued)  
(Continued)  
• Seat belts should never be worn  
with the straps twisted and should  
be adjusted as tightly as is com-  
fortable to provide the protection  
for which they have been designed.  
A slack belt will provide less pro-  
tection than one which is snug.  
(Continued)  
• Pregnant women should use seat  
belts, although specific recommen-  
dations about driving should be  
made by the woman’s medical advi-  
sor. Remember that the lap portion  
of the belt should be worn as low  
as possible across the hips, as  
shown in the diagram.  
• Children age 12 and under should  
ride properly restrained in the rear  
seat, if equipped.  
• Make sure that each seat belt  
buckle is inserted into the proper  
buckle catch. It is possible to cross  
the buckles in the rear seat.  
(Continued)  
(Continued)  
2-29  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Safety reminder  
Lap-Shoulder Belt  
WARNING  
Sit up straight and  
fully back  
Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR)  
The seat belt has an emergency locking  
retractor (ELR), which is designed to lock  
the seat belt only during a sudden stop or  
impact. It also may lock if you pull the belt  
across your body very quickly. If this hap-  
pens, let the belt go back to unlock it, then  
pull the belt across your body more slowly.  
(Continued)  
• Infants and small children should  
never be transported unless they  
are properly restrained. Restraint  
systems for infants and small chil-  
dren can be purchased commer-  
cially and should be used. Make  
sure that the system you purchase  
meets Federal Motor Vehicle Safety  
Standards. Read and follow all the  
directions provided by the manu-  
facturer.  
• Avoid contamination of seat belt  
webbing by polishes, oils, chemi-  
cals and particularly battery acid.  
Cleaning may safely be carried out  
using mild soap and water.  
Low on hips  
Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)  
The front passenger’s seat belt and the  
rear seat belts have emergency locking  
retractors (ELRs) that can be temporarily  
converted to function as automatic locking  
retractors (ALRs). The ALR mode should  
be used if you need to secure a child  
restraint system in the seat. Refer to the  
“Child Restraint Systems” section for  
details.  
60A038  
Low on hips  
• For children, if the shoulder belt  
irritates the neck or face, move the  
child closer to the center of the  
vehicle.  
• All seatbacks should always be in  
an upright position when driving,  
or seat belt effectiveness may be  
reduced. Seat belts are designed to  
offer maximum protection when  
seatbacks are in the upright posi-  
tion.  
60A040  
2-30  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
To reduce the risk of sliding under the belt  
during a collision, position the lap portion  
of the belt across your lap as low on your  
hips as possible and adjust it to a snug fit  
by pulling the shoulder portion of the belt  
upward through the latch plate. The length  
of the diagonal shoulder strap adjusts itself  
to allow freedom of movement.  
All Seat Belts  
EXAMPLE  
80J2008  
60A036  
NOTE:  
The word “CENTER” is molded into the  
buckle for the rear center belt. The buckles  
are designed so a latch plate cannot be  
inserted into the wrong buckle.  
To fasten the seat belt, sit up straight and  
well back in the seat, pull the latch plate  
attached to the seat belt across your body  
and press it into the buckle until you hear a  
“click”.  
2-31  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
When the driver and front passenger don’t  
buckle their seat belts, the driver’s seat belt  
reminder light in the instrument cluster and  
the front passenger’s seat belt reminder  
light in the information display will come on  
and a buzzer will sound as a reminder to  
the driver and front passenger to buckle  
their seat belts.  
Seat Belt Reminder  
Driver’s seat belt reminder light  
WARNING  
It is absolutely essential that the  
driver and passengers wear their seat  
belts at all times. Persons who are  
not wearing seat belts have a much  
greater risk of injury if an accident  
occurs. Make a regular habit of buck-  
ling your seat belt before putting the  
key in the ignition.  
60A039  
To unfasten the belt, push the red  
“PRESS” button on the buckle and allow  
the belt to retract.  
80J2017  
Front passenger’s seat belt reminder  
light  
The seat belt reminder functions as shown  
in the figure below. There are some differ-  
ences between the driver’s seat belt  
reminder and the front passenger’s seat  
belt reminder. For more details, refer to the  
explanation below.  
80J2018  
2-32  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 3  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Flow chart  
Driver’s seat belt reminder  
If the driver’s seat belt remains unbuckled  
with the ignition key in the “ON” position,  
the driver’s seat belt reminder works as fol-  
lows:  
Ignition Switch “ON”  
Seat belt is  
unbuckled  
Seat belt is  
buckled  
1) The driver’s seat belt reminder light will  
come on for about 20 seconds when  
the ignition key is turned to the “ON”  
position then will blink for about 55 sec-  
onds. When the light comes on, a  
buzzer will also sound intermittently for  
about 6 seconds (Reminder 1).  
2) If the vehicle is driven (vehicle speed >  
8 km/h), Reminder 2 will operate about  
30 seconds after Reminder 1 has fin-  
ished.  
No reminder  
Seat belt is  
unbuckled  
Reminder 1  
30 sec.  
Vehicle speed:  
below 8 km/h  
Vehicle speed:  
over 8 km/h  
Vehicle speed:  
below 8 km/h  
Vehicle speed:  
over 8 km/h  
If the vehicle is not driven (vehicle  
speed < 8 km/h), Reminder 2 will oper-  
ate when driving starts (vehicle speed >  
8 km/h).  
Vehicle speed:  
increase to 8 km/h  
Reminder 2  
3 min.  
3) Reminder 3 will operate about 3 min-  
utes after Reminder 2 has finished.  
4) Even if the driver’s seat belt remains  
unbuckled after Reminder 3, there will  
be no further reminders.  
Reminder 3  
If the driver has buckled his or her seat belt  
and later unbuckles the seat belt, the  
reminder system will be activated from  
Reminder 1 or Reminder 2 according to  
the vehicle speed. (Refer to the flow chart.)  
No reminder  
52D219  
Reminder 1 – 3  
For each reminder 1 – 3, the reminder light comes on for about 20 seconds, then blinks for  
about 55 seconds. When the reminder light first comes on, a buzzer sounds intermittently  
for about 6 seconds.  
The driver’s seat belt reminder will be auto-  
matically canceled when the driver’s seat  
belt is buckled or the ignition switch is  
turned off.  
2-33  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems: 3  
Supplemental Restraint System (advanced air bags):  
3, 9, 12  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Front passenger’s seat belt reminder  
The front passenger’s seat belt reminder  
will activate only when there is a passen-  
ger sitting in the front seat. In some situa-  
tions, however, such as when you place  
heavy objects in the front seat, the seat  
belt reminder can be activated as if there  
were a passenger present. The front pas-  
senger’s seat belt reminder works in the  
same manner as the driver’s seat belt  
reminder, except that it is not activated  
until 10 seconds after the ignition switch is  
turned to the “ON” position.  
Shoulder Anchor Height Adjuster  
EXAMPLE  
Seat Belt Hanger (if equipped)  
SX4  
EXAMPLE  
64J198  
80JM140  
Adjust the shoulder anchor height so that  
the shoulder belt rides on the center of the  
outside shoulder. To upward, slide the  
anchor up. To downward, slide the anchor  
down while pulling the lock knob out. After  
adjustment, make sure that the anchor is  
securely locked.  
SX4 SEDAN  
EXAMPLE  
WARNING  
Be sure that the shoulder belt is posi-  
tioned on the center of the outside  
shoulder. The belt should be away  
from your face and neck, but not fall-  
ing off your shoulder. Misadjustment  
of the belt could reduce the effective-  
ness of the safety belt in a crash.  
80JM141  
2-34  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Supplemental Restraint System (advanced air bags):  
3, 9, 12  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Seat Belt Inspection  
EXAMPLE  
CAUTION  
WARNING  
When you move a seatback, make  
sure the belt webbing is hooked in  
the seat belt hangers so the seat  
belts are not caught by the seatback,  
seat hinge, or seat latch. This helps  
prevent damage to the belt system.  
Be sure to inspect all seat belt  
assemblies after any collision. Any  
seat belt assembly which was in use  
during a collision (other than a very  
minor one) should be replaced, even  
if damage to the assembly is not  
obvious. Any seat belt assembly  
which was not in use during a colli-  
sion should be replaced if it does not  
function properly, it is damaged in  
any way or the seat belt pretension-  
ers were activated.  
65D209S  
Periodically inspect the seat belts to make  
sure they work properly and are not dam-  
aged. Check the webbing, buckles, latch  
plates, retractors, anchorages and guide  
loops. Replace any seat belts which do not  
work properly or are damaged.  
2-35  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Supplemental Restraint System (advanced air bags):  
3, 9, 12  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Infant restraint - rear seat only  
SUZUKI highly recommends that you use  
a child restraint system to restrain infants  
and small children. Many different types of  
child restraint systems are available; make  
sure that the restraint system you select  
meets Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Stan-  
dards.  
Child Restraint Systems  
EXAMPLE  
All child restraint systems are designed to  
be secured in vehicle seats by either seat  
belts (lap belts or the lap portion of lap-  
shoulder belts) or by special rigid lower  
anchor bars built into the seats. Whenever  
possible, SUZUKI recommends that child  
restraint systems be installed on the rear  
seat. According to accident statistics, chil-  
dren are safer when properly restrained in  
rear seating positions than in front seating  
positions.  
80JC007  
60G332  
Booster seat  
Infant restraint - rear seat only  
EXAMPLE  
EXAMPLE  
If you must use a front-facing child restraint  
in the front passenger’s seat, be sure to  
move the front passenger’s seat as far  
back as possible.  
80JC008  
65D202  
2-36  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Supplemental Restraint System (advanced air bags):  
3, 9, 12  
BEFORE DRIVING  
WARNING  
Children could be endangered in a  
crash if their child restraints are not  
properly secured in the vehicle.  
When installing a child restraint sys-  
tem, be sure to follow the instruc-  
tions below. Be sure to secure the  
child in the restraint system accord-  
ing to the manufacturer’s instruc-  
tions.  
65D607  
65D608  
WARNING  
Do not install a rear-facing child  
restraint in the front passenger’s  
seat. If the passenger’s air bag  
inflates, a child in a rear-facing child  
restraint could be killed or seriously  
injured. The back of a rear-facing  
child restraint would be too close to  
the inflating air bag.  
65D609  
2-37  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Supplemental Restraint System (advanced air bags):  
3, 9, 12  
BEFORE DRIVING  
A-ELR type belt  
EXAMPLE  
A-ELR type belt  
EXAMPLE  
Installation with Lap-Shoulder Seat  
Belts (child restraint with no top  
strap)  
A-ELR type belt  
EXAMPLE  
83E035  
83E032  
1) Pull all of the remaining webbing out of  
the retractor. You will hear a click, which  
means that the emergency locking  
retractor (ELR) has converted to func-  
tion as an automatic locking retractor  
(ALR).  
2) Allow the extra webbing to retract, and  
pull the webbing toward the retractor to  
take up any slack. Make sure that the  
lap portion of the belt is tight around the  
child restraint system and the shoulder  
portion of the belt is positioned so that it  
cannot interfere with the child’s head or  
neck.  
83E031  
Install your child restraint system accord-  
ing to the instructions provided by the child  
restraint system manufacturer. If you install  
the child restraint system in the front seat,  
be sure to slide the seat to the rearmost  
position. After making sure that the seat  
belt is securely latched:  
2-38  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Supplemental Restraint System (advanced air bags):  
3, 9, 12  
BEFORE DRIVING  
A-ELR type belt  
EXAMPLE  
A-ELR type belt  
EXAMPLE  
WARNING  
Before installing a child restraint in  
the rear center seat, follow these  
steps for secure installation:  
• Make sure the detachable connec-  
tor is securely latched and the web-  
bing is not twisted.  
• Make sure the seat belt is passed  
through the seat belt guide.  
Move to check  
83E036  
65D234  
3) Make sure that the retractor has con-  
verted to the ALR mode by trying to pull  
webbing out of the retractor. If the  
retractor is in the ALR mode, the belt  
will be locked.  
A-ELR type belt  
EXAMPLE  
Pull to tighten  
WARNING  
If the retractor is not in the ALR  
mode, the child restraint system can  
move or tip over when your vehicle  
turns or stops abruptly.  
65D235  
4) Try moving the child restraint system in  
all directions, to make sure it is securely  
installed. If you need to tighten the belt,  
pull more webbing toward the retractor.  
2-39  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Supplemental Restraint System (advanced air bags):  
3, 9, 12  
BEFORE DRIVING  
To revert from ALR to ELR  
EXAMPLE  
Installation with the LATCH System  
EXAMPLE  
Rigid lower connecting  
bar type  
Flexible lower connecting  
strap type  
80JM080  
65D267  
65D337  
Your vehicle is equipped with lower  
anchors for securing up to one or two stan-  
dard LATCH-type child restraint(s) in the  
rear seats. (LATCH stands for Lower  
Anchors and Tethers for Children.)  
The anchors are located where the rear of  
the seat cushion meets the bottom of the  
seatback.  
When you unbuckle the seat belt and allow  
it to retract to a certain length, the retractor  
will automatically revert back to the normal  
ELR mode.  
2-40  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Supplemental Restraint System (advanced air bags):  
3, 9, 12  
BEFORE DRIVING  
SX4 SEDAN  
NOTE:  
Although there are three rear seating posi-  
tions, you cannot install three LATCH type  
child restraints in the rear seats. You can  
install one or two LATCH restraint(s). Be  
sure to install the LATCH type child  
restraint(s) in the outboard seating posi-  
tions.  
EXAMPLE  
If your LATCH restraint has flexible lower  
connecting straps, these general instruc-  
tions apply:  
1) If possible, fold the seatback rearward  
for easier installation.  
EXAMPLE  
65D340  
80JC028  
EXAMPLE  
3) Snap the strap hooks to the anchors.  
Take care not to pinch your fingers.  
For SX4 SEDAN, the covers marked with  
the child restraint symbol as shown in the  
illustration indicate the presence of lower  
anchors. Remove the covers before install-  
ing the child restraint system. Cover the  
lower anchors when not in use.  
Install the LATCH-type child restraint sys-  
tem according to the instructions provided  
by the child restraint system manufacturer.  
After installing, try moving the child  
restraint system in all directions, especially  
forward to make sure the flexible straps or  
rigid connecting bars are securely latched  
to the anchors.  
73K017  
2) Place the child restraint in the rear seat,  
feeding the strap hooks through the  
slots in the seat cushion or the slots in  
the seatback bottom.  
2-41  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
If your LATCH restraint has rigid lower con-  
necting bars, these general instructions  
apply:  
EXAMPLE  
EXAMPLE  
1) If possible, fold the seatback rearward  
for easier installation.  
EXAMPLE  
65D341  
65D342  
4) Return the seatback to the normal,  
upright position. Tighten the lower  
straps as described in the child restraint  
owner’s manual. Attach the top tether  
strap, if applicable.  
5) Make sure the child restraint is securely  
fastened by trying to move the child  
restraint system in all directions, espe-  
cially forward.  
78F114  
2) Place the child restraint in the rear seat,  
inserting the connecting bars through  
the slots in the seat cushion or the slots  
in the seatback bottom.  
WARNING  
The seatback should always be  
securely latched in a fairly upright  
position when any type of child seat  
is installed. An unlatched or reclined  
seatback will reduce the intended  
effectiveness of the child restraint  
system.  
2-42  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
EXAMPLE  
EXAMPLE  
EXAMPLE  
54G183  
54G184  
54G185  
3) Use your hands to carefully align the  
connecting bar tips with the anchors.  
Take care not to pinch your fingers.  
4) Push the child restraint toward the  
anchors so that the connecting bar tips  
are partially hooked to the anchors.  
Use your hands to confirm the position.  
5) Grasp the front of the child restraint and  
push the child restraint forcefully to  
latch the connecting bars. Make sure  
they are securely latched by trying to  
move the child restraint system in all  
directions, especially forward.  
6) Return the seatback if folded. Attach  
the top tether strap, if applicable.  
WARNING  
The seatback should always be  
securely latched in a fairly upright  
position when any type of child seat  
is installed. An unlatched or reclined  
seatback will reduce the intended  
effectiveness of the child restraint  
system.  
2-43  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Some child restraint systems require the  
use of a top strap. Top strap anchor brack-  
ets are provided in your vehicle at the loca-  
tions shown in the illustrations. Install the  
child restraint system as follows:  
1) For SX4, remove the luggage compart-  
ment cover.  
Installation of Child Restraint with  
Top Strap  
Type 1  
SX4  
EXAMPLE  
Front  
2) Secure the child restraint on the rear  
seat using the procedure described  
above for securing a restraint system  
that does not require a top strap.  
3) For SX4 SEDAN, open the cover that is  
marked with the anchor bracket symbol  
to access the anchor bracket. Close the  
cover when not using the anchor  
bracket.  
Type 2  
4) Hook the top strap to the anchor  
bracket and tighten the top strap  
according to the instructions provided  
by the child restraint system manufac-  
turer. Be sure to attach the top strap to  
the corresponding anchor located  
directly behind the child restraint. Do  
not attach the top strap to the luggage  
restraint loops (if equipped).  
80JS072  
SX4 SEDAN  
EXAMPLE  
Front  
Type 3  
WARNING  
Do not attach the child restraint top  
strap to the luggage restraint loops  
(if equipped). Incorrectly attached top  
strap will reduce the intended effec-  
tiveness of the child restraint system.  
80JC029  
80JC102  
2-44  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
5) When routing the top strap, be sure to  
pass the top strap as shown in the illus-  
tration. For SX4 SEDAN, if the top strap  
cannot be properly tightened when  
passed under the head restraint as  
shown in the Type 1 and Type 2 illustra-  
tions, pass the top strap over the top of  
the head restraint as shown in the Type  
• A seat belt extender should only be used  
for the person, vehicle and seating loca-  
tion it was provided for.  
Seat Belt Extender  
• When using the extender, ensure that  
both ends are latched securely. Do not  
use the extender if the open end of the  
extender’s buckle is within 152 mm (6  
inches) of the center of the occupant’s  
body (See diagram). Use of the extender  
when the buckle is too close to the cen-  
ter of the body could increase the risk of  
abdominal injury in the event of an acci-  
dent, and could cause the shoulder belt  
to be positioned incorrectly.  
3
illustration. (Refer to “Head  
Restraints” section for details on how to  
raise or lower the head restraint.)  
6) Make sure that cargo does not interfere  
with routing of the top strap.  
• Make sure to use the correct buckle cor-  
responding to your seating position.  
• Seat belt extenders are not intended for  
use by pregnant women, and should  
only be used upon approval by their  
medical advisors.  
65D613  
(1) Center of body  
(2) Less than 152 mm (6 inches)  
(3) Open end of extender buckle  
• Remove and stow the extender when it  
is not being used.  
If a seat belt cannot be fastened securely  
because it is not long enough, see your  
authorized SUZUKI dealer for a seat belt  
extender. Seat belt extenders are available  
for each seating position except for the  
rear center position. After inspecting the  
relationship between the seat belt length,  
the occupant’s body size, and the seat  
adjustment (the driver’s seat should always  
be adjusted as far back as possible while  
still maintaining control of the vehicle, and  
other adjustable seats should be adjusted  
as far back as possible), your dealer can  
select the appropriate seat belt extender.  
2-45  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Your vehicle is equipped with a seat belt  
pretensioner system at the front seating  
positions. You can use the pretensioner  
seat belts in the same manner as ordinary  
seat belts.  
Seat Belt Pretensioner System  
(for front seat belt only)  
WARNING  
Failure to follow these instructions  
may increase the risk of injury in a  
crash.  
The seat belt pretensioner system works  
with the SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT  
SYSTEM (advanced air bags). The crash  
sensors and the electronic controller of the  
air bag system also control the seat belt  
pretensioners. The pretensioners are trig-  
gered only when there is a frontal or side  
crash severe enough to trigger the air bags  
and the seat belts are fastened. If the seat  
belts are not fastened, the respective pre-  
tensioner system will not be activated. For  
precautions and general information  
including servicing the pretensioner sys-  
tem, refer to the “Supplemental Restraint  
System (air bags)” section in addition to  
this “Seat Belt Pretensioner System” sec-  
tion, and follow all those precautions.  
• Only use an extender for the per-  
son, vehicle and seating position it  
was provided for.  
• Do not use if open end of  
extender’s buckle is within 152 mm  
(6 inches) of center of occupant’s  
body (See diagram).  
• Remove and stow the extender  
when it is not being used.  
EXAMPLE  
52D011  
WARNING  
This section of the owner’s manual  
describes your SUZUKI’s SEAT BELT  
PRETENSIONER SYSTEM. Please  
read and follow ALL these instruc-  
tions carefully to minimize your risk  
of severe injury or death.  
The pretensioner is located in each front  
seat belt retractor. The pretensioner tight-  
ens the seat belt so the belt fits the occu-  
pant’s body more snugly in the event of a  
frontal or side crash. The retractors will  
remain locked after the pretensioners are  
activated. Upon activation, some noise will  
occur and some smoke may be released.  
These conditions are not harmful and do  
not indicate a fire in the vehicle.  
2-46  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
The driver and all passengers must be  
properly restrained by wearing seat belts  
at all times, whether or not a pretensioner  
is equipped at their seating position, to  
help minimize the risk of severe injury or  
death in the event of a crash.  
Service on or around the pretensioner sys-  
tem components or wiring must be per-  
formed only by an authorized SUZUKI  
dealer who is specially trained. Improper  
service could result in unintended activa-  
tion of pretensioners or could render the  
pretensioner inoperative. Either of these  
two conditions may result in personal  
injury.  
Supplemental Restraint  
System (air bags)  
EXAMPLE  
Sit fully back in the seat; sit up straight; do  
not lean forward or sideways. Adjust the  
belt so the lap portion of the belt is worn  
low across the pelvis, not across the waist.  
Please refer to the “Seat Adjustment” sec-  
tion and the instructions and precautions  
about the seat belts in this “Seat Belts and  
Child Restraint Systems” section for details  
on proper seat and seat belt adjustments.  
Please note that the pretensioners along  
with the air bags will activate only in severe  
frontal or side collisions. They are not  
designed to activate in rear impacts, roll-  
overs or minor frontal collisions. The pre-  
tensioners can be activated only once. If  
the pretensioners are activated (that is, if  
the air bags are activated), have the pre-  
tensioner system serviced by an autho-  
rized SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible.  
To prevent damage or unintended activa-  
tion of the pretensioners, be sure the bat-  
tery is disconnected and the ignition switch  
has been in the “LOCK” position for at least  
90 seconds before performing any electri-  
cal service work on your SUZUKI. Do not  
touch pretensioner system components or  
wiring. The wires are wrapped with yellow  
tape or yellow tubing, and the couplers are  
yellow. When scrapping your SUZUKI, ask  
your SUZUKI dealer, body repair shop or  
scrap yard for assistance.  
54G022  
WARNING  
This section of the owner’s manual  
describes the protection provided by  
your  
SUZUKI’s  
SUPPLEMENTAL  
RESTRAINT SYSTEM (air bags).  
Please read and follow ALL these  
instructions carefully to minimize  
your risk of severe injury or death in  
the event of a collision.  
If the AIR BAG light on the instrument clus-  
ter does not blink or come on briefly when  
the ignition switch is turned to the “ON”  
position, stays on for more than 10 sec-  
onds, or comes on while driving, the pre-  
tensioner system or the air bag system  
may not work properly. Have both systems  
inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer  
as soon as possible.  
Your vehicle has advanced front air bags  
and side air bags for the driver and right  
front passenger. Your vehicle also has side  
curtain air bags.  
2-47  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
EXAMPLE  
2
10  
8
1
7
13  
9
8
6
4
9
80J2086  
3
Your vehicle is equipped with a Supple-  
mental Restraint System consisting of the  
following components in addition to a lap-  
shoulder belt at each front seating position.  
11  
14  
12  
11  
1. Driver’s front air bag  
5
2. Front passenger’s front air bag  
3. Seat belt pretensioners  
4. Air bag controller  
5. Driver’s seat position sensors  
6. Occupant classification module  
7. “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator  
8. Forward crash sensors  
9. Side air bags  
3
80J2085  
10.Side curtain air bags  
11.Side crash sensors  
12.Rear side crash sensors  
13.Front passenger’s sensor mat  
14.Seat belt buckle sensors  
2-48  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
The driver’s front air bag is located behind  
the center pad of the steering wheel and  
the front passenger’s front air bag is  
located behind the passenger’s side of the  
dashboard. The words “SRS AIRBAG” are  
molded into the air bag covers to identify  
the location of the air bags.  
Front Air Bags  
EXAMPLE  
63J030  
Frontal collision range  
If the AIR BAG light on the instrument clus-  
ter does not blink or come on when the  
ignition switch is first turned to the “ON”  
position, or the AIR BAG light stays on, or  
comes on while driving, the air bag system  
(or the seat belt pretensioner system) may  
not work properly. Have the air bag system  
inspected by an authorized SUZUKI dealer  
as soon as possible.  
80JS026  
EXAMPLE  
60G032  
Front air bags are designed to inflate only  
in severe frontal collisions.  
80J2009  
2-49  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Front air bags will not inflate  
Front air bags are not designed to inflate in  
rear impacts, side impacts, rollovers or  
minor frontal collisions, since they would  
offer no protection in those types of acci-  
dents. Remember, since air bags deploy  
only one time during an accident, seat  
belts are needed to restrain occupants  
from further movements during the acci-  
dent.  
Side Air Bags and Side Curtain Air  
Bags  
EXAMPLE  
Therefore, an air bag is NOT a substitute  
for seat belts. To maximize your protection,  
ALWAYS WEAR YOUR SEAT BELTS. Be  
aware that no system can prevent all pos-  
sible injuries that may occur in an accident.  
65D236  
WARNING  
Front air bags will probably not inflate  
68KM090  
An air bag supplements, or adds to,  
the crash protection offered by seat  
belts. The driver and all passengers  
must be properly restrained by wear-  
ing seat belts at all times, whether or  
not air bags are mounted at their  
seating position, to minimize the risk  
of severe injury or death in the event  
of a crash.  
Your vehicle has “dual stage” front air  
bags, which adjust the air bag inflation  
force according to crash severity, driver’s  
seat fore/aft position and whether or not  
the front passenger’s seat belt is fastened.  
Also, your vehicle has a front passenger  
sensing system, which turns off the front  
passenger’s front air bag and seat belt pre-  
tensioner under certain conditions.  
65D237  
2-50  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Side collision range  
EXAMPLE  
EXAMPLE  
80J2078  
80JM146  
80JM032  
Side air bags are located in the part of the  
front seatbacks closest to the doors. The  
words “SRS AIRBAG” are indicated on the  
tag to identify the location of the side air  
bags.  
Side curtain air bags are located in the roof  
lining. The words “SRS AIRBAG” are  
molded into the pillar to identify the loca-  
tion of the side curtain air bags.  
Side air bags and side curtain air bags are  
designed to inflate only in severe side  
impact collisions.  
2-51  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
WARNING  
Side air bags and side curtain air bags  
will not inflate  
Side air bags and side curtain air bags  
will probably not inflate  
An air bag supplements, or adds to,  
the crash protection offered by seat  
belts. The driver and all passengers  
must be properly restrained by wear-  
ing seat belts at all times, whether or  
not air bags are mounted at their  
seating position, to minimize the risk  
of severe injury or death in the event  
of a crash.  
WARNING  
If the AIR BAG light in the instrument  
cluster ever comes on and stays on,  
it means that something may be  
wrong with the air bag system. If this  
ever happens, have the vehicle ser-  
viced immediately, because the air  
bags may not offer the protection for  
which they were designed.  
54G027  
54G028  
Side air bags and side curtain air bags are  
not designed to inflate in frontal or rear col-  
lisions, rollovers or minor side collisions,  
since they would offer no protection in  
those types of accidents. Only the side air  
bag and side curtain air bag on the side of  
the vehicle that is struck will inflate.  
Remember, since an air bag deploys only  
one time during an accident, seat belts are  
needed to restrain occupants from further  
movements during the accident.  
Therefore, an air bag is NOT a substitute  
for seat belts. To maximize your protection,  
ALWAYS WEAR YOUR SEAT BELTS. Be  
aware that no system can prevent all pos-  
sible injuries that may occur in an accident.  
2-52  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Driver’s Seat Position Sensor  
Front Passenger’s Seat Belt Buckle  
Sensor  
Front Passenger Sensing System  
The front passenger sensing system will  
turn off the front passenger’s front air bag  
and seat belt pretensioner under certain  
conditions. This system works using a sen-  
sor mat that is part of the front passenger’s  
seat. The front passenger sensing system  
is designed to detect whether an occupant  
is present in the seat and, if an occupant is  
present, to determine whether the front  
passenger’s front air bag and seat belt pre-  
tensioner should be enabled or disabled  
(turned off).  
The driver’s seat is equipped with a seat  
position sensor to monitor the driver seat  
fore/aft position. The seat position sensor  
provides information which is used to  
judge if the driver’s front air bag should  
deploy at reduced power or at full power.  
The front passenger’s seat belt buckle is  
equipped with a sensor to monitor whether  
or not the front passenger’s seat belt is fas-  
tened. The front passenger’s seat belt  
buckle sensor provides information which  
is used to judge if the front passenger’s air  
bag should deploy at reduced power or at  
full power.  
CAUTION  
Do not put any cargo or metal objects  
under the seat. The seat position sen-  
sor may not work properly or may be  
damaged if it is covered with some-  
thing.  
WARNING  
When the buckle sensor has a prob-  
lem, the AIR BAG light on the instru-  
ment cluster will turn on. If this  
happens, deployment of the front  
passenger’s air bag will not include  
consideration of whether the front  
passenger’s seat belt is fastened or  
not. Have the air bag system  
inspected by an authorized SUZUKI  
dealer as soon as possible.  
NOTE:  
The front passenger’s side air bag and the  
side curtain air bag are not controlled by  
the front passenger sensing system.  
When the seat position sensor has a prob-  
lem, the AIR BAG light on the instrument  
cluster will turn on. If this happens, deploy-  
ment of the driver’s front air bag will not  
include consideration of seat fore/aft posi-  
tion. Have the air bag system inspected by  
an authorized SUZUKI dealer as soon as  
possible.  
80J2019  
2-53  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
When the ignition switch is turned to the  
“ON” position, the “PASS AIR BAG OFF”  
indicator comes on for several seconds to  
let you know the system is working. When  
the front passenger sensing system has  
turned off the front passenger’s front air  
bag including the seat belt pretensioner,  
the “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator will  
come on and stay on to remind you that  
the front passenger’s front air bag is off.  
NOTE:  
If the front passenger seat is unoccupied,  
the “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator will not  
come on but the front passenger’s front air  
bag will not deploy and the seat belt pre-  
tensioner will not operate.  
If you have secured a child in the front pas-  
senger seat in a forward-facing child  
restraint system or booster seat and the  
PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator light is not  
on, turn the vehicle off, remove the child  
restraint or booster seat from the vehicle  
and reinstall it following the child restraint  
or booster seat manufacturer’s directions.  
Also refer to “Seat Belts and Child  
Restraint Systems” in this section. If, after  
reinstalling the child restraint and restart-  
ing the vehicle, the “PASS AIR BAG OFF”  
indicator is still not lit, check to make sure  
that the vehicle’s seatback is not pressing  
the child restraint into the seat cushion. If  
this happens, slightly recline the vehicle’s  
seatback and adjust the seat cushion if  
possible. Also make sure the child restraint  
is not trapped under the vehicle head  
restraint. If this happens, adjust the head  
restraint. If the “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indi-  
cator is still not on, secure the child in the  
child restraint or booster seat in a rear seat  
position in the vehicle and check with your  
dealer.  
The front passenger sensing system uses  
front seat pressure measurements and  
pressure locations to determine whether to  
activate or deactivate the front passenger’s  
front air bag. The front passenger sensing  
system may or may not turn off the front air  
bag, depending on the front passenger’s  
seating posture and body build. The air  
bag should be turned off in the following  
situations:  
• There is no occupant in the front pas-  
senger seat.  
• The occupant of the front passenger  
seat lifts his or her weight off of the seat  
for a period of time.  
• The occupant of the front passenger  
seat is an infant or small child in a child  
restraint system or a small child in a  
booster seat.  
• A smaller person, such as a child who  
has outgrown child restraints or a very  
small adolescent is seated in the front  
passenger seat.  
65D607  
WARNING  
Do not install a rear-facing child  
restraint in the front passenger’s  
seat. If the passenger’s front air bag  
inflates, a child in a rear-facing child  
restraint could be seriously injured.  
The back of  
a
rear-facing child  
restraint would be too close to the  
inflating air bag.  
According to accident statistics, children  
are safer when properly restrained in rear  
seating positions than in front seating posi-  
tions. Whenever possible, SUZUKI recom-  
mends you install child restraints in the  
rear seat.  
2-54  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
The front passenger sensing system is  
designed to enable the front passenger’s  
front air bag when the system senses a  
properly-seated adult in the front passen-  
ger’s seat. When the passenger sensing  
system has allowed the air bag to be  
enabled, the “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indica-  
tor will remain off to remind you that the air  
bag is active.  
WARNING  
The front passenger sensing system  
may not work properly in the follow-  
ing situations:  
• The occupant is sitting near the  
dashboard or is not sitting in the  
proper position.  
• Objects placed under the seat are  
pushing up on the seat cushion.  
If a person of adult size is sitting in the  
front passenger’s seat and the “PASS AIR  
BAG OFF” indicator comes on, it could be  
because that person isn’t sitting properly in  
the seat. If this happens, unfasten the seat  
belts, sit upright in the center of the seat  
with the seatback nearly vertical and your  
legs outstretched, and refasten the seat  
belt.  
WARNING  
If the “PASS AIR BAG OFF” indicator  
on the instrument panel turns on  
even though there is no occupant or  
an adult occupant in the front pas-  
senger’s seat, it means that some-  
thing may be wrong with the  
passenger sensing system. Have the  
system inspected by an authorized  
SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible.  
52D258  
When seated as shown in the above illus-  
tration, the front passenger sensing sys-  
tem senses a properly-seated occupant  
and enables the air bag.  
When using a seat belt extender, follow the  
instructions in the “Seat Belt Extender”  
section.  
WARNING  
Do not place any heavy objects on  
the front passenger’s seat. The pres-  
sure sensors in the sensor mat could  
be damaged and the front passenger  
sensing system may not work prop-  
erly.  
2-55  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Air bags must inflate quickly and forcefully  
in order to reduce the chance of serious or  
fatal injuries. However, an unavoidable  
consequence of the quick inflation is that  
the air bag may irritate bare skin, such as  
the facial area against a front air bag. Also,  
upon inflation, a loud noise will occur and  
some powder and smoke will be released.  
These conditions are not harmful and do  
not indicate a fire in the car. Be aware,  
however, that some air bag components  
may be hot for a while after inflation.  
How the System Works  
In a frontal collision, the crash sensors will  
detect rapid deceleration and send a signal  
to the controller. If the controller judges  
that the deceleration represents a severe  
frontal crash, the controller will trigger the  
inflators. The controller also judges:  
• Whether the front air bags should deploy  
at reduced power or at full power accord-  
ing to crash severity.  
WARNING  
• Do not spill any liquids on the seat.  
Liquids can damage the sensors  
under the front seat.  
• Have the driver’s seat position sen-  
sor and the front passenger’s sen-  
sor mat inspected by your dealer  
after a collision.  
• Do not replace the front seats. If  
you replace them, the air bags and  
front passenger sensing system  
may not work properly.  
• Do not use a seat cover. If you use  
a seat cover, the front passenger  
sensing system may not work prop-  
erly.  
• Whether the air bags should deploy at  
reduced power or at full power according  
to crash severity, driver’s seat fore/aft  
position and whether or not the front  
passenger’s seat belt is fastened.  
• Whether the front passenger’s front air  
bag should deploy or not based on clas-  
sification of the occupant of the front  
passenger’s seat.  
A seat belt helps keep you in the proper  
position for maximum protection when an  
air bag inflates. Adjust your seat as far  
back as possible while still maintaining  
control of the vehicle. Sit fully back in your  
seat; sit up straight; do not lean over the  
steering wheel or dashboard. Front occu-  
pants should not lean on or sleep against  
the door. Please refer to the “Seat Adjust-  
ment” section and the “Seat Belts and  
Child Restraint Systems” section in the  
“BEFORE DRIVING” section for details on  
proper seat and seat belt adjustments.  
Since your vehicle is equipped with side air  
bags, and side curtain air bags, crash sen-  
sors will detect a side collision, and if the  
controller judges that the side collision is  
severe enough, it will trigger the side air  
bag and side curtain air bag inflators.  
The inflators inflate the appropriate air  
bags with nitrogen or argon gas. The  
inflated air bags provide a cushion for your  
head (front air bags and side curtain air  
bags only) and upper body. The air bag  
inflates and deflates so quickly that you  
may not even realize that it has activated.  
The air bag will neither hinder your view  
nor make it harder to exit the vehicle.  
2-56  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Note that even though your vehicle may be  
moderately damaged in a collision, the col-  
lision may not have been severe enough to  
trigger the front, side, or side curtain air  
bags to inflate. If your car sustains ANY  
front-end or side damage, have the air bag  
system inspected by an authorized  
SUZUKI dealer to ensure it is in proper  
working order.  
WARNING  
• The driver should not lean over the  
steering wheel. The front passen-  
ger should not rest his or her body  
against the dashboard, or other-  
wise get too close to the dash-  
board. For vehicles with side air  
bags and side curtain air bags,  
occupants should not lean on or  
sleep against the door. In these sit-  
uations, the out-of-position occu-  
pant would be too close to an  
inflating air bag, and may suffer  
severe injury.  
• Do not attach any objects to, or  
place any objects over, the steering  
wheel or dashboard. Do not place  
any objects between the air bag  
and the driver or front passenger.  
These objects may interfere with air  
bag operation or may be propelled  
by the air bag in the event of a  
crash. Either of these conditions  
may cause severe injury.  
Your vehicle is equipped with a diagnostic  
module which records information about  
the air bag system if the air bags deploy in  
a crash. The module records information  
about overall system status, which sensors  
activated the deployment, and whether the  
front seat belts were in use.  
65D610  
• For vehicles with side air bags, do  
not place seat covers on the front  
seats, because seat covers could  
restrict the air bag’s inflation. Also,  
do not place any cup holders or  
other objects on the door, as these  
objects could be propelled by the  
air bag in the event of a crash.  
Either of these conditions may  
cause severe injury.  
54G582  
2-57  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
To prevent damage or unintended inflation  
of the air bag system, be sure the battery  
is disconnected and the ignition switch has  
been in the “LOCK” position for at least 90  
seconds before performing any electrical  
service work on your SUZUKI. Do not  
touch air bag system components or wires.  
The wires are wrapped with yellow tape or  
yellow tubing, and the couplers are yellow  
for easy identification.  
If it is necessary to modify the advanced  
front air bag system to accommodate a  
person with disabilities, owners in the con-  
tinental United States can call American  
Suzuki toll-free at 1-800-934-0934, or write  
to:  
Servicing the Air Bag System  
If the air bags inflate, have the air bags and  
related components replaced by an autho-  
rized SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible.  
If your vehicle ever gets in deep water and  
the driver’s floor is submerged, the air bag  
controller could be damaged. If this hap-  
pens, have the air bag system inspected  
by the SUZUKI dealer as soon as possible.  
American Suzuki Motor Corporation  
Automotive Customer Relations  
3251 East Imperial Highway  
Brea, CA 92821-6795  
Special procedures are required for servic-  
ing or replacing an air bag. For that reason,  
only an authorized SUZUKI dealer should  
be allowed to service or replace your air  
bags. Please remind anyone who services  
your SUZUKI that it has air bags.  
Scrapping a car that has an undeployed air  
bag can be hazardous. Ask your dealer,  
body repair shop or scrap yard for help  
with disposal.  
If you purchased your SUZUKI in Canada  
please contact the Suzuki Canada Cus-  
tomer Relations Department by telephone  
at 1-905-889-2677 extension 2254 or in  
writing at:  
Suzuki Canada Inc.  
Customer Relations  
100 East Beaver Creek Road  
Richmond Hill, On  
L4B 1J6  
Service on or around air bag components  
or wiring must be performed only by an  
authorized SUZUKI dealer. Improper ser-  
vice could result in unintended air bag  
deployment or could render the air bags  
inoperative. Either of these two conditions  
may result in severe injury.  
2-58  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Instrument Cluster  
1. Speedometer  
2. Tachometer  
3. Fuel gauge  
4. Temperature gauge  
5. Information display  
6. Trip meter selector knob  
7. Indicator selector knob  
8. Warning and indicator lights  
EXAMPLE  
2
4
8
3
1
8
6
5
7
8
80J2020  
2-59  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
WARNING  
inflation pressure as specified in the vehi-  
cle placard and owner’s manual.  
Warning and Indicator Lights  
Low Tire Pressure Warning Light  
The low tire pressure warning light is also  
used to inform you of a TPMS malfunction.  
When the system detects a malfunction,  
this light will flash for approximately one  
minute and then remain continuously illu-  
minated. This sequence will be repeated  
approximately ten minutes after subse-  
quent the ignition switch is turned on as  
long as the malfunction exists.  
The load rating of your tires is  
reduced at lower inflation pressures.  
If your tires become even moderately  
under-inflated, the vehicle load may  
exceed the load rating of the tires,  
which can lead to tire failure. The low  
tire pressure warning light will not  
alert you of this condition. The warn-  
ing light will only come on when one  
or more of your tires become signifi-  
cantly under-inflated. Check and  
adjust your tire inflation pressure at  
least once a month. Refer to “Tires”  
in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTE-  
NANCE” section.  
52D305  
As an added safety feature, your vehicle  
has been equipped with a tire pressure  
monitoring system (TPMS) that uses a low  
tire pressure warning light to inform you  
when one or more of your tires is signifi-  
cantly under-inflated.  
NOTE:  
The low tire pressure warning light may not  
come on immediately if you have a sudden  
loss of air pressure.  
WARNING  
When the ignition switch is turned to the  
“ON” position, this light comes on briefly so  
you can check that the light is working.  
If the low tire pressure warning light  
does not come on when the ignition  
is turned to the “ON” position, or  
comes on and blinks while driving  
there may be a problem with the tire  
pressure monitoring system. Have  
your vehicle inspected by an autho-  
rized SUZUKI dealer. Even if the light  
turns off after blinking, indicating  
that monitoring system has recov-  
ered, make sure to have an autho-  
rized SUZUKI dealer check the  
system.  
When the low tire pressure warning light is  
lit, one or more of your tires is significantly  
under-inflated. You should stop and check  
your tires as soon as possible, and inflate  
them to the proper pressure as indicated  
on the vehicle’s tire information placard.  
Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire  
causes the tire to overheat and can lead to  
tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces  
fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may  
affect the vehicle’s handling and stopping  
ability. Each tire, including the spare,  
should be checked at least once a month  
when cold and set to the recommended  
2-60  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Refer to “Tire Pressure Monitoring System”  
in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” sec-  
tion for additional details on the tire pres-  
sure monitoring system. Refer to “Tires” in  
the “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE”  
section for information on maintaining  
proper tire pressure.  
Brake System Warning Light  
WARNING  
If the low tire pressure warning light  
comes on and stays on, reduce your  
speed and avoid abrupt steering and  
braking. Stop in a safe place as soon  
as possible and check your tires.  
• If you have a flat tire, replace it with  
the spare tire. Refer to “Jacking  
Instructions” in the “EMERGENCY  
65D477  
This light comes on briefly when the igni-  
tion switch is turned to the “ON” position.  
The light also comes on under the follow-  
ing conditions: 1) when the parking brake  
is engaged and 2) when the fluid in the  
brake fluid reservoir falls below the speci-  
fied level. The light should go out after fully  
releasing the parking brake, if the fluid  
level in the brake fluid reservoir is ade-  
quate.  
If this light and the ABS warning light stay  
on, or come on simultaneously when driv-  
ing, then there may be something wrong  
with both the rear brake proportioning  
valve function and anti-lock function of the  
ABS.  
SERVICE”  
section.  
Refer  
to  
“Replacing Tires and/or Wheels”  
for instructions on how to restore  
normal operation of the tire pres-  
sure monitoring system after you  
have had a flat tire.  
• If one or more of your tires is  
under-inflated, adjust the inflation  
pressure in all of your tires to the  
recommended inflation pressure as  
soon as possible.  
Be aware that driving on a signifi-  
cantly under-inflated tire can cause  
the tire to overheat and can lead to  
tire failure, and may affect steering  
control and brake effectiveness. This  
could lead to an accident, resulting in  
severe injury or death.  
If the brake system warning light comes on  
while you are driving the vehicle, it may  
mean that there is something wrong with  
the vehicle’s brake system. If this happens,  
you should:  
2-61  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
1) Pull off the road and stop carefully.  
NOTE:  
For details of the ABS, refer to “Anti-Lock  
Brake System (ABS)” in the “OPERATING  
YOUR VEHICLE” section.  
Because the disc brake system is self-  
adjusting, the fluid level will drop as the  
brake pads become worn.  
WARNING  
Remember that stopping distance  
may be longer, you may have to push  
harder on the pedal, and the pedal  
may go down farther than normal.  
Replenishing the brake fluid reservoir is  
considered normal periodic maintenance.  
SLIP Indicator Light (if equipped)  
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)  
Warning Light  
2) Test the brakes by carefully starting and  
stopping on the shoulder of the road.  
3) If you determine that it is safe, drive  
cautiously at low speed to the nearest  
dealer for repairs,  
52KM133  
®
ESP is a registered trademark of Daimler  
or  
AG.  
4) Have the vehicle towed to the nearest  
dealer for repairs.  
65D529  
This light blinks 5 times per second when  
When the ignition switch is turned to the  
“ON” position, the light comes on briefly so  
you can check that the light is working. If  
the light stays on, or comes on when driv-  
ing, there may be something wrong with  
the ABS.  
WARNING  
®
one of the ESP systems other than ABS  
If any of the following conditions  
occur, you should immediately ask  
your SUZUKI dealer to inspect the  
brake system.  
• If the brake system warning light  
does not go out after the parking  
brake has been fully released.  
• If the brake system warning light  
does not come on when the igni-  
tion switch is turned to the “ON”  
position.  
is activated. If this light blinks, drive care-  
fully.  
When the ignition switch is turned to the  
“ON” position, the light comes on briefly so  
you can check that the light is working. If  
the light stays on, or comes on when driv-  
ing and remains on, there may be some-  
If the ABS light and the brake system  
warning light stay on, or come on simulta-  
neously when driving, then there may be  
something wrong with both the rear brake  
proportioning valve function and anti-lock  
function of the ABS.  
®
thing wrong with the ESP systems (other  
than ABS). You should have the system  
inspected by an authorized SUZUKI  
dealer.  
• If the brake system warning light  
comes on at any time during vehi-  
cle operation.  
If one of these happens, have the system  
inspected by your SUZUKI dealer. If the  
ABS becomes inoperative, the brake sys-  
tem will function as an ordinary brake sys-  
tem that has no ABS.  
2-62  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
NOTE:  
“ESP” (Electronic Stability  
Program) Warning Light  
(if equipped)  
“ESP OFF” Indicator Light  
(if equipped)  
When you disconnect and re-connect the  
®
battery, ESP system functions other than  
ABS will be deactivated and the slip indica-  
tor light will blink 1 time per second. For  
®
details on how to reactive the ESP sys-  
tems, refer to “SLIP Indicator Light” in the  
“OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.  
®
For details of the ESP systems, refer to  
®
“Electronic Stability Program (ESP )” in  
66J032  
the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” sec-  
tion.  
66J031  
When the ignition switch is turned to the  
“ON” position, this light comes on briefly so  
you can check that the light is working.  
When the ignition switch is turned to the  
“ON” position, the light comes on briefly so  
you can check that the light is working. If  
the light stays on, or comes on when driv-  
ing, there may be something wrong with  
the ESP systems (other than ABS). You  
should have the system inspected by an  
authorized SUZUKI dealer.  
WARNING  
®
When the “ESP OFF” switch is pushed to  
The ESP systems cannot prevent  
®
turn off the ESP systems (other than  
accidents. Always drive carefully.  
ABS), the “ESP OFF” light comes on and  
stays on.  
®
®
For details of the ESP systems, refer to  
®
“Electronic Stability Program (ESP )” in  
®
For details of the ESP systems, refer to  
the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” sec-  
tion.  
®
“Electronic Stability Program (ESP )” in  
the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” sec-  
tion.  
2-63  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Oil Pressure Light  
Charging Light  
Driver’s Seat Belt Reminder Light  
50G051  
50G052  
60G049  
This light comes on when the ignition  
switch is turned to the “ON” position, and  
goes out when the engine is started. The  
light will come on and remain on if there is  
insufficient oil pressure. If the light comes  
on when driving, pull off the road as soon  
as you can and stop the engine. Check the  
oil level and add oil if necessary. If there is  
enough oil, the lubrication system should  
be inspected by your SUZUKI dealer  
before you drive the vehicle again.  
This light comes on when the ignition  
switch is turned to the “ON” position, and  
goes out when the engine is started. The  
light will come on and remain on if there is  
something wrong with the battery charging  
system. If the light comes on when the  
engine is running, the charging system  
should be inspected immediately by your  
SUZUKI dealer.  
If the driver’s seat belt is unbuckled when  
the ignition switch is turned to the “ON”  
position, this light will come on and then  
blink. When the light comes on, a buzzer  
will also sound intermittently for about 6  
seconds. The reminder will repeat several  
times under certain conditions until the  
driver’s seat belt is buckled. After repeating  
several times, the reminder will be can-  
celed even if the driver’s seat belt remains  
unbuckled.  
For details about the seat belt reminder,  
refer to “Seat Belts and Child Restraint  
Systems” in this section.  
CAUTION  
• If you operate the engine with this  
light on, severe engine damage can  
result.  
• Do not rely on the Oil Pressure  
Light to indicate the need to add  
oil. Be sure to periodically check  
the engine oil level.  
WARNING  
It is absolutely essential that the  
driver and passengers wear their seat  
belts at all times. Persons who are  
not wearing seat belts have a much  
greater risk of injury if an accident  
occurs. Make a regular habit of buck-  
ling your seat belt before putting the  
key in the ignition.  
2-64  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
AIR BAG Light  
Malfunction Indicator Light  
CAUTION  
Continuing to drive the vehicle when  
the malfunction indicator light is on  
or blinking can cause permanent  
damage to the vehicle’s emission  
control system, and can affect fuel  
economy and driveability.  
63J030  
65D530  
This light monitors inflators, crash sensors,  
seat belt pretensioners, the front passen-  
ger sensing system, and corresponding  
electrical circuits.  
This light blinks or comes on for several  
seconds when the ignition switch is turned  
to the “ON” position so you can check if the  
light is working. The light will come on and  
stay on if there is a problem in the air bag  
system or the seat belt pretensioner sys-  
tem.  
Your vehicle has a computer-controlled  
emission control system. A malfunction  
indicator light is provided on the instrument  
panel to indicate when it is necessary to  
have the emission control system serviced.  
The malfunction indicator light comes on  
when the ignition switch is turned to the  
“ON” position to let you know the light is  
working and goes out when the engine is  
started.  
NOTE:  
If the fuel filler cap is not installed fully, the  
electrical system gets wet (such as by driv-  
ing through a deep puddle of water) or the  
fuel tank gets nearly empty, the malfunc-  
tion indicator light may come on. If so, the  
light will go off after driving a few times  
after the fuel filler cap is installed fully, the  
electrical system dries out or the fuel tank  
is filled.  
If the malfunction indicator light comes on  
or blinks when the engine is running, ser-  
vice to the emission control system is nec-  
essary. Bring the vehicle to your SUZUKI  
dealer to have the emission control system  
serviced right away and avoid hard accel-  
eration until the service is performed.  
Also, if the light comes on, there may be  
something wrong with the continuously  
variable transaxle system. Have the sys-  
tem inspected by an authorized SUZUKI  
dealer.  
WARNING  
If the AIR BAG light does not blink or  
come on when the ignition switch is  
turned to the “ON” position or stays  
on or comes on when driving, the air  
bag system or the seat belt preten-  
sioner system may not work properly.  
Have both systems inspected by an  
authorized SUZUKI dealer.  
2-65  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
If any door (including the tailgate of SX4) is  
open when the vehicle is moving, a ding  
sounds to remind you to close all doors  
completely.  
Low Fuel Warning Light  
Keyless Start System Indicator  
Light (if equipped)  
“CRUISE” Indicator Light  
(if equipped)  
54G343  
80JM122  
If this light comes on, fill the fuel tank  
immediately.  
When this light comes on, a ding sounds  
once to remind you to fill the fuel.  
If you do not fill the fuel, a ding sounds  
every time when the ignition switch is  
turned to “ON”.  
When you push the ignition switch for vehi-  
cle with the keyless start system, this light  
will come on in blue or red. If this light  
comes on in blue, you can turn the ignition  
switch without using an ignition key. If this  
light comes on in red, you cannot turn the  
ignition switch without using an ignition  
key. For details, refer to “Ignition Switch” in  
the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” sec-  
tion.  
52D113  
When the cruise control system is on, this  
light will be on.  
NOTE:  
The activation point of this light varies  
depending on road conditions (for exam-  
ple, slope or curve) and driving conditions  
because of fuel moving in the tank.  
“SET” Indicator Light (if equipped)  
If this light blinks in red, it reminds you that  
the remote controller is not in the vehicle.  
For details, refer to “Keyless Start System  
Remote Controller/Keyless Entry System  
Transmitter” in this section.  
Open Door Warning Light  
65D474  
When the vehicle’s speed is controlled by  
the cruise control system, this light will be  
on.  
54G391  
This light remains on until all doors (includ-  
ing the tailgate of SX4) are completely  
closed.  
2-66  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
system inspected by an authorized  
SUZUKI dealer.  
Illumination Indicator Light  
High Beam Indicator Light  
If the oil temperature of the parts for i-AWD  
system is high, this light will blink. The “i-  
AWD AUTO” or “i-AWD LOCK” mode will  
be changed to the “2WD” mode automati-  
cally to prevent a damage of the parts for i-  
AWD system.  
64J045  
50G056  
NOTE:  
This indicator light comes on while the  
position lights, tail light and/or the head-  
lights are on.  
This indicator comes on when headlight  
high beams are turned on.  
If you restart the engine, the light will stop  
blinking temporarily.  
intelligent All Wheel Drive (i-AWD)  
AUTO Indicator Light (if equipped)  
For details, refer to “Using the 2WD/i-AWD  
Switch” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHI-  
CLE” section.  
Turn Signal Indicators  
NOTE:  
When the vehicle speed is increased, the  
“i-AWD LOCK” mode will be changed to  
the “i-AWD AUTO” mode automatically.  
The “i-AWD AUTO” indicator light will come  
on and stay on.  
50G055  
79J040  
When you turn on the left or right turn sig-  
nals, the corresponding green arrow on the  
instrument panel will flash along with the  
respective turn signal lights.  
When you turn on the hazard warning  
switch, both arrows will flash along with all  
of the turn signal lights.  
When the ignition switch is turned to the  
“ON” position, the light comes on briefly so  
you can check that the light is working.  
When the 2WD/i-AWD switch is in the “i-  
AWD AUTO” mode with the ignition switch  
in the “ON” position, the light comes on  
and stays on.  
If the light and the “i-AWD LOCK” indicator  
light stay on or come on simultaneously  
when driving, there may be something  
wrong with the i-AWD system. Have the  
2-67  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
For details of the “i-AWD LOCK” mode,  
refer to “Using the 2WD/i-AWD Switch” in  
the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” sec-  
tion.  
intelligent All Wheel Drive (i-AWD)  
LOCK Indicator Light (if equipped)  
Speedometer  
EXAMPLE  
CAUTION  
Do not operate your vehicle in “i-  
AWD LOCK” mode on dry hard sur-  
faces.  
79J100  
When the ignition switch is turned to the  
“ON” position, this light comes on briefly so  
you can check that the light is working.  
Daytime Running Light (D.R.L.) Indi-  
cator Light (if equipped)  
The light comes on when the 2WD/i-AWD  
switch is changed to the “i-AWD LOCK”  
mode from the “i-AWD AUTO” mode.  
80J2063  
The speedometer indicates vehicle speed  
in km/h and mph.  
If the light and the “i-AWD AUTO” indicator  
light stay on or come on simultaneously  
when driving, there may be something  
wrong with the i-AWD system. Have the  
system inspected by an authorized  
SUZUKI dealer.  
60B245  
With the D.R.L. system, the headlights  
light, but are dimmer than the low beam,  
when the following three conditions are all  
met. Whenever the D.R.L. system is oper-  
ating, the D.R.L. indicator light remains on.  
NOTE:  
• When the vehicle speed is increased,  
the “i-AWD LOCK” mode will be changed  
to the “i-AWD AUTO” mode automati-  
cally. The “i-AWD AUTO” indicator light  
will come on and stay on.  
Conditions for D.R.L. system operation  
1) The engine is running.  
2) The parking brake is released.  
3) The headlights are off.  
• When the ignition switch is turned to the  
“OFF” position, the “i-AWD LOCK” mode  
is canceled.  
2-68  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
If the low fuel warning light (1) comes on,  
fill the fuel tank immediately.  
Tachometer  
Fuel Gauge  
When the low fuel warning light (1) comes  
on, a ding sounds once to remind you to fill  
the fuel.  
EXAMPLE  
(2)  
If you do not fill the fuel, a ding sounds  
every time when the ignition switch is  
turned to “ON”.  
CAUTION  
(1)  
Avoid driving with an extremely low  
fuel level. Running out of fuel could  
cause the engine to misfire, damag-  
ing the catalytic converter.  
80JM101  
80JM102  
NOTE:  
The activation point of the low fuel warning  
light (1) varies depending on road condi-  
tions (for example, slope or curve) and  
driving conditions because of fuel moving  
in the tank.  
The tachometer indicates engine speed in  
revolutions per minute.  
When the ignition switch is in the “ON”  
position, this gauge gives an approximate  
indication of the amount of fuel in the fuel  
tank. “F” stands for full and “E” stands for  
empty.  
CAUTION  
Never drive with the engine speed  
indicator in the red zone or severe  
engine damage can result.  
If the indicator gets off the graduation of  
“E” (not character “E”), refill the tank as  
soon as possible.  
The mark (2) indicates that the fuel filler  
door is located on the left side of the vehi-  
cle.  
NOTE:  
The indicator moves a little depending on  
road conditions (for example, slope or  
curve) and driving conditions because of  
fuel moving in the tank.  
2-69  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Display (E)  
Clock (if equipped)  
Temperature Gauge  
Information display  
Instantaneous Fuel Consumption  
The display (A) shows instantaneous fuel  
consumption with a bar graph only when  
the vehicle is moving.  
(A)  
(C)  
(B)  
EXAMPLE  
(D)  
(E)  
(1)  
(3)  
(2)  
80J2026  
80JM103  
80JM104  
NOTE:  
• The display does not show the bar graph  
unless the vehicle is moving.  
• The indicated maximum value of instan-  
taneous fuel consumption is 80. No  
more than 80 will be indicated on the dis-  
play even if the actual instantaneous fuel  
consumption is higher.  
• The indication on the display may be  
delayed if fuel consumption is greatly  
affected by driving conditions.  
• The display shows estimated values.  
Indications may not be the same as  
actual values.  
When the ignition switch is in the “ON”  
position, this gauge indicates the engine  
coolant temperature. Under normal driving  
conditions, the indicator should stay within  
the normal, acceptable temperature range  
between “H” and “C”. If the indicator  
approaches “H”, overheating is indicated.  
Follow the instructions for engine overheat-  
ing in the “EMERGENCY SERVICE” sec-  
tion.  
(1) Trip meter selector knob  
(2) Indicator selector knob  
(3) Information display  
When the ignition switch is in the “ON”  
position, the information display shows the  
following information.  
Display (A)  
Instantaneous fuel consumption  
Display (B)  
Trip meter / Average fuel consumption /  
Driving range / Thermometer  
CAUTION  
Continuing to drive the vehicle when  
engine overheating is indicated can  
result in severe engine damage.  
Display (C)  
Transaxle selector position indicator  
(for CVT)  
Display (D)  
Odometer / Illumination control setting  
2-70  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
You can turn off or on the indication of  
instantaneous fuel consumption according  
to the following instruction.  
indication of instantaneous fuel con-  
sumption.  
EXAMPLE  
WARNING  
(a)  
EXAMPLE  
If you attempt to adjust the display  
while driving, you could lose control  
of the vehicle.  
Do not attempt to adjust the display  
while driving.  
(b)  
NOTE:  
When you reconnect the negative (–) ter-  
minal to the battery, the indication of the  
instantaneous fuel consumption will be  
reinitialized. Change the indication again to  
your preference.  
80J2027  
1) Change the display (B) to the driving  
range by pushing the indicator selector  
knob (2).  
(c)  
(d)  
(e)  
EXAMPLE  
Trip meter / Average Fuel Consumption /  
Driving Range / Thermometer  
When the ignition switch is in the “ON”  
position, the display (B) shows one of the  
following five indications, trip meter A, trip  
meter B, average fuel consumption, driving  
range or thermometer.  
(Initial  
setting)  
To switch the display indication (B), push  
the trip meter selector knob (1) or the indi-  
cator selector knob (2) quickly.  
80J2029  
Push the trip meter selector  
knob (1).  
80J2028  
2) While pushing and holding the trip  
meter selector knob (1), turn the indica-  
tor selector knob (2) to turn off or on the  
Push the indicator selector  
knob (2).  
2-71  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
(a) Trip meter A  
NOTE:  
Driving range  
(b) Trip meter B  
The indicated maximum value of the trip  
meter is 9999.9. When you run past the  
maximum value, the indicated value will  
return to 0.0.  
If you selected driving range the last time  
you drove the vehicle, the display indicates  
---” for a few seconds and then indicates  
the current driving range when the ignition  
switch is turned to the “ON” position.  
(c) Average fuel consumption  
(d) Driving range  
(e) Thermometer  
Average fuel consumption  
WARNING  
The driving range shown in the display is  
the approximate distance you can drive  
until the fuel gauge indicates “E”, based on  
current driving conditions.  
If you selected average fuel consumption  
the last time you drove the vehicle, the dis-  
play shows the last value of average fuel  
consumption from previous driving when  
the ignition switch is turned to the “ON”  
position. Unless you reset the value of  
average fuel consumption, the display indi-  
cates the value of average fuel consump-  
tion which includes average fuel  
consumption during previous driving.  
If you attempt to adjust the display  
while driving, you could lose control  
of the vehicle.  
When the remaining fuel in fuel tank  
reaches a low level, the display “---” will  
appear.  
Do not attempt to adjust the display  
while driving.  
NOTE:  
If the low fuel warning light comes on, fill  
the fuel tank immediately regardless of the  
value of driving range shown in the display.  
• Indications will change when you push  
and release a knob.  
• The display shows estimated values.  
Indications may not be the same as  
actual values.  
To reset the average fuel consumption to  
zero, push and hold the indicator selector  
knob (2) for a while when the display  
shows the average fuel consumption.  
As the driving range after refueling is cal-  
culated based on the most recent driving  
condition, the value is different each time  
you refuel.  
Trip meter  
The trip meter can be used to measure the  
distance traveled on short trips or between  
fuel stops.  
You can use the trip meter A or trip meter B  
independently.  
NOTE:  
NOTE:  
When you reset the indication or reconnect  
the negative (–) terminal to the battery, the  
value of average fuel consumption will be  
shown after driving for a while.  
• If you refuel when the ignition switch is in  
the “ON” position, the driving range may  
not indicate the correct value.  
• When you reconnect the negative (–) ter-  
minal to the battery, the value of driving  
range will be shown after driving for a  
while.  
To reset the trip meter to zero, push and  
hold the trip meter selector knob (1) for a  
while when the display shows the trip  
meter.  
2-72  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Thermometer  
Transaxle selector position indicator  
(for CVT)  
The thermometer indicates the outside  
temperature.  
EXAMPLE  
(h)  
(g)  
EXAMPLE  
(Initial  
setting)  
EXAMPLE  
(f)  
80J2032  
When the ignition switch is in the “ON”  
position, the display (C) indicates the gear  
position (g).  
When using the manual mode, the display  
(C) indicates the manual mode indicator  
(h).  
80J2030  
If the outside temperature nears freezing,  
the mark (f) will appear on the display.  
80J2031  
NOTE:  
NOTE:  
• The outside temperature indication is not  
the actual outside temperature when  
driving at low speed, or when stopped.  
• If there is something wrong with the ther-  
mometer, or just after the ignition switch  
is turned to the “ON” position, the display  
may not indicate the outside tempera-  
ture.  
When you reconnect the negative (–) ter-  
minal to the battery, the unit of temperature  
will be reinitialized. Change the unit again  
to your preference.  
For details on how to use the transaxle,  
refer to “Using the Transaxle” in the  
“OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.  
• The mark (f) will appear whenever the  
outside temperature is near freezing,  
even if the display does not show the  
thermometer.  
To change the unit of temperature, while  
pushing and holding the trip meter selector  
knob (1), turn the indicator selector knob  
(2).  
2-73  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Odometer / Illumination Control Setting  
When the ignition switch is in the “ON”  
position, the display (D) shows the odome-  
ter.  
Illumination control setting  
When the ignition switch is turned to the  
“ON” position, the instrument panel lights  
come on.  
(Brightest)  
If you turn the indicator selector knob (2)  
clockwise or counterclockwise, the display  
will change to the illumination control set-  
ting.  
Your vehicle has a system to automatically  
dim the brightness of the instrument panel  
lights when the position lights or headlights  
are on.  
(Initial setting)  
Odometer  
You can change the brightness of the  
instrument panel lights regardless of  
whether the position lights or headlights  
are off or on.  
The odometer records the total distance  
the vehicle has been driven.  
CAUTION  
To increase the brightness of the instru-  
ment panel lights, turn the indicator selec-  
tor knob (1) clockwise.  
To reduce the brightness of the instrument  
panel lights, turn the indicator selector  
knob (1) counterclockwise.  
Keep track of your odometer reading  
and check the maintenance schedule  
regularly for required services.  
Increased wear or damage to certain  
parts can result from failure to per-  
form required services at the proper  
mileage intervals.  
(Dimmest)  
80JM039  
2-74  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
To change the time indication:  
Lighting Control Lever  
1) Push the trip meter selector knob (1)  
and the indicator selector knob (2)  
together.  
WARNING  
If you attempt to adjust the display  
while driving, you could lose control  
of the vehicle.  
2) To change the hour indication, turn the  
indicator selector knob (2) left or right  
repeatedly when the hour indication  
flashes. To change the hour indication  
quickly, turn and hold the indicator  
selector knob (2). To set the hour indi-  
cation, push the the indicator selector  
knob (2) and the minute indication will  
flash.  
3) To change the minute indication, turn  
the indicator selector knob (2) left or  
right repeatedly when the minute indi-  
cation flashes. To change the minute  
indication quickly, turn and hold the  
indicator selector knob (2). To set the  
minute indication, push the indicator  
selector knob (2).  
Do not attempt to adjust the display  
while driving.  
NOTE:  
• If you push the indicator selector knob or  
do not turn the knob for more than 5 sec-  
onds while activating the illumination  
control, the illumination control will be  
canceled automatically and the display  
(D) will show the odometer indication.  
You can change the brightness when the  
position lights or headlights are on even  
if the ignition switch is in the “ACC” or  
“LOCK” position.  
• When you reconnect the negative (–) ter-  
minal to the battery, the brightness of the  
instrument panel lights will be reinitial-  
ized. Readjust the brightness according  
to your preference.  
65D611  
WARNING  
To avoid possible injury, do not oper-  
ate controls by reaching through the  
steering wheel.  
WARNING  
If you attempt to adjust the display  
while driving, you could lose control  
of the vehicle.  
NOTE:  
Do not attempt to adjust the display  
while driving.  
If you select the lowest brightness level  
when the position lights or headlights are  
on, the instrument panel lights other than  
meter lights are turned off.  
NOTE:  
When you reconnect the negative (–) ter-  
minal to the battery, the clock indication will  
be reinitialized. Change the indication  
again to your preference.  
Clock (if equipped)  
When the ignition switch is in the “ON”  
position, the display (E) shows the time.  
2-75  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Lighting Operation  
EXAMPLE  
Daytime Running Light (D.R.L.)  
System  
EXAMPLE  
The headlights light, but are dimmer than  
the low beam, when the following three  
conditions are all met. Also, the D.R.L. indi-  
cator light on the instrument panel comes  
on.  
(3)  
Conditions for D.R.L. system operation:  
1) The engine is running.  
2) The parking brake is released.  
3) The headlights are off.  
(2)  
(1)  
NOTE:  
Be sure to turn the headlights on at night  
or at any time of the day when driving or  
weather conditions require the headlights  
to operate at full brightness and the tail-  
lights to be on.  
63J309  
63J308  
With the headlights on, push the lever for-  
ward to switch to the high beams (main  
beams) or pull the lever toward you to  
switch to the low beams. When the high  
beams (main beams) are on, a light on the  
instrument panel will come on. To momen-  
tarily activate the high beams (main  
beams) as a passing signal, pull the lever  
slightly toward you and release it when you  
have completed the signal.  
To turn the lights on or off, twist the knob  
on the end of the lever. There are three  
positions:  
Lights “On” reminder (if equipped)  
A buzzer/chime sounds to remind you to  
turn off the lights if they are left on when  
the ignition key is removed and the driver’s  
door is opened.  
OFF (1)  
All lights are off.  
(2)  
Front position lights, tail lights, license  
plate light and instrument lights are on, but  
headlights are off.  
(3)  
Front position lights, tail lights, license  
plate light, instrument lights and head  
lights are on.  
2-76  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Turn Signal Operation  
Front Fog Light Switch  
(if equipped)  
Turn Signal Control Lever  
With the ignition switch in the “ON” posi-  
tion, move the lever up or down to activate  
the right or left turn signals.  
Normal turn signal  
EXAMPLE  
65D611  
64J058  
WARNING  
The front fog light comes on when the fog  
light switch is pushed in with the headlights  
are on and the beams set to the low beam  
position.  
To avoid possible injury, do not oper-  
ate controls by reaching through the  
steering wheel.  
63J310  
Move the lever all the way upward or down-  
ward to signal. When the turn is com-  
pleted, the signal will cancel and the lever  
will return to its normal position.  
2-77  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Lane change signal  
EXAMPLE  
Hazard Warning Switch  
Windshield Wiper and Washer  
Lever  
63J311  
80JM041  
Some times, such as when changing  
lanes, the steering wheel is not turned far  
enough to cancel the turn signal. For con-  
venience, you can flash the turn signal by  
moving the lever part way and holding it  
there. The lever will return to its normal  
position when you release it.  
Push in the hazard warning switch to acti-  
vate the hazard warning lights. All turn sig-  
nal lights and both turn signal indicators  
will flash simultaneously. To turn off the  
lights, push the switch again.  
65D611  
WARNING  
To avoid possible injury, do not oper-  
ate controls by reaching through the  
steering wheel.  
Use the hazard warning lights to warn  
other traffic during emergency parking or  
when your vehicle could otherwise become  
a traffic hazard.  
2-78  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Windshield Wipers  
EXAMPLE  
Windshield Washer  
EXAMPLE  
EXAMPLE  
MIST  
OFF  
INT  
LO  
HI  
63J302  
63J301  
63J303  
If the lever is equipped with the “INT TIME”  
control, turn the control forward or rear-  
ward to adjust the intermittent wiper opera-  
tion to the desired interval.  
To turn the windshield wipers on, move the  
lever down to one of the three operating  
positions. In the “INT” position (if  
equipped), the wipers operate intermit-  
tently. The “INT” position is very convenient  
for driving in mist or light rain. In the “LO”  
position, the wipers operate at a steady  
low speed. In the “HI” position, the wipers  
operate at a steady high speed. To turn off  
the wipers, move the lever back to the  
“OFF” position.  
To spray windshield washer fluid, pull the  
lever toward you. The windshield wipers  
will automatically turn on at low speed if  
they are not already on and the “INT” posi-  
tion is equipped.  
WARNING  
• To prevent windshield icing in cold  
weather, turn on the defroster to  
heat the windshield before and dur-  
ing windshield washer use.  
• Do not use radiator antifreeze in  
the windshield washer reservoir. It  
can severely impair visibility when  
sprayed on the windshield, and can  
also damage your vehicle’s paint.  
Move the lever up and hold it to the “MIST”  
position, the windshield wipers will turn on  
continuously at low speed.  
2-79  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Rear Window Wiper/Washer Switch  
(if equipped)  
CAUTION  
CAUTION  
To help prevent damage to the wind-  
shield wiper and washer system  
components, you should take the fol-  
lowing precautions:  
• Do not continue to hold in the lever  
when there is no windshield  
washer fluid being sprayed or the  
washer motor can be damaged.  
• Do not attempt to remove dirt from  
a dry windshield with the wipers or  
you can damage the windshield  
and the wiper blades. Always wet  
the windshield with washer fluid  
before operating the wipers.  
• Clear ice or packed snow from the  
wiper blades before using the wip-  
ers.  
• Check the washer fluid level regu-  
larly. Check it often when the  
weather is bad.  
Clear ice or snow from the rear win-  
dow and rear wiper blade before  
using the rear wiper. Accumulated ice  
or snow could prevent the wiper  
blade from moving, causing damage  
to the wiper motor.  
EXAMPLE  
Washer  
Wiper  
Intermittent wiper  
63J304  
To turn the rear wiper on, twist the rear  
wiper switch on the end of the lever for-  
ward to the “ON” position. If your vehicle is  
equipped the “INT” position, the rear wiper  
operates intermittently when you twist the  
switch forward to the “INT” position. To turn  
the rear wiper off, twist the switch rearward  
to the “OFF” position.  
• Only fill the washer fluid reservoir  
3/4 full during cold weather to allow  
room for expansion if the tempera-  
ture falls low enough to freeze the  
solution.  
To spray window washer fluid, twist the  
switch rearward from the “OFF” position, or  
twist the switch forward from the “ON” posi-  
tion. The rear wiper will turn on automati-  
cally while spraying the window washer  
fluid.  
2-80  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
Tilt Steering Lock Lever  
(if equipped)  
Horn  
Heated Rear Window and  
Heated Outside Rearview  
Mirrors (if equipped) Switch  
EXAMPLE  
EXAMPLE  
Type 1  
EXAMPLE  
LOCK  
UNLOCK  
80J2010  
63J026  
Press the horn pad on the steering wheel  
to sound the horn. The horn will sound with  
the ignition switch in any position.  
(1)  
The lock lever is located under the steering  
column. To adjust the steering wheel  
height:  
80JM042  
Type 2  
1) Pull up the lock lever to unlock the  
steering column.  
EXAMPLE  
2) Adjust the steering wheel to the desired  
height and lock the steering column by  
push down the lock lever.  
3) Try moving the steering wheel up and  
down to make sure it is securely locked  
in position.  
WARNING  
Never attempt to adjust the steering  
wheel height while the vehicle is  
moving or you could lose control of  
the vehicle.  
(1)  
80JM043  
2-81  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
When the rear window is misted, push this  
switch (1) to clear the window.  
CAUTION  
The heated rear window and the  
heated outside rearview mirrors (if  
equipped) use a large amount of elec-  
tricity. Be sure to turn off after the  
window and mirrors have become  
clear.  
(2)  
NOTE:  
• The defogger will work only when the  
engine is running.  
• The defogger will automatically turn off  
after the defogger remains on for 15 min-  
utes to prevent discharging of the bat-  
tery.  
80JC040  
If the outside rearview mirror has the mark  
(2), it is also equipped with the heated out-  
side rearview mirrors. When you push the  
switch (1), both the heated outside rear-  
view mirrors and the heated rear window  
will operate simultaneously.  
An indicator light will be lit when the defog-  
ger is on. The defogger will work only  
when the engine is running. To turn off the  
defogger, push the switch (1) again.  
2-82  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BEFORE DRIVING  
MEMO  
2-83  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
Exhaust Gas Warning ......................................................... 3-1  
Daily Inspection Checklist .................................................. 3-1  
Ignition Switch ..................................................................... 3-2  
Parking Brake Lever ........................................................... 3-6  
Pedals ................................................................................... 3-7  
Starting the Engine ............................................................. 3-8  
Engine Block Heater (if equipped) ..................................... 3-9  
Using the Transaxle ............................................................ 3-10  
Using the 2WD/i-AWD (intelligent All Wheel Drive)  
3
Switch (if equipped) ............................................................ 3-16  
Cruise Control (if equipped) ............................................... 3-18  
Braking ................................................................................. 3-20  
®
Electronic Stability Program (ESP ) (if equipped) ........... 3-23  
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) ........................ 3-26  
60G408  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ignition Switch: 8  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
Exhaust Gas Warning  
Daily Inspection Checklist  
WARNING  
Before Driving  
(Continued)  
1) Make sure that windows, mirrors, lights  
and reflectors are clean and unob-  
structed.  
• Do not park with the engine run-  
ning for a long period of time, even  
in an open area. If it is necessary to  
sit for a short time in a parked vehi-  
cle with the engine running, make  
sure the air intake selector is set to  
“FRESH AIR” and the blower is at  
high speed.  
• Avoid operating the vehicle with  
the tailgate or trunk open. If it is  
necessary to operate the vehicle  
with the tailgate or trunk open,  
make sure the sunroof (if equipped)  
and all windows are closed, and the  
blower is at high speed with the air  
intake selector set to “FRESH AIR”.  
• To allow proper operation of your  
vehicle’s ventilation system, keep  
the air inlet grille in front of the  
windshield clear of snow, leaves or  
other obstructions at all times.  
• Keep the exhaust tailpipe area clear  
of snow and other material to help  
reduce the buildup of exhaust  
gases under the vehicle. This is  
particularly important when parked  
in blizzard conditions.  
• Have the exhaust system inspected  
periodically for damage and leaks.  
Any damage or leaks should be  
repaired immediately.  
2) Visually check the tires for the following  
points:  
– the depth of the tread groove  
– abnormal wear, cracks and damage  
– loose wheel nuts  
– existence of foreign material such as  
nails, stones, etc.  
Refer to “Tires” in “INSPECTION AND  
MAINTENANCE” section for details.  
3) Look for fluid, oil leaks.  
52D334  
NOTE:  
WARNING  
It is normal for water to drip from the air  
conditioning system after use.  
Avoid breathing exhaust gases.  
Exhaust gases contain carbon mon-  
oxide, a potentially lethal gas that is  
colorless and odorless. Since carbon  
monoxide is difficult to detect by  
itself, be sure to take the following  
precautions to help prevent carbon  
monoxide from entering your vehicle.  
• Do not leave the engine running in  
garages or other confined areas.  
(Continued)  
4) Make sure the hood is fully closed and  
latched.  
5) Check the headlights, turn signal lights,  
brake lights and horn for proper opera-  
tion.  
6) Lock all doors.  
7) Adjust the seat and adjustable head  
restraints (if equipped).  
8) Check the brake pedal.  
9) Adjust the mirrors.  
10)Make sure that you and all passengers  
have properly fastened your seat belts.  
11)Make sure that all warning lights come  
on as the key is turned to the “ON” posi-  
tion.  
3-1  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ignition Switch: 8  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
12)Check all gauges.  
13)Make sure that the BRAKE light turns  
off when the parking brake is released.  
Once a month, or each time you fill your  
fuel tank, check the tire pressure using a  
tire pressure gauge. Also check the tire  
pressure of the spare tire.  
Ignition Switch  
Once a week, or each time you fill your fuel  
tank, perform the following under-hood  
checks:  
1) Engine oil level  
2) Coolant level  
3) Brake fluid level  
4) Power steering (if equipped) fluid level  
5) Windshield washer fluid level  
6) Hood latch operation  
Pull the hood release handle inside the  
vehicle. Make sure that you cannot  
open the hood all the way without  
releasing the secondary latch. Be sure  
to close the hood securely after check-  
ing for proper latch operation. See the  
item “All latches, hinges and locks” of  
“CHASSIS AND BODY” in the “Periodic  
Maintenance Schedule” section in the  
“INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE”  
section for lubrication schedule.  
65D611  
WARNING  
To avoid possible injury, do not oper-  
ate controls by reaching through the  
steering wheel.  
WARNING  
Make sure the hood is fully closed  
and latched before driving. If it is not,  
it can fly up unexpectedly during  
driving, obstructing your view and  
resulting in an accident.  
3-2  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lighting/Turn Signal Control Lever: 8  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
Manual transaxle  
ACC  
Vehicle Without Keyless Start  
System  
Accessories such as the radio can oper-  
ate, but the engine is off.  
ON  
This is the normal operating position. All  
electrical systems are on.  
Push  
START  
This is the position for starting the engine  
using the starter motor. The key should be  
released from this position as soon as the  
engine starts.  
Turn to “LOCK”  
Ignition key reminder  
60A055  
A buzzer sounds intermittently to remind  
you to remove the ignition key if it is in the  
ignition switch when the driver’s door is  
opened.  
Manual transaxle vehicles  
60B041  
You must push in the key to turn it to the  
“LOCK” position. It locks the ignition, and  
prevents normal use of the steering  
wheel after the key is removed.  
The ignition switch has the following four  
positions:  
LOCK  
This is the normal parking position. It is the  
only position in which the key can be  
removed.  
CVT vehicles  
The gearshift lever must be in the “P”  
(Park) position to turn the key to the  
“LOCK” position. It locks the ignition and  
prevents normal use of the steering  
wheel and gearshift lever.  
To release the steering lock, insert the key  
and turn it clockwise to one of the other  
positions. If you have trouble turning the  
key to unlock the steering, try turning the  
steering wheel slightly to the right or left  
while turning the key.  
3-3  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lighting/Turn Signal Control Lever: 8  
Windshield Wiper and Washer Lever: 8  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
• If the keyless start system red indicator  
light illuminates, the remote controller  
may not be in the vehicle or the battery  
of the remote controller may be unreli-  
able.  
Vehicle With Keyless Start System  
(3)  
(4)  
(2)  
NOTE:  
• If the battery of the remote controller  
runs down or there are strong radio  
waves or noise, the operating range may  
be narrower or the remote controller may  
be inoperative.  
(1)  
• If the remote controller is too close to the  
door glass, it may not operate.  
• The ignition switch may not turn when  
the remote controller is on the instru-  
ment panel, in the glove box, in a stor-  
age compartment, in the sun visor or on  
the floor.  
EXAMPLE  
80J2016  
56KN076  
If the keyless start system blue indicator  
light illuminates on the instrument cluster,  
you can turn the ignition switch. If the red  
indicator light illuminates, you cannot turn  
the ignition switch.  
The ignition switch can be operated with-  
out using an ignition key when the remote  
controller is in an area of the vehicle other  
than the rear luggage area. To turn the  
ignition switch, first push in the switch.  
CAUTION  
NOTE:  
The remote controller is a sensitive  
electronic instrument. To avoid dam-  
aging the remote controller:  
• Do not expose it to impacts, mois-  
ture or high temperature such as by  
leaving it on the dashboard under  
direct sunlight.  
• Keep the remote controller away  
from magnetic objects such as a  
television.  
• The ignition switch can be turned to the  
“ACC” position when the keyless start  
system blue indicator light illuminates.  
The blue indicator light will illuminate for  
several seconds when you push in the  
ignition switch and then will turn off to  
protect the system. In this case, you  
must release the ignition switch and  
push it in again to illuminate the blue  
indicator light.  
• Manual transaxle vehicle  
You must push in the ignition switch to  
turn it from the “LOCK” position to the  
“ACC” position. To return to the “LOCK”  
position from the “ACC” position, turn the  
ignition switch counterclockwise while  
pushing in the switch.  
• CVT vehicle  
To turn the ignition switch, push the  
switch.  
3-4  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windshield Wiper and Washer Lever: 8  
Rear Window Wiper/Washer Switch: 8  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
If you leave any of the doors open with the  
ignition switch in the “ACC” position for a  
while (and no key inserted), the engine  
may not start when you turn the ignition  
switch to “START”. If the engine does not  
start, close all doors completely or turn the  
ignition switch back to the “LOCK” position,  
then start the engine.  
• CVT vehicle  
You can also turn the ignition switch by  
inserting the ignition key into the slot.  
To turn the ignition switch, push the  
switch.  
ACC (2)  
Accessories such as the radio can oper-  
ate, but the engine is off.  
ON (3)  
The ignition switch has the following four  
positions:  
This is the normal operating position. All  
electrical systems are on.  
LOCK (1)  
START (4)  
This is the normal parking position. It is the  
only position in which the key can be  
removed. It locks the ignition, and prevents  
normal use of the steering wheel.  
This is the position for starting the engine  
using the starter motor. The switch should  
be released from this position as soon as  
the engine starts.  
(1)  
80JM139  
For vehicles with a CVT, the gearshift lever  
must be in the “P” (Park) position to turn  
the key to the “LOCK” position.  
The ignition switch cap (1) is installed to  
make the ignition switch turn easily.  
If you use the ignition key to turn the igni-  
tion switch, remove the cap (1) by pinching  
both side of the cap and pull it out.  
Ignition switch reminder  
(When using the keyless start system)  
A buzzer sounds intermittently to remind  
you to return the ignition switch to the  
“LOCK” position if it is in the “ACC” position  
when the driver’s door is opened.  
To release the steering lock, turn the igni-  
tion switch clockwise to one of the other  
positions. If you have trouble turning the  
ignition switch to unlock the steering, try  
turning the steering wheel slightly to the  
right or left while turning the switch.  
NOTE:  
If you remove the cap, be careful not to  
lose it.  
Ignition key reminder  
• Manual transaxle vehicle  
(When using the ignition key)  
A buzzer sounds intermittently to remind  
you to remove the ignition key if it is in the  
ignition switch when the driver’s door is  
opened.  
You must push in the ignition switch to  
turn it from the “LOCK” position to the  
“ACC” position. To return to the “LOCK”  
position from the “ACC” position, turn the  
ignition switch counterclockwise while  
pushing in the switch.  
3-5  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Rear Window Wiper/Washer Switch: 8  
Tilt Steering Lock Lever: 6  
Cruise Control: 7, 8  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
Parking Brake Lever  
CAUTION  
• Do not turn the starter motor for  
more than 15 seconds at a time. If  
the engine does not start, wait 15  
seconds before trying again. If the  
engine does not start after several  
attempts, check the fuel and igni-  
tion systems or consult your  
SUZUKI dealer.  
• Do not leave the ignition switch in  
the “ON” position if the engine is  
not running or the battery will dis-  
charge.  
81A297S  
52D122  
WARNING  
(1) To set  
(2) To release  
(3) To release  
• For manual transaxle vehicles,  
never remove the ignition key while  
the vehicle is moving. The steering  
wheel will lock and you will not be  
able to steer the vehicle.  
• Always remove the ignition key  
when leaving the vehicle even if  
only for a short time. Also do not  
leave children or pets alone in a  
parked vehicle. Unattended chil-  
dren could cause accidental move-  
ment of the vehicle or could tamper  
with power windows. Children or  
pets could suffer from heatstroke  
in warm or hot weather, which  
could result in severe injury or  
even death.  
The parking brake lever is located between  
the seats. To set the parking brake, hold  
the brake pedal down and pull the parking  
brake lever all the way up. To release the  
parking brake, hold the brake pedal down,  
pull up slightly on the parking brake lever,  
push the button on the end of the lever with  
your thumb and lower the lever to its origi-  
nal position.  
3-6  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cruise Control: 7, 8  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
For CVT vehicles, always set the parking  
brake before moving the gearshift lever to  
the “P” (Park) position. If you park on an  
incline and shift into “P” before you set the  
parking brake, the weight of the vehicle  
may make it difficult to shift out of “P” when  
you are ready to drive the vehicle. When  
preparing to drive the vehicle, move the  
gearshift lever out of the “P” position before  
releasing the parking brake.  
Pedals  
WARNING  
Manual transaxle  
EXAMPLE  
Always set the parking brake fully  
before leaving your vehicle or it may  
roll, causing injury or damage. When  
parking, make sure the gearshift  
lever for manual transaxle vehicles is  
in 1st gear or “R” (Reverse) and the  
gearshift lever for CVT vehicles is in  
“P” (Park). Remember, even though  
the transaxle is in gear or in Park, you  
must set the parking brake fully.  
WARNING  
• Never drive your vehicle with the  
parking brake set: rear brake effec-  
tiveness can be reduced from over-  
heating, brake life may be  
shortened or permanent brake  
damage may result.  
• If the parking brake does not hold  
the vehicle securely or does not  
fully release, have your vehicle  
inspected immediately by an autho-  
rized SUZUKI dealer.  
(1)  
(2)  
(3)  
79J072  
CVT  
EXAMPLE  
(2)  
(3)  
79J154  
3-7  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cruise Control: 7, 8  
Remote Audio Controls:  
Horn: 6  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
Clutch Pedal (1)  
Starting the Engine  
(For manual transaxle)  
WARNING  
The clutch pedal is used to disengage the  
drive to the wheels when starting the  
engine, stopping or shifting the gearshift  
lever. Depressing the pedal disengages  
the clutch.  
Before Starting the Engine  
Do not “ride” the brakes by applying  
them continuously or resting your  
foot on the pedal. This will result in  
overheating of the brakes which  
could cause unpredictable braking  
action, longer stopping distances or  
permanent brake damage.  
1) Make sure the parking brake is set fully.  
2) Manual Transaxle – Shift into “N” (Neu-  
tral) and depress the clutch pedal all  
the way to the floor. Hold the clutch  
pedal while starting the engine.  
CVT – If the gearshift lever is not in “P”  
(Park) position, shift into “P”. (If you  
need to re-start the engine while the  
vehicle is moving, shift into “N”.)  
CAUTION  
Do not drive with your foot resting on  
the clutch pedal. It could result in  
excessive clutch wear, clutch dam-  
age, or unexpected loss of engine  
braking.  
Accelerator Pedal (3)  
This pedal controls the speed of the  
engine. Depressing the accelerator pedal  
increases power output and speed.  
NOTE:  
The engine of manual transaxle vehicle will  
not start unless the clutch pedal is  
depressed.  
Brake Pedal (2)  
Your SUZUKI vehicle is equipped with  
either front and rear disc brakes or front  
disc brakes and rear drum brakes.  
Depressing the brake pedal applies both  
sets of brakes.  
NOTE:  
CVT vehicles have a starter interlock  
device which is designed to keep the  
starter from operating if the transaxle is in  
any of the drive positions.  
You may hear occasional brake squeal  
when you apply the brakes. This is a nor-  
mal condition caused by environmental  
factors such as cold, wet, snow, etc.  
WARNING  
Make sure that the parking brake is  
set fully and the transaxle is in Neu-  
tral (or Park for vehicles with a CVT)  
before attempting to start the engine.  
WARNING  
If brake squeal is excessive and  
occurs each time the brakes are  
applied, you should have the brakes  
checked by your SUZUKI dealer.  
3-8  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
NOTE:  
Starting a Cold Engine  
Engine Block Heater  
(if equipped)  
Activate the heater at least four hours  
before you start the engine. However, as  
the heating time varies depending on the  
ambient temperature and other factors,  
adjust the time by observing the engine  
cranking condition.  
With your foot off the accelerator pedal,  
crank the engine by turning the ignition key  
to “START”. Release the key when the  
engine starts.  
EXAMPLE  
CAUTION  
• Stop turning the starter immedi-  
ately after the engine has started or  
the starter system can be dam-  
aged.  
• Do not crank the engine for more  
than 15 seconds at a time. If the  
engine doesn’t start on the first try,  
wait about 15 seconds before try-  
ing again.  
WARNING  
To avoid serious personal injury  
caused by electrical shock or fire:  
• Do not plug the cord into a non-  
grounded outlet. Only use a prop-  
erly grounded three-prong 110-volt  
AC outlet.  
• Do not use a 2-wire (non-grounded)  
extension cord.  
80J2064  
• Only use a heavy-duty, three-prong  
extension cord rated for at least 15  
amps.  
If the engine does not start after 15 sec-  
onds of cranking, wait about 15 seconds,  
then press down the accelerator pedal to  
1/3 of its travel and try cranking the engine  
again. Release the key and accelerator  
pedal when the engine starts.  
The engine block heater will help you start  
the engine more easily in very cold  
weather (–18°C (0°F) or below). To use the  
engine block heater:  
After using the block heater:  
1) Unplug the extension cord and reinstall  
the plug cap.  
2) Tie the block heater cord back to its  
original position.  
1) Turn off the engine.  
2) Open the engine hood.  
3) Untie the block heater cord and remove  
the block heater plug cap. When the  
engine block heater is not in use,  
ensure the heater cord is secured to  
prevent contact with any moving parts.  
If the engine still does not start, try holding  
the accelerator pedal all the way to the  
floor while cranking. This should clear the  
engine if it is flooded.  
If you are unable to start the engine using  
this procedure, consult your SUZUKI  
dealer.  
4) Using  
a
heavy-duty, three-prong  
grounded extension cord, plug the  
female end into the block heater socket  
and the male end into a normal,  
grounded 110-volt AC outlet.  
Starting a Warm Engine  
Use the same procedure as for “Starting a  
Cold Engine”.  
3-9  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
Using the Transaxle  
CAUTION  
Manual Transaxle  
Secure the block heater cord back to  
its original position or to the routed  
position. A loose cord could get  
caught in the engine accessory drive  
belt(s) or other moving parts.  
EXAMPLE  
3) Close the engine hood securely before  
starting the engine.  
80J2082  
Reverse gear: with lifting up ring, shift the  
gearshift lever to the right, engage gear.  
80J2081  
Starting off  
To start off, depress the clutch pedal all the  
way to the floor and shift into 1st gear.  
After releasing the parking brake, gradually  
release the clutch. When you hear a  
change in the engine’s sound, slowly press  
the accelerator while continuing to gradu-  
ally release the clutch.  
Shifting  
All forward gears are synchronized, which  
provides for quiet, and easy shifting.  
Always depress the clutch pedal all the  
way to the floor before shifting gears. Keep  
the engine speed does not rise into the red  
zone of the tachometer.  
3-10  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
WARNING  
Gearshift lever  
Continuously Variable Transaxle  
(CVT)  
• Reduce your speed and downshift  
to a lower gear before going down  
a long or steep hill. Downshifting  
will allow the engine to provide  
braking. Avoid riding the brakes or  
they may overheat, resulting in  
brake failure.  
• When driving on slippery roads, be  
sure to slow down before down-  
shifting.  
Large  
and  
sudden  
changes in engine speed may  
cause loss of traction, which could  
cause you to lose control.  
80J2035  
• Make sure that the vehicle is com-  
pletely stopped before you shift  
into reverse.  
80J2065  
WARNING  
Always depress the brake pedal  
before shifting from “P” (Park) (or  
“N” (Neutral) if the vehicle is station-  
ary) to a forward or reverse gear, to  
help prevent the vehicle from moving  
unexpectedly when you shift.  
CAUTION  
• To help avoid clutch damage, do  
not use the clutch pedal as a foot-  
rest while driving or use the clutch  
to keep the vehicle stationary on a  
slope. Depress the clutch fully  
when shifting.  
• When shifting or starting off, do not  
race the engine. Racing the engine  
can shorten engine life and affect  
smooth shifting.  
3-11  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
The gearshift lever has a lock mechanism  
to help prevent accidental shifting. To shift  
the gearshift lever:  
NOTE:  
Use the gearshift lever positions as  
described below:  
• Always shift the gearshift lever without  
pushing in the lock button (1) except  
when you shift from “P” to “R”, from “N”  
to “R” or from “R” to “P”. If you always  
push in the lock button (1) when shifting  
the gearshift lever, you could shift into  
“P” or “R” by mistake.  
P (Park)  
Shift with the lock button (1)  
pushed in and the brake pedal  
depressed.  
Use this position to lock the transaxle  
when the vehicle is parked or when start-  
ing the engine. Shift into Park only when  
the vehicle is completely stationary.  
• If driver’s or passenger’s knee hits the  
gearshift lever while driving, the lever  
could move and the gear could be  
changed unexpectedly.  
Shift with the lock button (1)  
pushed in.  
R (Reverse)  
Use this position to reverse the vehicle  
from stop. Make sure that vehicle is com-  
pletely stationary before shifting into  
Reverse.  
Shift without the lock button (1)  
pushed in.  
CAUTION  
Do not shift the gearshift lever into  
“R” while moving forward, or the  
transaxle may be damaged. If you  
shift into “R” when the vehicle speed  
is over 6mph (10km/h), the transaxle  
will not shift into reverse.  
(1)  
N (Neutral)  
Use this position for starting the engine if  
the engine stalls and you need to restart it  
while the vehicle is moving. You may also  
shift into Neutral and depress the brake  
pedal to hold the vehicle stationary during  
idling.  
80J2036  
3-12  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
D (Drive)  
Manual mode  
The information display shows the manual  
mode indicator (1) and the current gear  
position (2).  
Use this position for all normal driving.  
The CVT can shift gears automatically.  
When using the manual mode, you can  
shift gears in the same manner as conven-  
tional manual transaxle.  
With the gearshift lever in “D” range you  
can get an automatic downshift by press-  
ing the accelerator pedal. The higher the  
vehicle speed is, the more you need to  
press the accelerator pedal to get a down-  
shift.  
NOTE:  
To use the manual mode, shift the gearshift  
lever from “D” to “M”.  
• The indicated gear position on the infor-  
mation display when you shift from “D” to  
“M” is the gear position that was selected  
automatically when the gearshift lever  
was in “D”.  
M (manual mode)  
Use this position for driving in the manual  
mode.  
Refer to “Manual mode” later in this section  
for details on how to use the manual mode.  
You can change to the manual mode  
temporarily by pulling the shift paddle (if  
equipped) on the steering wheel toward  
you when the gearshift lever is in “D”.  
Shifting in the manual mode  
You can shift gears from 1st to 6th depend-  
ing on driving speed.  
CAUTION  
Be sure to take the following precau-  
tions to help avoid damage to the  
CVT:  
• Make sure that the vehicle is com-  
pletely stationary before shifting  
into “P” or “R”.  
• Do not shift from “P” or “N” to “R”,  
“D” or “M” when the engine is run-  
ning above idle speed.  
• Do not rev the engine with the tran-  
saxle in a drive position (“R”, “D”  
or “M”) and the front wheels not  
moving.  
NOTE:  
• When the engine is revved, the gear is  
shifted up automatically to prevent dam-  
age to the engine and the transaxle. If  
the CVT fluid becomes hot such as  
when driving on up hill, the engine speed  
at which shifting occurs may be lower  
than usual.  
80J2037  
EXAMPLE  
(1)  
(2)  
• When the driving speed becomes slow,  
the gear shifts down automatically, and  
when the vehicle stops, the gear position  
will be in 1st gear without shifting the  
gearshift lever.  
• If you depress the accelerator pedal a  
certain amount, the gear shifts down  
automatically even if the gearshift lever  
is in the manual mode.  
80J2073  
• Do not use the accelerator to hold  
the vehicle on a hill. Use the vehi-  
cle’s brakes.  
(1) Manual mode indicator  
(2) Gear position  
3-13  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
NOTE:  
NOTE:  
When you shift gears, the gear may not  
shift to the desired position. This is to  
maintain good drivability and to protect the  
transaxle.  
To shift gears continuously, remove your  
hand from the gearshift lever, then shift the  
lever again. You cannot shift gears continu-  
ously while holding the lever in the “+” or  
” position.  
Using the gearshift lever  
Using the shift paddle (if equipped)  
(2)  
80J1359  
To shift down, pull the “–” side shift paddle,  
located on left side of the steering wheel,  
toward you. When you remove your finger  
from the switch, the switch will return to the  
original position.  
(1)  
80J2039  
NOTE:  
80J1358  
(1) “+” side (shift up)  
To shift gears continuously, remove your  
finger from the shift paddle, then pull the  
shift paddle again. You cannot shift  
gears continuously while holding the  
shift paddle toward you.  
(2) “–” side (shift down)  
To shift up, pull the “+” side shift paddle,  
located on right side of the steering wheel,  
toward you. When you remove your finger  
from the switch, the switch will return to the  
original position.  
To shift up, pull the gearshift lever to the “+”  
side (rearward). When you remove your  
hand from the gearshift lever, the lever will  
return to the “M” position automatically.  
• When you pull the both “+” and “” shift  
paddle simultaneously, the gear may not  
shift.  
To shift down, push the gearshift lever to  
the “–” side (forward). When you remove  
your hand from the gearshift lever, the  
lever will return to the “M” position auto-  
matically.  
3-14  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
Canceling the manual mode  
To cancel the manual mode, shift the gear-  
shift lever from “M” to “D”.  
If You Cannot Shift CVT Gearshift Lever  
Out of “P” (PARK)  
This procedure is for emergency use only.  
If repeated use of this procedure is neces-  
sary, or the procedure does not work as  
described, take the vehicle to your dealer  
for repair.  
(1)  
Temporary manual mode  
Pull the shift paddle (if equipped) toward  
you when driving with the gearshift lever in  
the “D” position. The information display  
shows the manual mode indicator (1) and  
the current gear position (2).  
EXAMPLE  
(1)  
(2)  
80J2040  
Vehicles with a CVT have an electrically  
operated park-lock feature. If the vehicle’s  
battery is discharged, or there is some  
other electrical failure, the CVT cannot be  
shifted out of Park in the normal way. Jump  
starting may correct the condition. If not,  
follow the procedure described below. This  
procedure will permit changing the tran-  
saxle out of Park.  
80J2073  
(1) Manual mode indicator  
(2) Gear position  
The temporary manual mode will be can-  
celed automatically in the following situa-  
tions.  
• When you press and hold the accelera-  
tor pedal for a certain period of time with-  
out shifting gears.  
1) Be sure the parking brake is firmly  
applied.  
2) If the engine is running, stop the  
engine.  
• When driving speed becomes slow.  
3) Make sure the key is in the “ON” or  
“ACC” position.  
4) Remove the cover (1) over the button.  
5) With pushing the release button by the  
key or the flat end rod, shift the gear-  
shift lever to the desired position.  
3-15  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
i-AWD AUTO  
may cause severe damage to the drive  
train.  
• As the vehicle speed increases, the “i-  
AWD LOCK” mode is automatically can-  
celed and the “i-AWD AUTO” mode is  
selected.  
• When the ignition switch is turned to the  
“OFF” position, the “i-AWD LOCK” mode  
is canceled.  
Using the 2WD/i-AWD  
(intelligent All Wheel Drive)  
Switch (if equipped)  
In this position, engine power is supplied to  
the front and rear axles at normal speed,  
providing greater traction than 2-wheel  
drive. Use this position for driving on paved  
roads or on slippery roads (icy, snow-cov-  
ered, muddy, etc.).  
In the AUTO mode, the i-AWD controller  
judges the driving conditions using signals  
from sensors.  
2WD/i-AWD Switch Operation  
Operate the 2WD/i-AWD switch according  
to the appropriate procedure described  
below:  
When slipping of the front wheels is  
detected, the electronically controlled cou-  
pling supplies optimum driving force to the  
rear wheels. This function improves driving  
stability and running through performance  
on rough roads and stabilizes driving per-  
formance even on a snow covered up-hill  
road or the like.  
Also, during normal driving on paved  
roads, torque distribution to the rear  
wheels is reduced to achieve the nearly  
front wheel drive condition, thereby fuel  
consumption is improved.  
How to turn on 2WD/i-AWD switch  
2WD/i-AWD switch will activate when the  
ignition switch is turned on.  
From 2WD to i-AWD AUTO  
80J009  
Turn the 2WD/i-AWD switch to the neutral  
position, and the “i-AWD AUTO” indicator  
will come on.  
This i-AWD system enables you to select  
the driving mode according to the driving  
conditions by operating the 2WD/i-AWD  
switch. With this feature, you can select 3  
mode positions, “2WD”, “i-AWD AUTO”  
and “i-AWD LOCK” by operating the 2WD/  
i-AWD switch even when the vehicle is  
moving, provided the front wheels are in  
the straight ahead position.  
i-AWD LOCK  
In this position, engine power is supplied to  
the front and rear axles at reduced speed.  
Use this position when it is hard to start off  
in the “i-AWD AUTO” mode such as in  
mud, sand or on snow.  
79J040  
Description of 3 Mode 4 x 4 System  
Positions  
NOTE:  
• Avoid operating your vehicle in the “i-  
AWD LOCK” on wet pavement as much  
as possible. Operating your vehicle in  
the “i-AWD LOCK” on wet pavement  
2WD  
In this position, engine power is supplied to  
the front axle only. Use this position for  
normal driving (on dry, hard surfaces).  
3-16  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
From i-AWD AUTO to i-AWD LOCK  
Push the “i-AWD LOCK” switch for a few  
seconds until the “i-AWD LOCK” indicator  
will come on.  
• While driving in the “i-AWD LOCK”  
mode, as the vehicle speed increases,  
the driving mode changes to the “i-AWD  
AUTO” mode automatically. Even when  
the vehicle speed reduces, on the other  
hand, the driving mode does not return  
to the “i-AWD LOCK” mode automati-  
cally. You should press the “i-AWD  
LOCK” switch according to the driving  
conditions.  
• Any forcible operation while driving off-  
road in the sand or water or when a  
wheel has run off the road, the difference  
of the revolution between front wheels  
and rear wheels increases (wheels run  
idle). If this state continues, the oil tem-  
perature of the driving system parts  
rises.  
In such case, the “i-AWD AUTO” indica-  
tor light blinks and the driving mode  
changes to the 2WD mode to protect the  
driving system parts.  
When you operate your vehicle in the i-  
AWD mode continuously, park the vehi-  
cle at a safe place and run the engine  
idle. After some time, the “i-AWD AUTO”  
indicator light turns on again and the  
driving mode returns to the “i-AWD  
AUTO” mode.  
CAUTION  
• Never use the “i-AWD LOCK” mode  
when driving on dry paved roads.  
Avoid using the “i-AWD LOCK”  
mode when driving on wet paved  
roads as much as possible. Use of  
the “i-AWD LOCK” mode in above  
conditions will apply excessive  
force to the driving system and  
may cause a critical failure. Also,  
the tires may wear faster and fuel  
consumption may be affected  
adversely.  
• Note that i-AWD vehicles are not  
all-around vehicles. Be sure to  
observe following instructions  
when driving your vehicle.  
– Do not drive through water like  
crossing a river.  
– Do not drive continuously where  
front wheels tend to race in  
places such as sand and mud.  
– When any wheel is in the air for  
such reason as running off the  
road, do not race it needlessly.  
• If the “i-AWD AUTO” and the “i-  
AWD LOCK” indicator lights stay  
on and come on simultaneously  
when driving, there may be some-  
thing wrong the i-AWD system.  
Have the system inspected by an  
authorized SUZUKI dealer.  
79J100  
From i-AWD LOCK to i-AWD AUTO  
Push the “i-AWD LOCK” switch, and the “i-  
AWD AUTO” indicator will come on.  
From i-AWD AUTO or LOCK to 2WD  
Push the “2WD” switch, and the “i-AWD  
AUTO” or “i-AWD LOCK” indicator will turn  
off.  
NOTE:  
• The 2WD/i-AWD switch can be operated  
when the vehicle is either stopped or  
moving.  
• Make sure that the front wheels are in  
the straight ahead position when operat-  
ing the 2WD/i-AWD switch.  
• While making turns or accelerating and  
decelerating, operating the 2WD/i-AWD  
switch or turning off the key switch in the  
“i-AWD AUTO” or “i-AWD LOCK” mode  
may cause a shock, but this is not a sys-  
tem malfunction.  
3-17  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
WARNING  
Cruise Control (if equipped)  
CAUTION  
Unevenly worn tires can cause prob-  
lems in the operation of the 2WD/i-  
AWD switch. Be sure to rotate the  
tires according to the maintenance  
schedule. Refer to “Tires” and “Main-  
tenance Schedule” in the “INSPEC-  
TION AND MAINTENANCE” section  
for proper tire rotation procedures.  
To help avoid loss of vehicle control,  
do not use the cruise control system  
when driving in heavy traffic, on slip-  
pery or winding roads, or on steep  
downgrades.  
(1)  
(4)  
79JM005  
(2)  
(3)  
The cruise control system allows you to  
maintain a steady speed without keeping  
your foot on the accelerator pedal. The  
controls for operating the cruise control  
system are on the steering wheel.  
79JM006  
You can use the cruise control system with  
the following conditions:  
• For manual transaxle vehicle, the gear  
position is in 4th, 5th or 6th.  
• For CVT vehicle, the gearshift lever is in  
“D” position, or the gear position is in  
3rd, 4th, 5th or 6th in the manual mode.  
• The vehicle speed is about 25 mph (40  
km/h) or higher.  
(1) “CRUISE” switch  
(2) “CANCELswitch  
(3) “SET/COAST” switch  
(4) “RES/ACC” switch  
3-18  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
“CRUISE” indicator light  
To Change Speed Temporarily  
When the cruising speed is maintained,  
you can temporarily accelerate or deceler-  
ate.  
To Set Cruising Speed  
1) Turn on the cruise control system by  
pushing the “CRUISE” switch (1). When  
the “CRUISE” indicator light comes on,  
you can set cruising speed.  
To accelerate, depress the accelerator  
pedal. When you take your foot off the  
pedal, your vehicle will return to the set  
speed.  
2) Accelerate or decelerate to the desired  
speed.  
3) Push the “SET/COAST” switch (3) and  
turn on the “SET” indicator light. Take  
your foot off the accelerator pedal and  
the set speed will be maintained.  
52D113  
To decelerate, depress the brake pedal.  
The set speed will be canceled and “SET”  
indicator light will go off.  
When you push the “CRUISE” switch, the  
system is on and a “CRUISE” indicator  
light on the instrument cluster will be on.  
To resume the previously set speed, push  
the “RES/ACC” switch (4) and turn on the  
“SET” indicator light again when vehicle  
speed is above 25 mph (40 km/h). The  
vehicle will accelerate to and maintain the  
previously set speed.  
WARNING  
“SET” indicator light  
If the cruising speed is set by acci-  
dent, you cannot decelerate or could  
loose control of the vehicle. This  
could lead to an accident, resulting in  
severe injury or death.  
NOTE:  
Turn off the cruise control system  
and make sure the “CRUISE” indica-  
tor light is off when the system is not  
in use.  
For CVT vehicle, when the cruising speed  
is maintained, you cannot decelerate by  
using the engine brake if you downshift  
from higher gear to 3rd in the manual  
mode.  
65D474  
When the vehicle’s speed is controlled by  
the cruise control system, a “SET” indica-  
tor light on the instrument cluster will be  
on.  
To decelerate while the cruise control is on,  
depress the brake pedal or push the “SET/  
COAST” switch (3).  
3-19  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
To Change Cruising Speed  
Cancellation of the Cruise Control  
The “SET” indicator light will go off and the  
cruise control will be canceled temporarily  
with following procedures:  
Braking  
Using the accelerator pedal  
To reset at a faster cruising speed, acceler-  
ate to the desired speed using the acceler-  
ator pedal and push the “SET/COAST”  
switch (3). The new speed will be main-  
tained.  
• Push the “CANCELswitch (2).  
• Depress the brake pedal.  
• For manual transaxle, depress the clutch  
pedal.  
• For CVT, downshift from 3rd to 2nd in the  
manual mode.  
Using the brake pedal  
To reset at a slower cruising speed, decel-  
erate to the desired speed using the brake  
pedal and push the “SET/COAST” switch  
(3). The new speed will be maintained.  
• The vehicle speed falls more than about  
20 percent from the set speed.  
• Any time the vehicle speed falls below  
25 mph (40 km/h).  
®
NOTE:  
• When the vehicle skids and ESP (if  
60G165  
When the brake pedal is depressed, the  
“SET” indicator light goes off until reset the  
cruising speed.  
equipped) is activated.  
The distance needed to bring any vehicle  
to a halt increases with the speed of the  
vehicle. The braking distance needed, for  
example, at 60 km/h (37 mph) will be  
approximately 4 times greater than the  
braking distance needed at 30 km/h (19  
mph). Start to brake the vehicle when there  
is plenty of distance between your vehicle  
and the stopping point, and slow down  
gradually.  
To resume the previously set speed, push  
the “RES/ACC” switch (4) and turn on the  
“SET” indicator light. Besides, the vehicle  
speed has to be above 25 mph (40 km/h)  
when the vehicle is not in the above condi-  
tions.  
Using the cruise control switch  
To reset at a faster cruising speed, press  
repeatedly or hold in the “RES/ACC”  
switch (4). Vehicle speed will steadily  
increase. When you release the switch, the  
new speed will be maintained.  
To turn off the cruise control system, push  
the “CRUISE” switch (1) and make sure  
the “CRUISE” indicator light is off.  
Also, if the malfunction indicator light in the  
instrument cluster comes on or blinks, the  
cruise control system will be turned off.  
To reset at a slower cruising speed, press  
repeatedly or hold in the “SET/COAST”  
switch (3) until the vehicle has slowed to  
the desired speed, then release the switch.  
The new speed will be maintained.  
NOTE:  
If you turn off the cruise control system, the  
previously set speed in the memory is  
cleared. Reset your cruising speed again.  
NOTE:  
You can adjust the set speed by approxi-  
mately 1.0 mph (1.6 km/h) by pushing a  
cruise control switch quickly.  
3-20  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
WARNING  
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS)  
(if equipped)  
WARNING  
ABS will help you avoid skidding by elec-  
tronically controlling braking pressure. It  
will also help you maintain steering control  
when braking on slippery surfaces or when  
braking hard.  
If water gets into the brake drums,  
brake performance may become poor  
and unpredictable.  
Even without reserve power in the  
brake system, you can still stop the  
vehicle by pressing the brake pedal  
harder than normally required. How-  
ever, the stopping distance may be  
longer.  
After driving through water or wash-  
ing the underside of the vehicle, test  
the brakes while driving at a slow  
speed to see if they have maintained  
their normal effectiveness. If the  
brakes are less effective than normal,  
dry them by repeatedly applying the  
brakes while driving slowly until the  
brakes have regained their normal  
effectiveness.  
The ABS works automatically, so you do  
not need any special braking technique.  
Just push the brake pedal down without  
pumping. The ABS will operate whenever it  
senses that the wheels are locking up.  
Brake Assist System  
When you slam the brakes on, the brake  
assist system judges as an emergency  
stop and provides more powerful braking  
for a driver who cannot hold down the  
brake pedal firmly.  
You may feel the brake pedal pulsate while  
the ABS is operating.  
NOTE:  
Power-Assisted Brakes  
NOTE:  
The ABS will not work if vehicle speed is  
under about 6 km/h (4mph).  
Your vehicle has power-assisted brakes. If  
power assistance is lost due to a stalled  
engine or other failures, the system is still  
fully operational on reserve power and you  
can bring the vehicle to a complete stop by  
pressing the brake pedal once and holding  
it down. The reserve power is partly used  
up when you depress the brake pedal and  
reduces each time the pedal is pressed.  
Apply smooth and even pressure to the  
pedal. Do not pump the pedal.  
If you quickly and forcefully depress the  
brakes, you may hear a clicking sound in  
the brake pedal. This is normal and indi-  
cates that the brake assist system is acti-  
vated properly.  
3-21  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
WARNING  
WARNING  
• On some types of loose surfaces  
(such as gravel, snow-covered  
roads, etc.), the stopping distance  
required for an ABS-equipped vehi-  
cle may be slightly greater than for  
a comparable vehicle with a con-  
ventional brake system. With a  
conventional brake system, skid-  
ding tires are able to “plow” the  
gravel or snow layer, shortening  
the stopping distance. ABS mini-  
mizes this resistance effect. Allow  
for extra stopping distance when  
driving on loose surfaces.  
If the ABS warning light ((1) or (2)) on  
the instrument panel comes on and  
stays on while driving, there may be a  
problem with the ABS system.  
If this happens:  
(1)  
(2)  
1) Pull off the road and stop care-  
fully.  
2) Turn the ignition switch to “LOCK”  
and then start the engine again.  
If the warning light comes on briefly  
then turns off, the system is normal.  
If the warning light still stays on,  
have the system inspected by your  
SUZUKI dealer immediately. If the  
ABS system becomes inoperative,  
the brake system will function as an  
ordinary brake system that has no  
ABS.  
(3)  
65D451  
(1) ABS warning light Type 1  
(2) ABS warning light Type 2  
(3) Brake system warning light  
• On regular paved roads, some driv-  
ers may be able to obtain slightly  
shorter stopping distances with  
conventional brake systems than  
with ABS.  
• In both of the above conditions,  
ABS will still offer the advantage of  
helping you maintain directional  
control. However, remember that  
ABS will not compensate for bad  
road or weather conditions or poor  
driver judgment. Use good judg-  
ment and do not drive faster than  
conditions will safely allow.  
3-22  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
WARNING  
How the ABS Works  
Electronic Stability Program  
A computer continuously monitors wheel  
speed. The computer compares the  
changes in wheel speed when braking. If  
the wheels slow suddenly, indicating a  
skidding situation, the computer will  
change braking pressure several times  
each second to prevent the wheels from  
locking. When you start your vehicle or  
when you accelerate after a hard stop, you  
may hear a momentary motor or clicking  
noise as the system resets or checks itself.  
®
(ESP ) (if equipped)  
If the ABS warning light ((1) or (2))  
and the Brake system warning light  
(3) on the instrument panel simulta-  
neously stay on or come on when  
driving, both anti-lock function and  
rear brake force control function (pro-  
portioning valve function) of the ABS  
system may have failed. This could  
cause the rear wheels to skid or the  
vehicle to spin during braking on a  
slippery road or hard braking on a  
dry paved road. If both warning lights  
come on, drive carefully, avoiding  
hard braking as much as possible,  
and ask your SUZUKI dealer to  
inspect the ABS system immediately.  
®
ESP is a registered trademark of Daimler  
AG.  
®
The Electronic Stability Program (ESP )  
helps to control the vehicle during corner-  
ing if front wheels or rear wheels skid. It  
also assists you in maintaining traction  
while accelerating on loose or slippery  
road surfaces. It does this by regulating the  
engine’s output, and by selectively apply-  
WARNING  
®
ing the brakes. In addition, ESP helps to  
The ABS may not work properly if  
tires or wheels other than those  
specified in the owner’s manual are  
used. This is because the ABS works  
by comparing changes in wheel  
speed. When replacing tires or  
wheels, use only the size and type  
specified in this owner’s manual.  
avoid skidding by controlling braking pres-  
sure.  
WARNING  
®
The ESP cannot enhance the vehi-  
cle’s driving stability in all situations  
and does not control your vehicle’s  
®
entire braking system. The ESP can-  
not prevent accidents, including  
those resulting from excessive speed  
in turns, or hydroplaning. Only a safe  
and attentive driver can prevent acci-  
®
dents. The capabilities of an ESP -  
equipped vehicle must never be used  
as a substitute for careful driving.  
3-23  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
WARNING  
®
The ESP has the following three systems:  
Anti-Lock Braking System (ABS)  
ABS will help you avoid skidding by elec-  
tronically controlling braking pressure. It  
will also help you maintain steering control  
when braking on slippery surfaces or when  
braking hard. The ABS works automati-  
cally, so you do not have to use any special  
braking technique. Just push the brake  
pedal down without pumping. The ABS will  
operate whenever it senses that wheels  
are locking up. You may feel the brake  
pedal pulsate while the ABS is operating.  
(For more information on ABS, see “Brak-  
ing” in the “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE”  
section.)  
Stability Control System  
®
• The ESP may not work properly if  
The vehicle stability control system helps  
provide integrated control of systems such  
as anti-lock brakes, traction control, engine  
control, etc. This system automatically  
controls the brakes and engine to help pre-  
vent the vehicle from skidding when cor-  
nering on a slippery road surface or when  
turning the steering wheel abruptly.  
tires or wheels other than those  
specified in the Owner’s Manual are  
used. When replacing tires or  
wheels, use only the size and type  
specified in this Owner’s Manual.  
®
• The ESP may not work properly if  
tires are not inflated to the recom-  
mended tire inflation pressure.  
®
• The ESP may not work properly if  
Traction Control System  
tires are fitted with tire chains.  
The traction control system automatically  
helps prevent the spinning of wheels when  
the vehicle is started or accelerated on  
slippery road surfaces. The system oper-  
ates only if it senses that some of the  
wheels are spinning or beginning to lose  
traction. When this happens, the system  
operates the front or rear brakes and  
reduces engine power to limit wheel spin.  
®
• The ESP may not work properly if  
the tires are excessively worn. Be  
sure to replace tires when the tread  
wear indicators in the grooves  
appear on the tread surface.  
NOTE:  
If the ABS system is activated, you may  
hear a clunking noise and/or feel pulsating  
in the brake pedal. This is normal and indi-  
cates that the brake fluid pressure is being  
controlled properly.  
®
• The ESP is not a substitute for  
winter tires or tire chains on a snow  
covered road.  
NOTE:  
WARNING  
You may hear a clicking sound in the  
engine compartment for a few seconds  
when you start the engine or just after the  
vehicle begins to move. This means that  
the above systems are in the self-check  
mode. This sound does not indicate a mal-  
function.  
®
• The ESP may not work properly if  
engine related parts such as the  
muffler are not equivalent to stan-  
dard equipment or are extremely  
deteriorated.  
• Do not modify the vehicle’s sus-  
®
pension since the ESP may not  
operate correctly.  
3-24  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
®
The ESP indicator lights are described  
NOTE:  
below:  
When you disconnect and re-connect the  
CAUTION  
®
battery, ESP system functions other than  
If the “ESP” warning light comes on,  
or stays on while driving, there may  
ABS will be deactivated and the slip indica-  
tor light will blink 1 time per second. In this  
case, use the following procedure to re-  
SLIP Indicator Light  
®
be a malfunction of the ESP sys-  
tems (other than ABS). You should  
have the systems inspected by an  
authorized SUZUKI dealer.  
®
activate the ESP systems:  
1) Drive your vehicle straight ahead with-  
out tire slippage at a speed until the slip  
indicator is turned off. (Drive straight for  
approximately 35 km/h (22 mph) or  
more and 10 seconds or more.)  
NOTE:  
When the “ESP” warning light comes on,  
or stays on while driving, indicating a mal-  
52KM133  
2) The slip indicator light will go out and  
®
®
®
When one of the ESP systems other than  
function of the ESP systems (other than  
the ESP systems (other than ABS) will  
ABS is activated, the SLIP indicator light in  
the instrument cluster blinks 5 times per  
second.  
ABS), the brake system will function as an  
be re-activated.  
®
ordinary ABS that has no additional ESP  
functions.  
It may take more than few seconds before  
the slip indicator light goes out depending  
on the road surface condition.  
CAUTION  
“ESP OFF” Indicator Light  
“ESP” Warning Light  
If the SLIP indicator light comes on  
and stays on while driving, there may  
®
be a malfunction of the ESP sys-  
tems (other than ABS). You should  
have the systems inspected by an  
authorized SUZUKI dealer.  
66J032  
NOTE:  
®
66J031  
When the SLIP indicator light comes on  
and stays on while driving, indicating a  
You should turn the ESP on during your  
ordinary driving, so that you have the ben-  
®
When the ESP systems (other than ABS)  
®
®
malfunction of the ESP systems (other  
efits of all of the ESP systems.  
have a system malfunction, the “ESP”  
warning light in the instrument cluster  
comes on.  
than ABS), the brake system will function  
as an ordinary ABS with no additional  
®
It may be required to turn the ESP sys-  
tems (other than ABS) off if your vehicle is  
stuck in sand, mud, or snow, where wheel  
spin is necessary.  
®
ESP functions.  
3-25  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
Low Tire Pressure Warning Light  
“ESP OFF” switch  
Tire Pressure Monitoring  
System (TPMS)  
The tire pressure monitoring system is  
designed to alert you when one or more of  
the tires on your vehicle is significantly  
under-inflated. A Tire Pressure Monitoring  
System (TPMS) sensor containing  
a
unique identification code is mounted on  
each wheel. The TPMS sensors transmit  
tire pressure signals to a central receiver  
which relays the information to a tire pres-  
sure monitoring system controller. When  
the inflation pressure of one or more tires  
indicates significant under-inflation, the low  
tire pressure warning light shown below  
comes on.  
52D305  
WARNING  
Each tire, including the spare (if pro-  
vided), should be checked monthly  
when cold and inflated to the inflation  
pressure recommended by the vehi-  
cle manufacturer on the vehicle plac-  
ard or tire inflation pressure label. (If  
your vehicle has tires of a different  
size than the size indicated on the  
vehicle placard or tire inflation pres-  
sure label, you should determine the  
proper tire inflation pressure for  
those tires.)  
62J142  
When the “ESP OFF” switch located at the  
center console is pushed and held to turn  
off the ESP systems (other than ABS),  
the “ESP OFF” indicator light in the instru-  
ment cluster comes on.  
When you have turned the ESP systems  
(other than ABS) off, make sure to turn  
them back on before resuming ordinary  
driving.  
When you push the “ESP OFF” switch  
again, the “ESP OFF” indicator light will go  
out and all of the ESP systems will be  
®
®
As an added safety feature, your  
vehicle has been equipped with a tire  
pressure monitoring system (TPMS)  
that illuminates a low tire pressure  
telltale when one or more of your  
tires is significantly under-inflated.  
Accordingly, when the low tire pres-  
sure telltale illuminates, you should  
stop and check your tires as soon as  
possible, and inflate them to the  
proper pressure.  
®
activated.  
ABS Warning Light / Brake System  
Warning Light  
See “Braking” in the “OPERATING YOUR  
VEHICLE” section.  
(Continued)  
3-26  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
WARNING  
WARNING  
WARNING  
(Continued)  
If the low tire pressure warning light  
does not come on when the ignition  
is turned to the “ON” position, or  
comes on and blinks while driving  
there may be a problem with the tire  
pressure monitoring system. Have  
your vehicle inspected by an autho-  
rized SUZUKI dealer. Even if the light  
turns off after blinking, indicating  
that the monitoring system has  
recovered, make sure to have an  
authorized SUZUKI dealer check the  
system.  
If the low tire pressure warning light  
comes on and stays on, reduce your  
speed and avoid abrupt steering and  
braking. Stop in a safe place as soon  
as possible and check your tires.  
Driving on  
a
significantly under-  
inflated tire causes the tire to over-  
heat and can lead to tire failure.  
Under-inflation also reduces fuel effi-  
ciency and tire tread life, and may  
affect the vehicle’s handling and  
stopping ability.  
Please note that the TPMS is not a  
substitute for proper tire mainte-  
nance, and it is the driver’s responsi-  
bility to maintain correct tire  
pressure, even if under-inflation has  
not reached the level to trigger illumi-  
nation of the TPMS low tire pressure  
telltale.  
• If you have a flat tire, replace it with  
the spare tire. Refer to “Jacking  
Instructions” in the “EMERGENCY  
SERVICE”  
section.  
Refer  
to  
“Replacing Tires and/or Wheels”  
for instructions on how to restore  
normal operation of the tire pres-  
sure monitoring system after you  
have had a flat tire.  
• If one or more of your tires is  
under-inflated adjust the inflation  
pressure in all of your tires to the  
recommended inflation pressure as  
soon as possible.  
Be aware that driving on a signifi-  
cantly under-inflated tire can cause  
the tire to overheat and can lead to  
tire failure, and may affect steering  
control and brake effectiveness. This  
could lead to an accident, resulting in  
severe injury or death.  
WARNING  
The load rating of your tires is  
reduced at lower inflation pressures.  
If your tires become even moderately  
under-inflated, the vehicle load may  
exceed the load rating of the tires,  
which can lead to tire failure. The low  
tire pressure warning light will not  
alert you of this condition. The warn-  
ing light will only come on when one  
or more of your tires become signifi-  
cantly under-inflated. Check and  
adjust your tire inflation pressure at  
least once a month. Refer to “Tires”  
in the “INSPECTION AND MAINTE-  
NANCE” section.  
WARNING  
The tire pressure monitoring system  
is not a substitute for regular tire  
pressure inspections. Check tire  
inflation pressures monthly when  
cold and set to the recommended  
inflation pressure as specified on the  
vehicle’s tire information placard and  
in the owner’s manual. Refer to  
“Tires” in the “INSPECTION AND  
MAINTENANCE” section.  
3-27  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
The low tire pressure warning light can  
come on due to normal causes such as  
natural air leaks and pressure changes  
caused by changes in temperature or  
atmospheric pressure. Adjusting the air  
pressure in the tires to the pressure shown  
on the tire information placard should  
cause the low tire pressure warning light to  
turn off.  
turns off after coming on, make sure to  
check the inflation pressure of all tires.  
To reduce the chance that the low tire  
pressure warning light will come on due  
to normal changes in temperature and  
atmospheric pressure, it is important to  
check and adjust the tire pressures  
when the tires are cold. Tires that  
appear to be at the specified pressure  
when checked after driving, when the  
tires are warm, could have pressure  
below the specification when the tires  
cool down. Also, tires that are inflated to  
the specified pressure in a warm garage  
may have pressure below the specifica-  
tion when the vehicle is driven outside in  
very cold temperature. If you adjust the  
tire pressure in a garage that is warmer  
than the outside temperature, you  
should add 1 psi to the recommended  
cold tire inflation pressure for every 10°F  
difference between garage temperature  
and outside temperature.  
TPMS Malfunction Indicator  
WARNING  
Your vehicle has also been equipped  
with a TPMS malfunction indicator to  
indicate when the system is not oper-  
ating properly.  
WARNING  
If the light turns on again shortly after  
adjusting the pressure in your tires, you  
may have a flat tire. If you have a flat tire,  
replace it with the spare tire. Refer to  
“Jacking Instructions” in the “EMER-  
GENCY SERVICE” section. Refer to  
“Replacing Tires and/or Wheels” for  
instructions on how to restore normal oper-  
ation of the tire pressure monitoring sys-  
tem after you have had a flat tire.  
The TPMS malfunction indicator is  
combined with the low tire pressure  
telltale. When the system detects a  
malfunction, the telltale will flash for  
approximately one minute and then  
remain continuously illuminated.  
This sequence will continue upon  
subsequent vehicle start-ups as long  
as the malfunction exists.  
NOTE:  
• When the tire inflation pressure is  
adjusted in high altitude areas, the low  
tire pressure light may not turn off even  
after tire inflation pressure adjustment.  
In this case, adjust the inflation pressure  
to a slightly higher pressure than is  
shown on the tire information placard.  
• The low tire pressure warning light may  
turn off temporarily after coming on. This  
could be due to surface temperature  
increases after long distance driving or  
traveling to a high temperature area.  
Even if the tire pressure warning light  
For tire inflation pressure information, refer  
to “Tire Inflation Pressure” in the “INSPEC-  
TION AND MAINTENANCE” section.  
3-28  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
When you turn off the engine, however, the  
malfunction indicator resets. It takes about  
ten minutes after restarting the engine for  
the malfunction to be detected again and  
for the light to start flashing.  
• When the TPMS sensor’s electronic sig-  
nal is disturbed in one of the following  
ways:  
– Electric devices or facilities using simi-  
lar radio wave frequencies are nearby.  
– A lot of snow or ice covers the vehicle,  
in particular, around the wheels or  
wheel housings.  
CAUTION  
• The tire pressure sensors can be  
damaged by the installation or  
removal of tires. When tires must  
be repaired or replaced, we highly  
recommend that you have them  
repaired or replaced by an autho-  
rized SUZUKI dealer.  
• Do not use liquid sealants for a flat  
tire as air pressure sensors can be  
damaged.  
WARNING  
When the malfunction indicator is  
illuminated, the system may not be  
able to detect or signal low tire pres-  
sure as intended. TPMS malfunctions  
may occur for a variety of reasons,  
including the installation of replace-  
ment or alternate tires or wheels on  
the vehicle that prevent the TPMS  
from functioning properly. Always  
check the TPMS malfunction telltale  
after replacing one or more tires or  
wheels on your vehicle to ensure that  
the replacement or alternate tires and  
wheels allow the TPMS to continue to  
function properly.  
– Snow tires or tire chains are used.  
• When you use non-genuine SUZUKI  
wheels or tires.  
Replacing Tires and/or Wheels  
If you get a flat tire, Suzuki recommends  
that you have an authorized SUZUKI  
dealer mount a new tire on the wheel that  
had the flat tire, and reinstall this tire on the  
vehicle in place of the spare. The TPMS is  
already set up to recognize the ID code of  
the original wheel, and normal TPMS oper-  
ation will be restored.  
• If the low tire pressure warning  
light comes on frequently, there  
may be something wrong with one  
of the tires or with the monitoring  
system.  
Have  
your  
vehicle  
inspected by an authorized SUZUKI  
dealer.  
TPMS Limitations  
If you need to replace original wheels on  
your vehicle, your dealer must make sure  
that TPMS sensors are installed in the new  
wheels and must set up the TPMS to rec-  
ognize the new sensors.  
The tire pressure monitoring system may  
not function properly under certain circum-  
stances. In the following situations, the low  
tire pressure warning light may come on  
and remain on or may blink.  
• When you replace a flat tire with the  
spare tire.  
• When you include the spare tire during a  
tire rotation.  
• When the TPMS sensor is damaged dur-  
ing a tire replacement or liquid sealants  
are used to repair a flat tire.  
NOTE:  
A TPMS sensor is not installed in the spare  
tire. You should use the spare tire only in  
an emergency situation, and should  
replace the spare tire as soon as possible  
to restore normal TPMS operation.  
3-29  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
WARNING  
Only use tires and wheels recom-  
mended by SUZUKI as standard or  
optional equipment for your vehicle.  
Use of tires or wheels not recom-  
mended by SUZUKI can result in  
TPMS failure. Refer to “Tires” in the  
“INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE”  
section for additional information.  
For Vehicles Sold in U.S.A.  
This device complies with Part 15 of the  
FCC Rules.  
Operation is subject to the following two  
conditions:  
1) This device may not cause harmful  
interference.  
2) This device must accept any interfer-  
ence received, including interference  
that may cause undesired operation.  
NOTE:  
Changes or modifications not expressly  
approved by the party responsible for com-  
pliance could void the user’s authority to  
operate the equipment.  
Traveling to CANADA  
Please note that service for the tire pres-  
sure monitoring system may not be avail-  
able in CANADA should there be any  
problems or malfunctions in the system.  
3-30  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE  
MEMO  
3-31  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
DRIVING TIPS  
DRIVING TIPS  
Break-In ................................................................................ 4-1  
Catalytic Converter ............................................................. 4-1  
Improving Fuel Economy ................................................... 4-2  
Highway Driving .................................................................. 4-3  
Driving on Hills .................................................................... 4-3  
Driving on Slippery Roads ................................................. 4-4  
4
60G409  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel: 3, 8  
DRIVING TIPS  
Break-In  
Catalytic Converter  
CAUTION  
The future performance and reliabil-  
ity of the engine depends on the care  
and restraint exercised during its  
early life. It is especially important to  
observe the following precautions  
during the initial 960 km (600 miles)  
of vehicle operation.  
52D078S  
WARNING  
• After starting, do not race the  
engine. Warm it up gradually.  
• Avoid prolonged vehicle operation  
at a constant speed. Moving parts  
will break in better if you vary your  
speed.  
• Wear Your Seat Belts at All Times.  
Even though air bags are equipped  
at the front seating positions, the  
driver and all passengers should  
be properly restrained at all times,  
using the seat belts provided. Refer  
to the “Seat Belts and Child  
Restraint Systems” section for  
instructions on proper use of the  
seat belts.  
• Never drive while under the influ-  
ence of alcohol or other drugs.  
Alcohol and drugs can seriously  
impair your ability to drive safely,  
greatly increasing the risk of injury  
to yourself and others. You should  
also avoid driving when you are  
tired, sick, irritated or under stress.  
68KM085  
The purpose of the catalytic converter is to  
minimize the amount of harmful pollutants  
in your vehicle’s exhaust. Use of leaded  
fuel in vehicles equipped with catalytic  
converters is prohibited by federal law,  
because lead deactivates the pollutant-  
reducing components of the catalyst sys-  
tem.  
• Start off from a stop slowly. Avoid  
full throttle starts.  
• Avoid hard stopping, especially  
during the first 320 km (200 miles)  
of driving.  
• Do not drive slowly with the tran-  
saxle in a high gear.  
• Drive the vehicle at moderate  
engine speeds.  
The converter is designed to last the life of  
the vehicle under normal usage and when  
unleaded fuel is used. No special mainte-  
nance is required on the converter. How-  
ever, it is very important to keep the engine  
properly tuned. Engine misfiring, which  
can result from an improperly tuned  
engine, may cause overheating of the cat-  
alyst. This may result in permanent heat  
damage to the catalyst and other vehicle  
components.  
4-1  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster: 8  
DRIVING TIPS  
Improving Fuel Economy  
CAUTION  
The following instructions will help you  
improve fuel economy.  
To minimize the possibility of catalyst  
or other vehicle damage:  
• Maintain the engine in the proper  
operating condition.  
• In the event of an engine malfunc-  
tion, particularly one involving  
engine misfire or other apparent  
loss of performance, have the vehi-  
cle serviced promptly.  
• Do not shut off the engine or inter-  
rupt the ignition when the transaxle  
is in gear and the vehicle is in  
motion.  
• Do not try to start the engine by  
pushing or towing the vehicle or  
coasting down a hill.  
• Do not idle the engine with any  
spark plug wires disconnected or  
removed, such as during diagnos-  
tic testing.  
• Do not idle the vehicle for pro-  
longed periods if idling seems  
rough or there are other malfunc-  
tions.  
• Do not allow the fuel tank to get  
near the empty level.  
Avoid excessive idling  
If you are to wait for more than a minute  
while you are parked, stop the engine and  
start it again later. When warming up a  
cold engine, allow the engine to idle until  
the temperature gauge pointer comes up  
to the “C” position. In this position, the  
engine is sufficiently warm for starting off.  
Avoid “jackrabbit” starts  
54G584S  
Fast starts away from lights or stop signs  
will consume fuel unnecessarily and  
shorten engine life. Start off slowly.  
WARNING  
Be careful where you park and drive;  
the catalytic converter and other  
exhaust components can get very  
hot. As with any vehicle, do not park  
or operate this vehicle in areas where  
combustible materials such as dry  
grass or leaves can come in contact  
with a hot exhaust system.  
Avoid unnecessary stops  
Avoid unnecessary deceleration and stop-  
ping. Try to maintain a slow, steady speed  
whenever possible. Slowing down and then  
accelerating again uses more fuel.  
Keep a steady cruising speed  
Keep as constant a speed as road and traf-  
fic conditions will permit.  
4-2  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Warning and Indicator Lights: 8  
DRIVING TIPS  
EXAMPLE  
Highway Driving  
Driving on Hills  
When driving at highway speeds, pay  
attention to the following:  
• Stopping  
distance  
progressively  
increases with vehicle speed. Apply the  
brakes far enough ahead of the stopping  
point to allow for the extra stopping dis-  
tance.  
• On rainy days, “Hydroplaning” can occur.  
“Hydroplaning” is the loss of direct con-  
tact between the road surface and the  
vehicle’s tires due to a water film forming  
between them. Steering or braking the  
vehicle while “Hydroplaning” can be very  
difficult, and loss of control can occur.  
Keep speed down when the road surface  
is wet.  
• At high speeds, the vehicle may be  
affected by side winds. Therefore,  
reduce speed and be prepared for unex-  
pected buffeting, which can occur at the  
exits of tunnels, when passing by a cut of  
a hill, or when being overtaken by large  
vehicles, etc.  
60A183S  
Keep the air cleaner clean  
80J2066  
If the air cleaner is clogged with dust, there  
will be greater intake resistance, resulting  
in decreased power output and increased  
fuel consumption.  
• When climbing steep hills, the car may  
begin to slow down and show a lack of  
power. If this happens, you should shift  
to a lower gear so that the engine will  
again be operating in its normal power  
range. Shift rapidly to prevent the car  
from losing momentum.  
• When driving down a hill, the engine  
should be used for braking by shifting to  
next lower gear. (Do this with EITHER a  
CVT or manual transaxle.)  
Keep weight to a minimum  
The heavier the load, the more fuel the  
vehicle consumes. Take out any luggage  
or cargo when it is not necessary.  
Keep tire pressure correct  
Underinflation of the tires can waste fuel  
due to increased running resistance of the  
tires. Keep your tires inflated to the correct  
pressure shown on the label located below  
the driver’s side door latch striker.  
4-3  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Warning and Indicator Lights: 8  
DRIVING TIPS  
If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck  
If your vehicle gets stuck in snow, mud or  
sand, follow the directions below:  
Driving on Slippery Roads  
WARNING  
Try not to hold the brake pedal down  
too long or too often while going  
down a steep or long hill. This could  
cause the brakes to overheat, result-  
ing in reduced braking efficiency.  
Failure to take this precaution could  
result in loss of vehicle control.  
1) Shift the transaxle back and forth  
between a forward range (or first gear  
for manual transaxle) and reverse. This  
will create a rocking motion which may  
give you enough momentum to free the  
vehicle. Press gently on the accelerator  
to keep wheel spinning to a minimum  
wheel rpm. Remove your foot from the  
accelerator while shifting.  
CAUTION  
Do not race the engine. Excessive  
wheel spin will cause the tires to dig  
deeper, making it more difficult to free  
the vehicle.  
When descending  
a
down hill,  
NEVER turn the ignition key to the  
“OFF” position. Emission control  
system and CVT (if equipped) dam-  
age may result.  
60G089S  
2) If your vehicle remains stuck after a few  
minutes of rocking, get another vehicle  
to pull your vehicle out.  
Under wet road conditions you should  
drive at a lower speed than on dry roads  
due to possible slippage of tires during  
braking. When driving on icy, snow-cov-  
ered, or muddy roads, reduce your speed  
and avoid sudden acceleration, abrupt  
braking, or sharp steering movements.  
WARNING  
Do not allow anyone to stand near the  
vehicle when you are rocking it, and  
do not spin the wheels faster than an  
indicated 40 km/h (25 mph) on the  
speedometer. Personal injury and/or  
vehicle damage may result from spin-  
ning the wheels too fast.  
intelligent All Wheel Drive (i-AWD)  
Models  
Your i-AWD provides greater traction on  
slippery roads than 2-wheel drive models.  
However, your i-AWD will not have as  
much traction in deep snow, mud or sand  
as multipurpose 4WD vehicles. You should  
not attempt to drive your i-AWD in deep  
snow, mud or sand. i-AWD models are not  
sport/utility vehicles, and are not designed  
for off-road use.  
4-4  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Warning and Indicator Lights: 8  
DRIVING TIPS  
CAUTION  
Do not drive through deep or rushing  
water  
Driving in deep or rushing water can be  
hazardous. You could lose control of the  
vehicle and the occupants could drown.  
Also, your vehicle could be seriously dam-  
aged. To avoid these risks, observe the fol-  
lowing instructions and precautions.  
Do not continue rocking the vehicle  
for more than a few minutes. Pro-  
longed rocking can cause engine  
overheating, transaxle or transfer  
case damage or tire damage.  
• Do not drive through deep or rushing  
water. Deep or rushing water, such as  
fast-moving streams or floodwaters,  
could carry your vehicle away from your  
intended path. The water is too deep if it  
covers your wheel hubs, axles or  
exhaust tailpipe. Know the depth of the  
water before you attempt to drive  
through it.  
• If water blocks the tailpipe, the engine  
may not start or run. If the water is deep  
enough to get drawn into the engine  
intake system, the engine will be badly  
damaged.  
• Submerged brakes will have poor brak-  
ing performance. Drive slowly and care-  
fully. Driving slowly will also help avoid  
water splashing onto the ignition system,  
which could cause the engine to stall.  
• Even when driving through shallow or  
still waters, drive carefully since the  
water may be hiding ground hazards  
such as holes, ditches or bumps.  
Tire Chains  
Tire chains should only be used if they are  
needed to increase traction or are required  
by law. Make sure that the chains you use  
are small-link chains or cable-type chains  
and are the correct size for your vehicle’s  
tires. Also make sure that there is enough  
clearance between the fenders and the  
chains as installed on the tires.  
54G638S  
Install the chains on the front tires tightly,  
according to the chain manufacturer’s  
instructions. Retighten the chains after  
driving about 1.0 km (1/2 mile) if neces-  
sary. With the chains installed, drive slowly.  
CAUTION  
If you hear the chains hitting against  
the vehicle body while driving, stop  
and tighten them.  
If your vehicle is equipped with full  
wheel caps, remove the wheel caps  
before installing the chains or the  
wheel caps can be damaged by the  
chain bands.  
4-5  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Warning and Indicator Lights: 8  
DRIVING TIPS  
WARNING  
WARNING  
In addition to following the driving  
tips in this section, it is important to  
observe the following precautions.  
• Make sure your tires are in good  
condition and always maintain the  
specified tire pressure. Refer to  
“Tires” in the “INSPECTION AND  
(Continued)  
• After driving through water, test the  
brakes while driving at a slow  
speed to see if they have main-  
tained their normal effectiveness. If  
the brakes are less effective than  
normal, dry them by repeatedly  
applying the brakes while driving  
slowly until the brakes have  
regained their normal effective-  
ness.  
MAINTENANCE”  
details.  
section  
for  
• Do not use tires other than those  
specified by SUZUKI. Never use dif-  
ferent sizes or types of tires on the  
front and rear wheels. For informa-  
tion regarding the specified tires,  
refer to the Tire Information Label  
located on the driver’s side door  
pillar.  
• Never use oversized tires or special  
shocks and springs to raise (jack  
up) your vehicle. This will change  
its handling characteristics. Over-  
sized tires may also rub against the  
fender over bumps, causing vehicle  
damage or tire failure.  
(Continued)  
4-6  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Warning and Indicator Lights: 8  
A/T Selector Position Indicator: 8  
Speedometer/Odometer/Trip meter: 8  
DRIVING TIPS  
MEMO  
4-7  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Heating and Air Conditioning System ............................... 5-1  
Radio Antenna ..................................................................... 5-15  
Audio Systems .................................................................... 5-15  
Fuel Filler Cap ..................................................................... 5-43  
Engine Hood ........................................................................ 5-44  
Sun Visor ............................................................................. 5-45  
Interior Light Switch ........................................................... 5-45  
Luggage Compartment Light (SX4) ................................... 5-46  
Trunk Light (SX4 SEDAN) ................................................... 5-46  
Spot Light ............................................................................ 5-47  
Accessory Socket (if equipped) ......................................... 5-47  
Cigarette Lighter and Ashtray (if equipped) ..................... 5-47  
Assist Grips (if equipped) .................................................. 5-48  
Glove Box ............................................................................ 5-49  
Cup Holder and Storage Area (if equipped) ..................... 5-49  
Front Seat Back Pocket (if equipped) ............................... 5-50  
Armrest (if equipped) .......................................................... 5-51  
Shopping Hook (if equipped) ............................................. 5-51  
Floor Mats (if equipped) ..................................................... 5-51  
Luggage Compartment Cover (if equipped) ..................... 5-52  
Luggage Compartment Board (if equipped) ..................... 5-53  
Roof Rails or Roof Rack Anchors (if equipped) ............... 5-55  
Frame Hooks ....................................................................... 5-56  
5
60G407  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Parking Brake Lever: 6  
Pedals: 6  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Air Outlet  
Heating and Air Conditioning  
System  
There are three types of heating and air  
conditioning systems as follows:  
EXAMPLE  
• Heating System  
• Manual Heating and Air Conditioning  
System  
• Automatic Heating and Air Conditioning  
System (Climate Control)  
80JM044  
1. Windshield defroster outlet  
2. Side defroster outlet  
3. Side outlet  
4. Center outlet  
5. Floor outlet  
5-1  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Pedals: 6  
Gearshift Lever: 10  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Side outlet  
Air flow selector (3)  
Heating System  
Description of Controls  
(c)  
(4)  
(b)  
(d)  
(a)  
(e)  
63J048  
(1)  
(2)  
(3)  
This is used to select one of the functions  
described below.  
63J193  
Temperature selector (1)  
This is used to select the temperature by  
turning the selector.  
Ventilation (a)  
Blower speed selector (2)  
This is used to turn on the blower and to  
select blower speed by turning the selec-  
tor.  
79J065  
63J045  
Temperature-controlled air comes out of  
the center and side air outlets.  
When “Open”, air comes out regardless of  
the air flow selector position.  
5-2  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Gearshift Lever: 10  
Fuel Filler Cap: 5  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Bi-level (b)  
Heat & defrost (d)  
Air intake selector (4)  
(f)  
(g)  
79J066  
79J068  
63J047  
Temperature-controlled air comes out of  
the floor outlets and cooler air comes out  
of the center and side outlets. When the  
temperature selector (1) is in the fully  
COLD position or fully HOT position, how-  
ever, the air from the floor outlets and the  
air from the center and side outlets will be  
the same temperature.  
Temperature-controlled air comes out of  
the floor outlets, the windshield defroster  
outlets, the side defroster outlets and the  
side outlets.  
This selector is used to select the following  
modes.  
Fresh Air (f)  
When this mode is selected, the indicator  
light will go off and outside air is used.  
Defrost (e)  
Recirculated Air (g)  
When this mode is selected, the indicator  
light will come on, outside air is shut out  
and inside air is recirculated. This mode is  
suitable when driving through dusty or pol-  
luted air such as in a tunnel, or when  
attempting to quickly cool down the inte-  
rior.  
Heat (c)  
79J069  
Temperature-controlled air comes out of  
the windshield defroster outlets, the side  
defroster outlets and the side outlets.  
“FRESH AIR” and “RECIRCULATED AIR”  
are switched alternately each time the air  
intake selector is pushed.  
79J067  
Temperature-controlled air comes out of  
the floor outlets and the side outlets, also  
comes out of the windshield defroster out-  
lets and also comes slightly out of the side  
defroster outlets.  
NOTE:  
If you select “RECIRCULATED AIR” for an  
extended period of time, the air in the vehi-  
cle can become contaminated. Therefore,  
you should occasionally select “FRESH  
AIR”.  
5-3  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuel Filler Cap: 5  
Folding Rear Seats: 3  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
EXAMPLE  
perature position, and the blower speed  
selector to the desired blower speed posi-  
tion. Unless the temperature selector is in  
the fully COLD position or fully HOT posi-  
tion, the air that comes out of the center  
and side outlets will be cooler than the air  
that comes out of the floor outlets.  
System Operating Instructions  
Natural ventilation  
Select “VENTILATION” and “FRESH AIR”,  
the temperature selector to the desired  
temperature position, and the blower  
speed selector to “OFF”. Fresh air will flow  
through the vehicle during driving.  
Defrosting/Feet warmed heating  
Forced ventilation  
Select “HEAT & DEFROST” and “FRESH  
AIR”, the temperature selector to the  
desired temperature position, and the  
blower speed selector to HIGH. When the  
windshield has become clear, set the  
blower speed selector to the desired  
blower speed position.  
The control settings are the same as for  
natural ventilation except you set the  
blower speed selector to a position other  
than “OFF”.  
Normal heating (using outside air)  
Select “HEAT” and “FRESH AIR”, the tem-  
perature selector to the desired tempera-  
ture position and the blower speed selector  
to the desired blower speed position. Set-  
ting the blower speed selector to a higher  
blower speed position increases heating  
efficiency.  
79J070  
NOTE:  
Defrosting  
If you need maximum defrosting, adjust the  
temperature selector to the HOT end and  
adjust the side outlets so the air blows on  
the side window, in addition to the above  
Defrosting steps.  
Select “DEFROST” and “FRESH AIR”, the  
temperature selector to the desired tem-  
perature position (higher temperature pro-  
vides more efficient defrosting), and the  
blower speed selector to HIGH. When the  
windshield has become clear, set the  
blower speed selector to the desired  
blower speed position.  
Quick heating (using recirculated air)  
The control settings are the same as for  
normal heating except you select “RECIR-  
CULATED AIR”. If you use this heating  
method for an extended period of time, the  
air in the vehicle can become contami-  
nated and the windows can become misty.  
Therefore, use this method only for quick  
heating and change to the normal heating  
method as soon as possible.  
Head cooled/Feet warmed heating  
Select “BI-LEVELand “FRESH AIR”, the  
temperature selector to the desired tem-  
5-4  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Folding Rear Seats: 3  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Air flow selector (3)  
Ventilation (a)  
Manual Heating and Air  
Conditioning System  
(c)  
Description of Controls  
(4)  
(b)  
(d)  
79J065  
Temperature-controlled air comes out of  
the center and side air outlets.  
(a)  
(e)  
Bi-level (b)  
80JC043  
This is used to select one of the functions  
described below.  
(1)  
(5)  
(2)  
(3)  
80JC042  
79J066  
Temperature selector (1)  
Temperature-controlled air comes out of  
the floor outlets and cooler air comes out  
of the center and side outlets. When the  
temperature selector (1) is in the fully  
COLD position or fully HOT position, how-  
ever, the air from the floor outlets and the  
air from the center and side outlets will be  
the same temperature.  
This is used to select the temperature by  
turning the selector.  
Blower speed selector (2)  
This is used to turn on the blower and to  
select blower speed by turning the selec-  
tor.  
5-5  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Folding Rear Seats: 3  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Heat (c)  
Defrost (e)  
Air intake selector (4)  
(f)  
(g)  
79J067  
79J069  
63J047  
Temperature-controlled air comes out of  
the floor outlets and the side outlets, also  
comes out of the windshield defroster out-  
lets and also comes slightly out of the side  
defroster outlets.  
Temperature-controlled air comes out of  
the windshield defroster outlets, the side  
defroster outlets and the side outlets.  
This selector is used to select the following  
modes.  
Fresh Air (f)  
When this mode is selected, the indicator  
light will go off and outside air is used.  
NOTE:  
When the air flow selector (3) is turned  
either to “Heat & defrost (d)” or “Defrost  
(e)”, the air conditioning system will come  
on and the “FRESH AIR” mode will be  
selected automatically.  
Heat & defrost (d)  
Recirculated Air (g)  
When this mode is selected, the indicator  
light will come on, outside air is shut out  
and inside air is recirculated. This mode is  
suitable when driving through dusty or pol-  
luted air such as in a tunnel, or when  
attempting to quickly cool down the inte-  
rior.  
79J068  
Temperature-controlled air comes out of  
the floor outlets, the windshield defroster  
outlets, the side defroster outlets and the  
side outlets.  
“FRESH AIR” and “RECIRCULATED AIR”  
are switched alternately each time the air  
intake selector is pushed.  
NOTE:  
If you select “RECIRCULATED AIR” for an  
extended period of time, the air in the vehi-  
cle can become contaminated. Therefore,  
you should occasionally select “FRESH  
AIR”.  
5-6  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Folding Rear Seats: 3  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Air conditioning switch (5)  
Head cooled/Feet warmed heating  
System Operating Instructions  
To turn on the air conditioning system,  
push in the “A/C” switch and set the blower  
speed selector to a position other than  
“OFF”. With this “A/C” switch operation, a  
indicator light will come on when the air  
conditioning system is on. To turn off the  
air conditioning system, push the “A/C”  
Select “BI-LEVELand “FRESH AIR”, the  
temperature selector to the desired tem-  
perature position, and the blower speed  
selector to the desired blower speed posi-  
tion. Unless the temperature selector is in  
the fully COLD position or fully HOT posi-  
tion, the air that comes out of the center  
and side outlets will be cooler than the air  
that comes out of the floor outlets.  
Natural ventilation  
Select “VENTILATION” and “FRESH AIR”,  
the temperature selector to the desired  
temperature position, and the blower  
speed selector to “OFF”. Fresh air will flow  
through the vehicle during driving.  
switch again.  
Forced ventilation  
The control settings are the same as for  
natural ventilation except you set the  
blower speed selector to a position other  
than “OFF”.  
During operation of the air conditioner, you  
may notice slight changes in engine  
speed. These changes are normal, the  
system is designed so that the compressor  
turns on or off to maintain the desired tem-  
perature.  
Normal cooling  
Turn on the “A/C” switch, set the air flow  
selector to “VENTILATION”, the tempera-  
ture selector to the desired temperature  
position and the blower speed selector to  
the desired blower speed position. Setting  
the blower speed selector to a higher  
blower speed position increases cooling  
efficiency.  
Normal heating (using outside air)  
Select “HEAT” and “FRESH AIR”, the tem-  
perature selector to the desired tempera-  
ture position and the blower speed selector  
to the desired blower speed position. Set-  
ting the blower speed selector to a higher  
blower speed position increases heating  
efficiency.  
Less operation of the compressor results  
in better fuel economy.  
You can switch the air intake selector to  
either “FRESH AIR” or “RECIRCULATED  
AIR” as you desire. Choosing “RECIRCU-  
LATED AIR” increases cooling efficiency.  
Quick heating (using recirculated air)  
The control settings are the same as for  
normal heating except you select “RECIR-  
CULATED AIR”. If you use this heating  
method for an extended period of time, the  
air in the vehicle can become contami-  
nated and the windows can become misty.  
Therefore, use this method only for quick  
heating and change to the normal heating  
method as soon as possible.  
5-7  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Folding Rear Seats: 3  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Quick cooling (using recirculated air)  
The control settings are the same as for  
normal cooling except you select “RECIR-  
CULATED AIR” and the highest blower  
speed.  
Maintenance  
If you do not use the air conditioner for a  
long period, such as during winter, it may  
not give the best performance when you  
start using it again. To help maintain opti-  
mum performance and durability of your air  
conditioner, it needs to be run periodically.  
Operate the air conditioner at least once a  
month for one minute with the engine  
idling. This circulates the refrigerant and oil  
and helps protect the internal components.  
EXAMPLE  
NOTE:  
• If you select “RECIRCULATED AIR” for  
an extended period of time, the air in the  
vehicle can become contaminated.  
Therefore, you should occasionally  
select “FRESH AIR”.  
Your air conditioner is equipped with air fil-  
ters. Clean or replace them as specified in  
the “Maintenance Schedule” in the  
“INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” sec-  
tion. Have this job done by your SUZUKI  
dealer as the lower glove box must be low-  
ered for this job.  
• If your vehicle has been left in the sun  
with the windows closed, it will cool  
faster if you open the windows briefly  
while you operate the air conditioner with  
the air intake selector at “FRESH AIR”  
and the blower at high speed.  
79J070  
NOTE:  
If you need maximum defrosting:  
• select “DEFROST” and “FRESH AIR”,  
• turn on the “A/C” switch,  
Dehumidifying  
• set the blower speed selector to HIGH,  
• adjust the temperature selector to the  
HOT end, and  
• adjust the side outlets so the air blows  
on the side windows.  
NOTE:  
Turn on the “A/C” switch, set the air flow  
selector to a desired air flow selector posi-  
tion, and select “FRESH AIR”, the temper-  
ature selector to the desired temperature  
position, and the blower speed selector to  
the desired blower speed position.  
Your vehicle uses the air conditioning  
refrigerant HFC-134a, commonly called  
“R-134a”. R-134a replaced R-12 around  
1993 for automotive applications. Other  
refrigerants are available, including recy-  
cled R-12, but only R-134a should be used  
in your vehicle.  
NOTE:  
Because the air conditioner dehumidifies  
the air, turning it on will help keep the win-  
dows clear, even when blowing heated air  
using the “DEFROST” or “HEAT  
DEFROST” functions.  
CAUTION  
Using the wrong refrigerant may  
damage your air conditioning sys-  
tem. Use R-134a only. Do not mix or  
replace the R-134a with other refrig-  
erants.  
&
5-8  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Folding Rear Seats: 3  
Armrest: 3  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
(1) Temperature selector  
(2) Blower speed selector  
(3) Air intake selector  
(4) Air flow selector  
(5) Defrost switch  
Automatic Heating and Air Conditioning System  
(Climate Control)  
Description of Controls  
(6) “OFF” switch  
(7) Air conditioning switch  
(8) “AUTO” switch  
(9) Display  
(1)  
(9)  
(2)  
(7)  
(8)  
(6)  
(4)  
(5)  
(3)  
80J2042  
5-9  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sun Visor: 5  
Interior Light Switch: 7  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Temperature selector (1)  
Blower speed selector (2)  
Air intake selector (3)  
(1)  
(2)  
(3)  
(a)  
(b)  
(7)  
80J2043  
80JM047  
80J2044  
Turn the temperature selector (1) to adjust  
the temperature.  
The blower speed selector (2) is used to  
turn on the blower and to select blower  
speed.  
Push the air intake selector (3) to change  
between the following modes.  
If the “AUTO” switch (8) is pushed, the air  
intake will vary automatically as the climate  
control system maintains the selected tem-  
perature.  
Air conditioning switch (7)  
If the “AUTO” switch (8) is pushed, the  
blower speed will vary automatically as the  
climate control system maintains the  
selected temperature.  
The air conditioning switch (7) is used to  
turn on and off the air conditioning system.  
To turn on the air conditioning system,  
push in the switch and “A/C ON” will  
appear on the display. To turn off the air  
conditioning system, push in the switch  
again and “A/C ON” will go off.  
RECIRCULATED AIR (a)  
When this mode is selected, outside air is  
shut off and inside air is recirculated. This  
mode is suitable when driving through an  
area with polluted air such as a tunnel, or  
when attempting to quickly cool down the  
vehicle.  
FRESH AIR (b)  
When this mode is selected, outside air is  
introduced.  
5-10  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Spot Light: 7  
Assist Grips: 3  
Coat Hooks:  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
“FRESH AIR” and “RECIRCULATED AIR”  
are selected alternately each time the air  
intake selector is pushed.  
Air flow selector (4)  
Ventilation (c)  
(c)  
NOTE:  
If you select “RECIRCULATED AIR” for an  
extended period of time, the air in the vehi-  
cle can become contaminated. Therefore,  
you should occasionally select “FRESH  
AIR”.  
(d)  
(e)  
79J065  
(4)  
Temperature-controlled air comes out of  
the center and side air outlets.  
Bi-level (d)  
(f)  
80JM049  
Push the air flow selector (4) to change  
among the following functions. The indica-  
tion of the selected mode appears on the  
display.  
79J066  
If the “AUTO” switch (8) is pushed, the air  
flow will vary automatically as the climate  
control system maintains the selected tem-  
perature.  
Temperature-controlled air comes out of  
the floor outlets and cooler air comes out  
of the center and side outlets. When the  
temperature selector (1) is in the fully  
COLD position or fully HOT position, how-  
ever, the air from the floor outlets and the  
air from the center and side outlets will be  
the same temperature.  
5-11  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Eyeglasses Holder:  
Engine Hood: 5  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Heat (e)  
Heat & defrost (f)  
Defrost switch (5)  
79J067  
79J068  
(5)  
Temperature-controlled air comes out of  
the floor outlets and the side outlets, a  
small amount of air comes out of the wind-  
shield defroster outlets and also comes  
slightly out of the side defroster outlets.  
Temperature-controlled air comes out of  
the floor outlets, the windshield defroster  
outlets, the side defroster outlets and the  
side outlets.  
NOTE:  
80JM050  
When the heat & defrost (f) is selected, the  
air conditioning system will come on and  
the “FRESH AIR” mode will be selected  
automatically. The “RECIRCULATED AIR”  
mode cannot be selected. In very cold  
weather, however, the air conditioning sys-  
tem will not turn on.  
Push the defrost switch (5) to turn on the  
defroster.  
5-12  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cup Holder and Storage Area: 3  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Defrost  
To turn the climate control system off, push  
the “OFF” switch (6).  
System Operating Instructions  
Automatic operation  
NOTE:  
(8)  
(1)  
If the “AUTO” on the display blinks, there is  
a problem in the heating system and/or air  
conditioning system. You should have the  
system inspected by an authorized  
SUZUKI dealer.  
80JM051  
Temperature-controlled air comes out of  
the windshield defroster outlets, the side  
defroster outlets and the side outlets.  
NOTE:  
To find the temperature at which you are  
most comfortable, start with the 72°F  
(22°C) setting.  
NOTE:  
• If you turn the temperature selector (1)  
until “HI” or “LO” appears on the display,  
the climate control system will operate at  
the maximum cooling or heating and the  
blower will run at full speed.  
To avoid blowing cold air in cold weather  
or hot air in hot weather, the system will  
delay turning on the blower until warmed  
or chilled air is available.  
• If your vehicle has been left in the sun  
with the windows closed, it will cool  
faster if you open the windows briefly.  
• Even under the automatic operation, you  
can set individual selectors to the man-  
ual mode. The manually selected func-  
tions are maintained, and the other  
functions remain under automatic opera-  
tion.  
To return the blower speed selector (2),  
air intake selector (3), and air flow selec-  
tor (4) to automatic operation, push the  
“AUTO” switch (8).  
When the defrost switch (5) is pushed to  
turn on the defroster, the air conditioning  
system will come on and the “FRESH AIR”  
mode will be selected automatically. In  
very cold weather, however, the air condi-  
tioning system will not turn on.  
(7)  
(6)  
80JM126  
You can let the climate control system work  
automatically. To set the system for fully-auto-  
matic operation, follow the procedure below.  
1) Start the engine.  
2) Push the “AUTO” switch (8).  
3) Set the desired temperature by turning  
the temperature selector (1).  
The blower speed, air intake and air flow  
are controlled automatically to maintain the  
set temperature.  
You can use the air conditioning switch (7)  
to manually turn the air conditioner on or off  
according to your preference. When you  
turn the air conditioning switch off, the cli-  
mate control system cannot lower the inside  
temperature below outside temperature.  
5-13  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessory Socket: 8  
Frame Hooks: 5, 6  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Manual operation  
Maintenance  
You can manually control the climate con-  
trol system. Set the selectors to the  
desired positions.  
If you do not use the air conditioner for a  
long period, such as during winter, it may  
not give the best performance when you  
start using it again. To help maintain opti-  
mum performance and durability of your air  
conditioner, it needs to be run periodically.  
Operate the air conditioner at least once a  
month for one minute with the engineidling.  
This circulates the refrigerant and oil and  
helps protect the internal components.  
EXAMPLE  
(11)  
EXAMPLE  
(10)  
Your air conditioner is equipped with air fil-  
ters. Clean or replace them as specified in  
the “Maintenance Schedule” in the  
“INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” sec-  
tion. Have this job done by your SUZUKI  
dealer as the lower glove box must be low-  
ered for this job.  
80JM127  
Be careful not to cover the interior temper-  
ature sensor (10) located between the  
steering wheel and the climate control  
panel, or the solar sensor (11) located at  
the top of the driver’s side dashboard.  
These sensors are used by the automatic  
system to regulate temperature.  
79J070  
NOTE:  
NOTE:  
If you need maximum defrosting:  
• push the defrost switch (5) to turn on the  
defroster (the air conditioning system will  
come on and the “FRESH AIR” mode will  
be selected automatically),  
• set the blower speed selector to HIGH,  
• adjust the temperature selector to the  
“HI” indication on the display, and  
• adjust the side outlets so the air blows  
on the side windows.  
Your vehicle uses the air conditioning  
refrigerant HFC-134a, commonly called  
“R-134a”. R-134a replaced R-12 around  
1993 for automotive applications. Other  
refrigerants are available, including recy-  
cled R-12, but only R-134a should be used  
in your vehicle.  
CAUTION  
Using the wrong refrigerant may  
damage your air conditioning sys-  
tem. Use R-134a only. Do not mix or  
replace the R-134a with other refrig-  
erants.  
5-14  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Frame Hooks: 5, 6  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
SX4 SEDAN  
The radio antenna wire is printed inside  
the rear window.  
Radio Antenna  
Audio Systems  
There are two types of audio system as  
shown below:  
SX4  
EXAMPLE  
CAUTION  
Type 1  
• Do not attach any metal objects to  
the rear window glass, or place  
metallic film near it. Either of these  
conditions may cause poor recep-  
tion or noise.  
• When cleaning the inside of the  
rear window, be careful not to  
scratch or damage the rear window  
antenna. Wipe the rear window  
lightly along the antenna with a  
dampened soft cloth.  
63J055  
The radio antenna on the roof is remov-  
able. To remove the antenna, turn it coun-  
terclockwise. To reinstall the antenna, turn  
it clockwise firmly by hand.  
80J059  
AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER  
WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL  
CAUTION  
To avoid damage to the radio  
antenna:  
• Remove the antenna before using  
an automatic car wash.  
• Remove the antenna when it is pos-  
sible for the antenna to hit some-  
thing such as a low ceiling in a  
parking garage or putting a car  
cover over your car.  
• Remove the antenna before put-  
ting a car cover over your vehicle.  
5-15  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Cautions on Handling  
Type 2  
Precautions  
• When the inside of the car is very cold  
and the player is used soon after switch-  
ing on the heater, moisture may form on  
the disc or the optical parts of the player  
and proper playback may not be possi-  
ble. If moisture forms on the disc, wipe it  
off with a soft cloth. If moisture forms on  
the optical parts of the player, do not use  
the player for about one hour. This will  
allow the condensation to disappear nor-  
mally.  
(A)  
52D274  
This unit has been designed specifically for  
playback of compact discs bearing the  
mark (A).  
• Driving on extremely bumpy roads which  
cause severe vibrations may cause  
sound to skip.  
No other discs can be played.  
80J060  
• This unit uses a precision mechanism.  
Even in the event that trouble arises,  
never open the case, disassemble the  
unit, or lubricate the rotating parts.  
Please bring the unit to an authorized  
SUZUKI dealer or a Clarion service  
Department.  
Removing the disc  
Proper way to hold  
the compact disc  
AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER  
WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL  
52D275  
To remove the compact disc from its stor-  
age case, press down on the center of the  
case and lift the disc out, holding it care-  
fully by the edges.  
Always handle the compact disc by the  
edges.  
Never touch the surface.  
5-16  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
prevent the system from operating prop-  
erly.  
52D347  
52D348  
To remove fingermarks and dust, use a  
soft cloth, and wipe in a straight line from  
the center of the compact disc to the cir-  
cumference.  
Never stick labels on the surface of the  
compact disc or mark the surface with a  
pencil or pen.  
52D351  
Do not expose compact discs to direct sun-  
light or any heat source.  
NOTE:  
• Do not use commercially available CD  
protection sheets or discs equipped with  
stabilizers, etc.  
(B)  
(B)  
(C)  
These may get caught in the internal  
mechanism and damage the disc.  
• CD-R discs may not be able to playback  
in this unit due to the recording condi-  
tions.  
• CD-RW discs cannot playback in this  
unit.  
52D349  
Do not use any solvents such as commer-  
cially available cleaners, anti-static spray,  
or thinner to clean compact discs.  
52D277  
New discs may have some roughness  
around the edges. The unit may not work  
or the sound may skip if such discs are  
used. Use a ball-point pen (B), etc. to  
remove the roughness (C) from edges of  
the disc before insertion inside the unit.  
52D350  
Do not use compact discs that have large  
scratches, are misshaped, or cracked, etc.  
Use of such discs will cause damage or  
5-17  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
(1) Power on/off knob  
Volume control knob  
Basic Operations  
(2) Tone/balance/fader control knob  
(3) Preset button 5  
(4) Preset button 6  
Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL  
(1)  
(2)  
(4)  
(3)  
Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL  
(1)  
(2)  
(4)  
(3)  
80J061  
5-18  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Turning power on/off  
Adjusting bass/treble/balance/fader  
1) Press the tone/balance/fader control  
knob (2).  
Adjusting the AVC (Auto volume con-  
trol)  
Press the power on/off knob (1).  
The unit starts in the function mode it was  
in when the power was turned off last.  
The Automatic Volume Control (AVC) func-  
tion automatically adjusts (increases/  
decreases) the sound volume in accor-  
dance with vehicle speed. The AVC control  
is provided with three selectable levels  
(LEVEL OFF, 1, 2, 3). The range of volume  
adjustment increases together with the  
LEVEL number,  
Each time it is pressed, sound adjust-  
ment is changed as follows:  
Adjusting the volume  
Turn the volume control knob (1).  
Turning it clockwise increases the volume;  
turning it counterclockwise decreases the  
volume.  
Bass adjustment (BASS 0)  
Treble adjustment (TREBLE 0)  
Balance adjustment (BALANCE 0)  
Fader adjustment (FADER 0)  
AVC adjustment (AVC LEVEL 2)  
Original mode  
1) Press the tone/balance/fader control  
knob (2) until the AVC adjustment mode  
is selected.  
2) Turn the tone/balance/fader control  
knob (2) to select the desired AVC  
adjustment level. (Initial setting: LEVEL  
2)  
NOTE:  
While driving, adjust the volume to an  
extent that sound and/or noise coming  
from outside the car can be heard.  
Adjusting the contrast of the display  
1) Press the tone/balance/fader/control  
knob (2) and preset button 5 (3), preset  
button 6 (4) simultaneously.  
66J224  
2) To adjust the contrast of the display,  
turn the power on/off knob (1).  
2) Turn the tone/balance/fader control  
knob (2) to adjust the sound.  
Cancel the dimmer condition  
Each time you press the power on/off knob  
(1) for two seconds with the lighting switch  
on, the background brightness of the audio  
display will switch between normal and  
dimmed.  
5-19  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Display  
Listening to the Radio  
(C)  
Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL  
(A)  
(B)  
(D)  
(2)  
(3)  
(6)  
(1)  
66J097  
(1) Band switch button (FM/AM)  
(2) Seek up button  
(3) Seek down button  
(4)  
(4) Manual tuning knob  
(5) Preset buttons (1 to 6)  
(6) Auto store button (AS)/  
Scan button (SCAN)  
(5)  
(A) Band  
(B) Preset channel number  
(C) Stereo indicator  
(D) Frequency  
Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL  
(6)  
(1)  
(2)  
(3)  
(4)  
(5)  
80J062  
5-20  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Selecting the reception band  
Auto store  
Radio Reception  
Press the band switch button (1).  
Each time the button is pressed, the recep-  
tion band is switched as follows:  
Press and hold the auto store button (6) for  
2 seconds or longer.  
Radio reception can be affected by envi-  
ronment, atmospheric conditions, or radio  
signal’s power and distance from the sta-  
tion. Nearby mountains and buildings may  
interfere or deflect radio reception, causing  
poor reception. Poor reception or radio  
static can also be caused by electric cur-  
rent from overhead wires or high voltage  
power lines.  
Six stations in total are automatically  
stored to the preset buttons (5) in sequen-  
tial order, starting from the lower frequen-  
cies.  
NOTE:  
• When the auto store is performed, the  
station previously stored in the memory  
at the position is overwritten.  
66J098  
• When there are fewer than 6 stations  
that can be stored even if 2 rounds of  
auto store operation are performed, the  
stations previously stored at the remain-  
ing preset buttons (5) are not overwrit-  
ten.  
Seek tuning  
Press the seek up button (2) or the seek  
down button (3).  
The unit stops searching for a station at a  
frequency where a broadcast station is  
available.  
Scan tuning  
Manual tuning  
1) Press the scan button (6).  
Turn the manual tuning knob (4).  
The frequency being received is displayed.  
Stations are automatically sought for in  
a sequential order, starting from a sta-  
tion being currently received, and scan  
stops for 5 seconds at a frequency  
where there is a station available.  
2) Press the scan button (6) again to stop  
scanning at the frequency being cur-  
rently received.  
Preset memory  
1) Select the desired station.  
2) Select the preset button (5) to which  
you want to store the station and press  
and hold the button for 2 seconds or  
longer.  
Receiving a stereo broadcast station  
If a stereo broadcast station is received,  
the stereo indicator will light.  
5-21  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
CAUTION  
Listening to a CD  
• Never insert your finger or hand  
into the CD insertion slot. Never  
insert foreign objects.  
• Never insert a CD with glue coming  
out from adhesive tape or a rental  
CD label or with a trace indicating  
that adhesive tape or a rental CD  
label has been removed. This may  
cause the CD not to eject or result  
in a malfunction.  
(A)  
52D291  
• A CD is inserted with its label facing  
upward.  
• When there is a CD already loaded in  
the unit, another CD cannot be loaded at  
the same time. Do not use force when  
inserting the CD into the CD insertion  
slot.  
52D274  
• CDs or CD-ROMs carrying no mark (A)  
cannot be used.  
• Some discs previously recorded in CD-  
R\CD-RW format may not be used.  
• If a blank disc (non-recorded CD-R) is  
loaded in the unit, the disc will be  
ejected.  
5-22  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Type 1  
Display  
AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built in CD Player)  
(D)  
(A)  
(C)  
(B)  
66J100  
(1) CD insertion slot  
(2) CD eject button  
(1)  
(3) Disc button (CD/AUX)  
(4) Track up button/Fast forward button  
(5) Track down button/Rewind button  
(6) Repeat button (RPT)  
(6)  
(3)  
(2)  
(4)  
(5)  
(A) Mode indicator  
(B) Track number  
(C) Play time  
(D) Repeat indicator  
80J063  
5-23  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
NOTE:  
Loading a CD  
Selecting a track  
About Single CDs (8 cm CDs)  
• No adapter is required to play a single  
CD.  
Insert a CD in the CD insertion slot (1).  
When a CD is loaded, play starts and the  
CD indicator (A) lights.  
• Press the track up button (4) to listen to  
the next track.  
• Press the track down button (5) twice to  
listen to the previous track.  
When the track down button (5) is  
pressed once, the track being currently  
played will return to the beginning.  
• A single CD is inserted from the center  
of the CD insertion slot.  
• Since an ejected single CD is not auto-  
matically reloaded, be sure to remove  
the ejected single CD.  
Ejecting a CD  
Press the CD eject button (2).  
If you left a CD ejected for a period of  
about 15 seconds, it will be automatically  
drawn inside the unit. (Auto reload func-  
tion)  
Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track  
• Hold in the fast forward button (4) to  
advance a track rapidly.  
• Hold in the rewind button (5) to rewind a  
track.  
The backup eject function:  
This function allows you to eject a CD with  
the power turned off by pressing the CD  
eject button (2).  
Repeat play  
Press the repeat button (6).  
The repeat indicator (D) lights and the  
track currently being played is played  
repeatedly.  
Press the repeat button (6) again to cancel  
repeat play.  
CAUTION  
If you forcefully try to push an ejected  
CD inside the unit before auto reload-  
ing, the disc surface might be  
scratched.  
Listening to a CD  
When a CD is inserted, it is automatically  
played back.  
When a CD is already inside the unit,  
press the disc button (3) to play back the  
CD. When a CD is inside the unit, the CD  
indicator (A) is lit on the display unit.  
5-24  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Type 2  
Display  
AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL (Built-in CD Changer)  
(F)  
(B)  
(C)  
(A)  
(D)  
(E)  
66J102  
(1) Load button (LOAD)  
(2) Disc select buttons (1 to 6)  
(3) CD insertion slot  
(4) CD eject button  
(5) Disc button (CD/AUX)  
(6) Track up button/Fast forward button  
(7) Track down button/Rewind button  
(8) Repeat button (RPT)  
(3)  
(1)  
(4)  
(8)  
(5)  
(6)  
(7)  
(A) Mode indicator  
(B) Disc number  
(C) Track number  
(D) Play time  
(E) CD indicator  
(F) Repeat indicator  
(2)  
66J064  
5-25  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
NOTE:  
Loading one CD  
Loading multiple CDs  
About Single CDs (8 cm CDs)  
1) Press the load button (1), then press  
one of the disc select buttons (2) that  
corresponds to the slot into which you  
want to load a CD.  
1) Press the load button (1) for 2 seconds  
or longer.  
• Since the unit is not compatible with a  
single CD, do not load it into the unit.  
• Keep in mind the fact that a single CD  
cannot be played even using a single CD  
adaptor for the unit.  
The indication “CD ALLappears in the  
display, and then the indication “In” and  
a disc number in the CD indicator will  
blink for about 15 seconds.  
• When a single CD is loaded into the unit  
accidentally, it will be ejected immedi-  
ately. Please be sure to remove it.  
If you forcefully try to push it into the unit  
without removing it, the CD cannot be  
ejected. This will result in a damage to  
the mechanism. Please never do this.  
2) Load a CD into the CD insertion slot  
(3).  
3) The indication “In” and the next disc  
number will blink in the display. Load  
the next CD.  
4) After loading the required number of  
CD’s, press any disc select button (2) to  
select the desired CD to listen to. If no  
select button is pressed, play will start  
from the first loaded CD.  
66J143  
Both the indication “In” and the selected  
disc number in the CD indicator will blink  
for about 15 seconds.  
2) Load the CD into the CD insertion slot  
(3). When the CD is loaded, play starts.  
The disk number in the CD indicator will  
light.  
Only the numbers in the CD indicator that  
correspond to the loaded slots will light.  
Ejecting one CD  
1) Select the CD you want to remove with  
the disc select buttons (2).  
CAUTION  
2) Press the CD eject button (4).  
If you leave the ejected CD without  
removing it, it will be drawn into the unit  
automatically after about 15 seconds.  
(Auto reload function)  
You can load a CD only while the indi-  
cation “In” is blinking for about 15  
seconds. During that period, the  
shutter located in the depth of the CD  
insertion slot (3) is opened. After 15  
seconds time has elapsed, the indi-  
cation “In” disappears from the dis-  
play and the shutter closes, making it  
impossible to load a CD. If you try to  
load the CD with the shutter closed,  
the CD may damage the shutter.  
Never do this.  
The buck up eject mechanism:  
This function allows you to eject the CD  
loaded in the unit with the unit turned off  
only by pressing the CD eject button (4).  
5-26  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Ejecting all the CDs  
Listening to a CD  
Repeat play  
Press the CD eject button (4) for 2 seconds  
or longer. All the CDs will be ejected from  
the unit in a sequential manner.  
1) When a CD is inserted, it is automati-  
cally played back.  
Press the repeat button (8).  
Each time the button is pressed, repeat  
play mode changes as follows:  
When a CD is already inside the unit,  
press the disc button (5) to play back  
the CD. When a CD is inside the unit,  
the CD indicator (A) is lit on the display  
unit.  
• Please prepare  
removed CDs can be stored.  
• If you leave the ejected CD without  
removing it, it will be drawn into the unit  
automatically after about 15 seconds.  
(Auto reload function)  
a
location where  
TRACK REPEAT  
2) If you want to play another CD, select it  
with the disc select buttons (2).  
Play starts from the point on the disc  
that the unit played last (Last position  
memory).  
OFF  
DISC REPEAT  
The buck up eject mechanism:  
66J144  
This function allows you to eject the CD  
loaded in the unit with the unit turned off  
only by pressing the CD eject button (4).  
NOTE:  
This operation should be performed within  
2 seconds.  
Selecting a track  
• Press the track up button (6) to listen to  
the next track.  
• Press the track down button (7) twice to  
listen to the previous track.  
When the track down button (7) is  
pressed once, the track being currently  
played will return to the beginning.  
CAUTION  
To cancel repeat play, press the repeat but-  
ton (8) several times to change the repeat  
play mode to OFF.  
If you try to push an ejected CD  
inside the unit forcibly before auto  
reloading, the disc surface might be  
scratched.  
• TRACK REPEAT  
The indication “TRACK RPT” appears in  
the display for 2 seconds and then the  
repeat indicator (F) lights.  
Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track  
• Hold in the fast forward button (6) to  
advance a track rapidly.  
• Hold in the rewind button (7) to rewind a  
track.  
The track currently being played is  
played repeatedly.  
• DISC REPEAT  
The indication “DISC RPT” appears in  
the display for 2 seconds and then the  
repeat indicator (F) lights.  
When all the tracks on the disc currently  
being played finish playing, play starts  
again at the beginning of the disc.  
5-27  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Display (Type 1)  
Listening to an MP3/WMA Disc  
(D)  
(E) (F)  
Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL  
(A)  
(B)  
(C)  
(2)  
(5)  
66J104  
(3)  
(4)  
Display (Type 2)  
(1)  
(D)  
(E) (F)  
(A)  
(B)  
(C)  
(G)  
66J105  
(1) Sound control knob  
(2) Repeat button (RPT)  
Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL  
(3) Track up button/Fast forward button  
(4) Track down button/Rewind button  
(5) Display button (DISP)  
(A) Folder number  
(B) Track number  
(C) Play time  
(D) Repeat indicator  
(E) WMA indicator  
(F) MP3 indicator  
(G) CD indicator  
(3)  
(4)  
(2)  
(5)  
(1)  
80J065  
5-28  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
What is MP3/WMA?  
WMA  
You may encounter trouble in playing  
MP3/WMA files or displaying the infor-  
mation of MP3/WMA files recorded with  
certain writing software or CD recorders.  
• This unit does not have a play list func-  
tion.  
• Although Multi-session recording is sup-  
ported, the use of Disc-at-Once is rec-  
ommended.  
MP3 (MPEG1/2 Audio Layer-III) and WMA  
• It is recommended to set the bit rate to  
“64 kbps or more” and “fixed”.  
• Do not set the copy protect attribute on  
the WMA file to enable this unit to play  
back.  
TM  
(Windows Media  
Audio) are the com-  
pression formats of digital audio. The  
former is developed by MPEG (Motion Pic-  
ture Experts Group), and the latter is  
developed by Microsoft Corporation. Using  
these compression formats, you can  
record the contents of about 10 music CDs  
on a single CD media (This figures refer to  
data recorded on a 650 MB CD-R or CD-  
RW at a fixed bit rate of 128 kbps and a  
sampling frequency of 44.1 kHz).  
NOTE:  
Never assign the “.mp3”, or “.wma” file  
name extension to a file that is not in the  
MP3/WMA format. This may not only pro-  
duce noise from the speaker damage, but  
also damage your hearing.  
Compression formats  
MP3  
• Bit rate  
MPEG1 Audio Layer III : 32 k – 320 kbps  
MPEG2 Audio Layer III : 8 k – 160 kbps  
• Sampling frequency  
MPEG1 Audio Layer III : 44.1 k/48 k/32  
kHz  
MPEG2 Audio Layer III :  
22.05 k/24 k/16 kHz  
Points to remember when making MP3/  
WMA files  
Recording MP3/WMA files on a CD-  
media  
You are recommended to minimize the  
chances of making a disc that contains  
both CD-DA files and MP3/WMA files.  
• If CD-DA files are on the same disc as  
MP3 or WMA files, the songs may not  
play in the intended order, or some  
songs may not play at all.  
Common  
• High bit rate and high sampling fre-  
quency are recommended for high qual-  
ity sounds.  
• Selecting VBR (Variable Bit Rate) is not  
recommended because playing time is  
not displayed properly and sound may  
be skipped.  
• The playback sound quality differs  
depending on the encoding circum-  
stances. For details, refer to the user  
manual of your own encoding software  
and writing software.  
WMA (Ver.7, Ver.8, Ver. 9*)  
• Bit rate  
32 k – 192 kbps  
• Sampling frequency  
44.1 k/48 k/32 kHz  
* WMA 9 Professional/LossLess/Voice  
are not supported.  
• When storing MP3 data and WMA data  
on the same disc, use different folders  
for each data.  
• Do not record files other than MP3/WMA  
files and unnecessary folder on a disc.  
• The name of an MP3/WMA file should  
be added by rules as shown in the fol-  
lowing descriptions and also comply with  
the rules of each file system.  
Supported file systems  
ISO 9660 Level 1/Level 2, Apple Extension  
to ISO 9660, Joliet, Romeo  
MP3  
• It is recommended to set the bit rate to  
“128 kbps or more” and “fixed”.  
• The file extension “.mp3” or “.wma”  
should be assigned to each file depend-  
ing on the file format.  
Maximum number of files/folders  
• Maximum number of files:  
CD Player: 999(files + folders)  
6-CD Player: 512(files + folders)  
5-29  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
• Maximum number of files in one folder:  
255  
• Maximum depth of trees: 8  
• Maximum number of folders: 255  
(Root folder is included.)  
NOTE:  
Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track  
• Hold in the fast forward button (3) to  
advance a track rapidly.  
• Hold in the rewind button (4) to rewind a  
track.  
This operation should be performed within  
2 seconds.  
To cancel repeat play, press the repeat but-  
ton (2) several times to change the repeat  
play mode to OFF.  
MP3/WMA MODE  
Displaying CD titles  
Press the display button (5).  
Each time the button is pressed, the title  
changes as follows:  
Selecting a folder  
• TRACK REPEAT  
Turn the sound control knob (1) to select a  
folder.  
The indication “TRACK RPT” appears in  
the display for 2 seconds and then the  
repeat indicator (D) lights.  
Repeat play  
The track currently being played is  
played repeatedly.  
• FOLDER REPEAT  
The indication “FOLDER RPT” appears  
in the display for 2 seconds and then the  
repeat indicator (D) lights.  
Press the repeat button (2).  
Each time the button is pressed, repeat  
play mode changes as follows:  
OFF  
ALBUM TITLE  
FOLDER TITLE  
FILE TITLE  
Type 1  
All the tracks in the folder currently being  
played are played repeatedly.  
• DISC REPEAT  
TRACK REPEAT  
The indication “DISC RPT” appears in  
the display for 2 seconds and then the  
repeat indicator (D) lights.  
When all the tracks on the disc currently  
being played finish playing, play starts  
again at the beginning of the disc.  
ARTIST TITLE  
TRACK TITLE  
OFF  
FOLDER REPEAT  
66J128  
66J146  
Type 2  
Forwarding a title  
If there is a title with 12 letters or more,  
each press will show next letters in the dis-  
play. (No scrolling is made.)  
TRACK REPEAT  
FOLDER REPEAT  
Selecting a track  
• Press the track up button (3) to listen to  
the next track.  
• Press the track down button (4) twice to  
listen to the previous track.  
When the track down button (4) is  
pressed once, the track currently being  
played will start again at the beginning.  
Press and hold the display button (5) for 2  
seconds or longer. A title is changed.  
OFF  
DISC REPEAT  
66J145  
5-30  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Display  
Listening to a XM Satellite Radio (Option)  
(C)  
Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL  
(A)  
(B)  
66J107  
(8)  
(6)  
(3)  
(4)  
(1) XM button  
(2) Category button (CAT)  
(3) Seek up button  
(4) Seek down button  
(5) Manual tuning knob  
(6) Display button (DISP)  
(7) Preset button (1 to 6)  
(8) Scan button (SCAN)  
(1)  
(5)  
(2)  
(7)  
(A) Band  
(B) Channel number  
(C) Category indicator  
Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL  
If you want to purchase XM Satellite Radio  
Service, contact your SUZUKI dealer.  
It is necessary to buy a special tuner to  
receive XM broadcasting.  
(8)  
(6)  
(3)  
(4)  
(1)  
(5)  
Your vehicle is capable of receiving XM  
Satellite Radio anywhere in the United  
States except Hawaii, Alaska, and Can-  
ada.  
(2)  
(7)  
80J066  
5-31  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
XM MODE  
Selecting a category  
and hold the button for 2 seconds or  
longer.  
Press the seek up button (3) or seek down  
button (4) to select a category.  
Selecting a band  
Press the XM button (1).  
Each time the button is pressed, the band  
changes in the following order.  
Scan tuning  
Displaying the category  
1) Press the scan button (8).  
Stations are automatically searched for  
in a sequential order, starting from the  
station being currently received, and  
scan tuning stops for 5 seconds at the  
frequency where there is a station avail-  
able.  
Press the category button (2) to have the  
currently selected category appear on the  
display.  
XM1  
XM2  
XM3  
Selecting a channel  
Turn the manual tuning knob (5) to select a  
channel.  
2) Press the scan button (8) again to stop  
scanning at the frequency currently  
being received.  
66J129  
NOTE:  
When the category function is on, only  
those channels included in the selected  
category can be selected.  
Selecting a category  
Satellite Radio Reception  
Press the seek up button (3) or the seek  
down button (4). The category is changed.  
Satellite radio receives signals from two  
satellites in orbit over the equator. There-  
fore, satellite radio reception can be inter-  
rupted when there are objects south of  
your vehicle. To help compensate for this,  
ground-based repeaters are placed in  
major metropolitan areas, but depending  
on the geographic situation (for example, if  
mountains or buildings are on the south  
side of your vehicle), you may experience  
reception problems.  
Selecting the item to be displayed  
Press the display button (6).  
Each time the button is pressed, the item  
on display changes in the following order.  
Turning the category function on/off  
Press and hold the category button (2) for  
2 seconds or longer, and “CATEGORY  
ON” appears on the display, the CAT indi-  
cator (c) lights up and the CATEGORY  
function is activated.  
Press and hold the category button (2) for  
2 seconds or longer again, and “CATE-  
GORY OFF” appears on the display and  
the CAT indicator turns off, indicating that  
the CATEGORY function has been turned  
off.  
CH NUMBER  
TITLE  
CH NAME  
NAME  
66J130  
Preset memory  
1) Select the desired station.  
2) Select the preset button (7) to which  
you want to store the station and press  
NOTE:  
The first time you use the radio, turn the  
category function on.  
5-32  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Display  
Listening to Audio for AUX (Option)  
Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL  
(A)  
66J221  
(1) Aux button (CD/AUX)  
(A) Mode indicator  
Aux function  
This system has an external input terminal  
so you can listen to audio from an external  
device connected to this unit.  
(1)  
Press the aux button (1).  
Each time the button is pressed, the  
selected mode is switched as follows:  
Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL  
CD  
AUX  
66J123  
(1)  
80J067  
5-33  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Display  
Listening to a CD from an External CD Changer (Option)  
(G)  
(E) (F)  
Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL  
(A) (B)  
(D)  
(C)  
(5)  
66J113  
(3)  
(4)  
(1)  
(1) Disc button (CD/AUX)  
(2) Disc select buttons (1 to 6)  
(6)  
(3) Track up button/Fast forward button  
(4) Track down button/Rewind button  
(5) Repeat button (RPT)  
(6) Category button (CAT)  
(2)  
(A) Mode indicator  
(B) Disc number  
(C) Track number  
(D) Play time  
Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL  
(E) Repeat indicator  
(F) Random indicator  
(G) CD changer number  
(5)  
(1)  
(3)  
(4)  
(6)  
(2)  
80J068  
5-34  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Selecting a CD changer mode  
Press the disc button (1).  
Each time the button is pressed, the  
selected CD plays as follows:  
Selecting a disc  
Random play  
Press the disc select button (2) corre-  
sponding to the disc number you want to  
listen to.  
Press the category button (6).  
Each time the button is pressed, the mode  
changes in the following order.  
Play starts from the first track on the disc. If  
a disc number having no disc is pressed,  
the selection will be invalid.  
TRACK RANDOM  
Built-in CD player  
CD changer 1  
CD changer 2  
Selecting a track  
OFF  
DISC RANDOM  
• Press the track up button (3) to listen to  
the next track.  
• Press the track down button (4) twice to  
listen to the previous track.  
When the track down button (4) is  
pressed once, the track currently being  
played will start again at the beginning.  
66J131  
NOTE:  
This operation should be performed within  
2 seconds.  
To cancel random play, press the category  
button (6) several times to change the ran-  
dom play mode to OFF.  
Fast forwarding/Rewinding a track  
• Hold in the fast forward button (3) to  
advance a track rapidly.  
• Hold in the rewind button (4) to rewind a  
track.  
52D300  
• When only one CD changer is con-  
nected to this unit, CD changer 2 is  
skipped.  
• When no CD is loaded in the built-in CD  
player, the built-in CD player is skipped.  
• TRACK RANDOM  
The tracks in the disc that is loaded are  
played at random.  
• DISC RANDOM  
The tracks in all discs are played at ran-  
dom.  
NOTE:  
The random play can be operated with the  
External CD Changer (Option) only.  
5-35  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Repeat play  
• TRACK REPEAT  
• DISC REPEAT  
Press the repeat button (5).  
Each time the button is pressed, repeat  
play mode changes as follows:  
The indication “TRACK RPT” appears in  
the display for 2 seconds and then the  
repeat indicator (E) lights.  
The indication “DISC RPT” appears in  
the display for 2 seconds and then the  
repeat indicator (E) lights.  
The track being currently played is  
played repeatedly.  
When all the tracks on a disc being cur-  
rently played finish playing, play starts  
again at the beginning of the disc.  
TRACK REPEAT  
OFF  
DISC REPEAT  
66J144  
NOTE:  
This operation should be performed within  
2 seconds.  
To cancel repeat play, press the repeat but-  
ton (5) several times to change the repeat  
play mode to OFF.  
5-36  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
To control the volume:  
To change the selection on a CD:  
To advance to the next track on a CD,  
push the upper part of the switch (4)  
briefly.  
To select the previous track on a CD,  
push the lower part of the switch (4).  
Remote Audio Controls  
(if equipped)  
To increase the volume, push the upper  
part of the switch (1). The volume contin-  
ues to increase until you release the  
switch.  
To decrease the volume, push the lower  
part of the switch (1). The volume contin-  
ues to decrease until you release the  
switch.  
To mute, push the switch (2).  
To select the mode (AM1, AM2, FM1, FM2,  
XM (option), CD, External CD-changer  
(option), AUX (option)), push the switch  
(3).  
You can also turn on the audio system by  
pushing the switch (3).  
To change the radio station:  
To advance to the next preset station,  
push the upper part of the switch (4)  
briefly.  
To select the previous preset station,  
push the lower part of the switch (4)  
briefly.  
(2)  
(1)  
(3)  
(4)  
To scan to a higher frequency radio sta-  
tion, push and hold the upper part of the  
switch (4).  
To scan to a lower frequency radio sta-  
tion, push and hold the lower part of the  
switch (4).  
80JC099  
You can control basic functions of the  
audio system with the switches on the  
steering wheel.  
5-37  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
(1) Power on/off knob  
(2) Track up button/Fast forward button  
(3) Preset buttons (1 to 6)  
Anti-Theft Feature  
Type 1 AM/FM/XM CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL  
The anti-theft feature is intended to dis-  
courage theft or the audio system by pre-  
venting the system from operating when it  
is moved to a different vehicle.  
This feature works by allowing you to enter  
a Personal Identification Number (PIN).  
When the audio system is disconnected  
from its power source, such as when the  
audio system is removed or the battery is  
disconnected, the system will not operate  
again unless the PIN is reentered.  
(2)  
(1)  
(3)  
Type 2 AM/FM/XM 6-CD PLAYER WITH CD CHANGER CONTROL  
(2)  
(1)  
(3)  
80J069  
5-38  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Setting the Anti-Theft Function  
1) Turn off the power by pressing the  
power on/off knob (1).  
Canceling Your Established PIN  
Setting  
This operation is to be done when you  
want to cancel the anti-theft function or  
change your PIN.  
1) Turn off the power by pressing the  
power on/off knob (1).  
66J118  
4) After you enter your four digit PIN, the  
display will return to “0000”.  
66J118  
2) Press the power on/off knob (1) while  
pressing and holding the track up but-  
ton (2). The “ENTRY 0000” will blink  
and the audio system enter PIN-input  
mode.  
EXAMPLE  
66J121  
2) Press the power on/off knob (1) while  
pressing and holding the track up but-  
ton (2). The “DELETE 0000” will blink  
and the audio system will enter the can-  
cel mode.  
NOTE:  
66J117  
Establish your PIN by combining numbers  
from 1 to 6 into any 4-digit number. If you  
forget your PIN, when you remove the bat-  
tery for repair etc., you will no longer be  
able to operate the audio system.  
5) Input the same 4-digit number you pre-  
viously entered.  
EXAMPLE  
66J120  
6) The power of the audio system will turn  
off.  
66J117  
3) Input the four digit PIN using preset but-  
tons 1 to 6.  
NOTE:  
Write down your PIN for the future use.  
5-39  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
registered PIN, the power of the audio  
system will turn off, and you will be able  
to operate the audio system.  
Confirming Your Personal Identifi-  
cation Number (PIN)  
EXAMPLE  
When the main power source is discon-  
nected such as when you exchange your  
battery, etc, you will have to confirm your  
PIN to be able to use the audio system.  
NOTE:  
• If you input your PIN incorrectly, ----” will  
be displayed and the anti-theft function  
lock mode is entered. If you enter an  
incorrect PIN fewer than 6 times, the  
locking time will be for 15 seconds; if you  
enter an incorrect PIN more than 6  
times, the locking time will be for 15 min-  
utes.  
To confirm your PIN:  
• If you forget your PIN and enter a wrong  
PIN, you cannot perform any further  
operation.  
66J124  
66J122  
3) Input your PIN. The power of the audio  
system will turn off and your PIN will be  
deleted.  
1) Turn the ignition switch to the “ACC”  
position.  
To change your PIN, first delete your  
current PIN, then set a new one.  
EXAMPLE  
66J125  
2) Input your PIN.  
If the PIN that you input matches the  
5-40  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Troubleshooting  
Applicable to every device  
Phenomenon  
Cause  
Remedy  
Power is not turned on.  
(No sound is produced)  
Fuse is blown.  
Contact your authorized SUZUKI dealer.  
Contact your authorized SUZUKI dealer.  
Connections are not properly made.  
Radio  
Phenomenon  
Cause  
Remedy  
Too much noise.  
Not tuned correctly to the frequency of a sta- Tune correctly to the station frequency.  
tion.  
Stations cannot be selected by There is no station with strong radio waves.  
seek tuning.  
Select stations by manual tuning.  
CD  
Phenomenon  
Cause  
Remedy  
Compact disc cannot be loaded. Another compact disc is already loaded.  
Eject the compact disc before loading a new  
one.  
Sound skips or is noisy.  
Compact disc is dirty.  
Clean the compact disc with a soft cloth.  
Compact disc is heavily scratched or warped.  
Replace with a compact disc with no scratches.  
Sound is bad directly after power Water droplets may form on the internal lens Let dry for about 1 hour with the power on.  
is turned on.  
when the car is parked in a humid place.  
5-41  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Error display  
This unit has a number of self-diagnostic functions to protect the system.  
If a problem should occur, the display shows the type of error. Refer to the table below and take proper measures to correct the problem.  
If the problem is corrected, the unit will operate normally.  
Error display  
Measures to be taken  
CD/CD changer “Mechanical error”.  
This error display indicates a mechanical failure in the CD changer  
(failure to change or eject a disc).  
The mechanism is probably damaged. Contact your authorized  
SUZUKI dealer.  
CD/CD changer “Focus error”.  
The pick-up-focus is not properly functioning during playback due to  
damage on the disc or for other reasons.  
Check disc for damage.  
CD/CD changer “Disc error”.  
The CD is inserted upside down or only an eight-centimeter CD  
adapter is equipped.  
Check disc for correct loading.  
If an error display not listed above appears, turn off the unit and contact your SUZUKI dealer.  
5-42  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
SX4 SEDAN  
EXAMPLE  
The fuel filler cap is located on the left rear  
side of the vehicle. The fuel filler door can  
be unlocked by pulling up the opener lever  
located on the outboard side of the driver’s  
seat and can be locked by simply closing  
the door.  
Fuel Filler Cap  
SX4  
EXAMPLE  
EXAMPLE  
Open  
Close  
56KN029  
80JC060  
EXAMPLE  
EXAMPLE  
79K053  
To remove the fuel filler cap:  
1) Open the fuel filler door.  
2) Remove the cap by turning it counter-  
clockwise.  
WARNING  
Remove the fuel filler cap slowly. The  
fuel may be under pressure and may  
spray out, causing injury.  
56KN030  
79J049  
5-43  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Engine Hood  
WARNING  
EXAMPLE  
(1)  
If you need to replace the fuel cap,  
use a genuine SUZUKI cap. Use of an  
improper cap can result in a malfunc-  
tion of the fuel system or emission  
control system. It may also result in  
fuel leakage in the event of an acci-  
dent.  
EXAMPLE  
(2)  
56KN078  
NOTE:  
79J077  
The cap holder (1) can hold the fuel filler  
cap (2) when refueling.  
To open the engine hood:  
1) Pull the hood release handle located on  
the outboard side of the driver’s side of  
the instrument panel. This will disen-  
gage the engine hood lock halfway.  
To reinstall the fuel filler cap:  
1) Turn the cap clockwise until you hear  
several clicks.  
2) Close the fuel filler door.  
EXAMPLE  
WARNING  
Fuel is extremely flammable. Do not  
smoke when refueling, and make  
sure there are no open flames or  
sparks in the area.  
80J045  
2) Push the under-hood release lever  
sideways with your finger, as shown in  
the illustration. While pushing the lever,  
lift up the engine hood.  
5-44  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Sun Visor  
Interior Light Switch  
EXAMPLE  
EXAMPLE  
(3) (2) (1)  
(1)  
80JS024  
3) Continue to lift up the hood until it is  
high enough to support with the prop  
rod.  
79K055  
64J104  
The sun visors can be pulled down to block  
glare coming through the windshield, or  
they can be unhooked and turned to the  
side to block glare coming through the side  
window.  
The interior light switch has three posi-  
tions, which functions as described below.  
To close the engine hood:  
ON (1)  
1) Lift the hood up slightly and remove the  
prop rod from the hole. Put the prop rod  
back to the holding clip.  
The light comes on and stays on regard-  
less of whether the door is open or closed.  
The extension (1) can be drawn out to  
block glare widely.  
2) Lower the hood close to the bumper,  
then let it drop down. Make sure the  
hood is securely latched after closing.  
DOOR (2)  
The light comes on when the door is  
opened. After closing all doors, the light  
will remain on for about 15 seconds and  
then fade out. If you push in the ignition  
switch or insert the key during this time, the  
light will start to fade out immediately. After  
removing the key from the ignition switch,  
the light will turn on for about 15 seconds  
and then fade out.  
CAUTION  
When unhooking and hooking a sun  
visor, be sure to handle it by the hard  
plastic parts or the sun visor can be  
damaged.  
WARNING  
Make sure the hood is fully closed  
and latched before driving. If it is not,  
it can fly up unexpectedly during  
driving, obstructing your view and  
resulting in an accident.  
OFF (3)  
The light remains off even when the door is  
opened.  
5-45  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Luggage Compartment Light  
(SX4)  
Trunk Light (SX4 SEDAN)  
EXAMPLE  
EXAMPLE  
(1)  
(2)  
79J075  
NOTE:  
56KN038  
The number of doors involved in the light-  
ing operation of the interior light depends  
on the vehicle specification. If there is a  
switch (rubber projection) at the door  
opening as shown, the door is involved in  
the lighting operation. The tailgate of SX4  
is also involved in this operation even with-  
out the rubber projection.  
When you open the trunk lid, the trunk light  
comes on and remains on as long as you  
keep the lid open.  
79J053  
When you open the tailgate with the lug-  
gage compartment light switch in the “ON”  
position (1), the light comes on and  
remains on as long as you keep the tail-  
gate open.  
When the luggage compartment light  
switch is in the “OFF” position (2), the light  
remains off regardless of whether the tail-  
gate is opened or closed.  
CAUTION  
Do not leave the trunk lid open for a  
long time, or the battery will dis-  
charge.  
CAUTION  
Do not leave the tailgate open with  
the luggage compartment light  
switch in the “ON” position for a long  
time, or the battery will discharge.  
5-46  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Spot Light  
Accessory Socket  
(if equipped)  
Cigarette Lighter and Ashtray  
(if equipped)  
Cigarette Lighter (if equipped)  
79J074  
Push the switch to turn on the light and  
push it again to turn off the light.  
80J2046  
The accessory socket will work when the  
ignition switch is in the “ACC” or “ON” posi-  
tion.  
This socket can be used to provide 12 volt/  
120 watt power for electrical accessories.  
80J2067  
The cigarette lighter will work when the  
ignition switch is in the “ACC” or “ON” posi-  
tion.  
To use the cigarette lighter, push it all the  
way into the receptacle and release it. It  
will automatically heat up and will pop out  
to its normal position when it is ready for  
use.  
CAUTION  
Use of inappropriate electrical acces-  
sories can cause damage to your  
vehicle’s electrical system. Make  
sure that any electrical accessories  
you use are designed to plug into this  
type of socket.  
CAUTION  
Holding the cigarette lighter in can  
overheat and damage the lighter.  
Release the lighter after you push it  
in.  
5-47  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Ashtray (if equipped)  
Assist Grips (if equipped)  
CAUTION  
EXAMPLE  
To avoid damage to the cigarette  
lighter socket, do not use it as an  
accessory power source. Some  
accessories’ power plug can damage  
the inner mechanism of the cigarette  
lighter socket.  
79J047  
54G249  
You can fit the ashtray into any of the cup  
holders on the center console.  
Assist grips are provided for convenience.  
CAUTION  
WARNING  
To avoid damaging the assist grip  
and the molded headlining, do not  
hang down the assist grip.  
Make sure tobacco is fully extin-  
guished before closing the ashtrays.  
Never throw waste in the ashtrays: it  
could create a fire hazard.  
5-48  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Glove Box  
Cup Holder and Storage Area  
(if equipped)  
WARNING  
Do not use the cup holder or the stor-  
age bin to hold cups containing hot  
liquids or sharp-edged, hard or  
breakable objects. Objects in these  
bins may be thrown about during a  
sudden stop or impact, and could  
cause personal injury.  
EXAMPLE  
Bottle holder  
Front  
79J120  
To open the glove box, pull the latch lever.  
To close it, push the lid until it latches  
securely.  
80J046  
EXAMPLE  
WARNING  
Never drive with the glove box lid  
open. It could cause injury if an acci-  
dent occurs.  
80JM055  
79J052  
Cup holders are provided in the center  
console.  
5-49  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Rear  
Luggage compartment pocket (SX4)  
Front Seat Back Pocket  
(if equipped)  
EXAMPLE  
(1)  
80JM143  
80JM124  
You should hold a bottle with a cap in the  
holder.  
To open the lid, slide the lever (1) and pull  
the lid.  
80JC089  
This pocket is provided for holding light  
and soft things such as gloves, newspa-  
pers or magazines.  
WARNING  
Do not put hard or breakable objects  
in the pocket. If an accident occurs,  
objects such as bottles, cans, etc.  
can injure the occupants in the rear  
seat.  
80JM108  
The lid can be installed on the back of the  
luggage compartment board.  
5-50  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Armrest (if equipped)  
Shopping Hook (if equipped)  
Floor Mats (if equipped)  
Luggage compartment  
EXAMPLE  
80J2068  
80J2014  
80JM058  
To use the armrest, pivot it down from the  
stowed (fully up) position. When not in use,  
return the armrest to the stowed position.  
Your vehicle has a fastener to keep the  
driver’s side floor mat from sliding forward  
and possibly interfering with the pedals.  
Whenever you put the driver’s side floor  
mat back in the vehicle after it has been  
removed, be sure to hook the floor mat  
grommet(s) to the fastener(s) and position  
the floor mat properly in the footwell.  
You can hang the shopping bag or other  
suitable objects on the hook.  
This hook is not designed for large or  
heavy items.  
CAUTION  
To avoid damage to the armrest, do  
not lean onto it or allow a child ride  
on it.  
When you replace the floor mats in your  
vehicle with a different type such as all-  
weather floor mats, we highly recommend  
using genuine SUZUKI floor mats for  
proper fitting.  
5-51  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
Luggage or other cargo placed in the lug-  
gage compartment can be hidden from  
view by a luggage compartment cover.  
Luggage Compartment Cover  
(if equipped)  
WARNING  
Failure to take the following precau-  
tions may result in the driver’s side  
floor mat interfering with the pedals  
and causing a loss of vehicle control  
or an accident.  
• Make sure that the floor mat grom-  
met(s) is(are) hooked to the fas-  
tener(s).  
• Never place additional floor mats  
on top of the existing floor mats.  
WARNING  
Do not carry items on top of the lug-  
gage compartment cover, even if they  
are small and light. Objects on top of  
the cover could be thrown about in an  
accident, causing injury, or could  
obstruct the driver’s rear view.  
80J049  
Rear  
Front  
80JM128  
5-52  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
To remove the luggage compartment  
board:  
Luggage Compartment Board  
(if equipped)  
80JM062  
You can stow the board behind the rear  
seatback as shown in the illustration.  
80JM060  
1) Fold the board forward.  
80JM059  
Your vehicle is equipped with the luggage  
compartment board in the luggage com-  
partment. You can place luggage or other  
cargos on the board or under the board.  
You can also place tall luggage by stowing  
the board on the floor of the luggage com-  
partment.  
CAUTION  
To avoid injury, handle the board  
carefully when removing or installing.  
Do not place the objects taller than  
the luggage compartment cover  
since objects could obstruct the  
driver’s rear view or could damage  
objects or the tailgate while driving.  
80JM109  
2) Lift the board, and remove the board  
from the vehicle.  
5-53  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
To re-install the luggage board to the  
normal position:  
To install the luggage board on the floor  
of the luggage compartment:  
(2)  
(1)  
80JM145  
3) Place the strikers of the luggage board  
to the latches on the luggage floor.  
80JM144  
80JM129  
Place the strikers of the luggage board to  
the latches on the side and tail end of orig-  
inal position.  
1) Unfold the luggage compartment board  
(1), and insert it along the groove (2) at  
both side of the luggage compartment  
as shown in the illustration.  
2) Slide the board forward.  
5-54  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
You can use the roof rails or the roof rack  
anchors to attach the optional roof rack  
which is available at your SUZUKI dealer. If  
you use a roof rack, observe the instruc-  
tions and precautions in this section and  
provided with the roof rack.  
• Secure the front and rear ends of long  
items – such as wood panels, surfboards  
and so forth – to both the front and rear  
of the vehicle. You should protect the  
painted surfaces of the vehicle from  
scuffing caused by tie-down ropes.  
• Check periodically to make sure the roof  
rack is securely installed and free from  
damage.  
Roof Rails or Roof Rack  
Anchors (if equipped)  
Roof rails  
• Make sure the roof rack is securely  
installed.  
To mount various types of cargo (such  
as skis, bicycles, etc.) properly, use suit-  
able attachments which are available  
from your SUZUKI dealer. Be sure to  
install the attachments properly and  
securely according to the instructions  
provided. Do not mount cargo directly on  
the roof panel. The cargo can damage  
the roof panel.  
• The gross weight of the roof rack plus  
cargo must not exceed the loading  
capacity (50 kg (110 lbs)). Also, do not  
let the gross vehicle weight (fully loaded  
vehicle including driver, passengers,  
cargo, roof load and trailer tongue  
weight) exceed the Gross Vehicle  
Weight Rating (GVWR) listed in the  
driver’s door lock pillar.  
• Mount and secure the cargo onto the  
roof rack properly according to the  
instructions provided. Be sure to stow  
the heaviest items at the bottom and dis-  
tribute the cargo as evenly as possible.  
• Do not carry items so large that they  
hang over the bumpers or the sides of  
the vehicle, or block your view.  
• For vehicles with roof rack anchors,  
make sure the anchors are covered with  
the caps when not in use.  
WARNING  
• Abrupt maneuvers or failure to  
properly secure cargo can allow the  
cargo to fly off the vehicle and hit  
others, causing personal injury or  
property damage.  
• Mount cargo securely and avoid  
abrupt maneuvers such as “jack-  
rabbit” starts, sharp turns, fast cor-  
nering and sudden braking. Check  
periodically to make sure that  
cargo is securely fastened.  
• Large, bulky, long, or flat items can  
affect vehicle aerodynamics or be  
caught by the wind, and can reduce  
vehicle control resulting in an acci-  
dent and personal injury. Drive cau-  
tiously at a safely reduced speed  
when carrying this type of cargo.  
79J167  
Roof rack anchors  
80J082  
5-55  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
CAUTION  
Front bumper cover (if equipped)  
Frame Hooks  
SX4  
If towing your vehicle, use the frame  
hook of removed bumper cover side  
to prevent damage to the vehicle.  
Front (1)  
(d)  
NOTE:  
When return the cover, make sure the  
ungual (d) of the cover securely fit to the  
slit on under the front bumper of vehicle.  
(1)  
EXAMPLE  
(c)  
80J2049  
SX4 SEDAN  
Front (1)  
(a)  
(b)  
EXAMPLE  
To use the frame hook:  
80JM111  
1) Insert a flat blade screwdriver into the  
hole (b) and remove the clips (a) by  
twist the driver as shown in the illustra-  
tion.  
EXAMPLE  
(1)  
2) Remove the bumper cover (c).  
80J2050  
5-56  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OTHER CONTROLS AND EQUIPMENT  
SX4  
Side (3)  
Frame hooks are provided on the front (1),  
rear (2) and side (3) of the vehicle. The  
hooks (1) and (2) are used for emergency  
situations. The hooks (3) are used for  
trailer/train shipping purposes.  
Rear (2)  
To tow your vehicle on the road or highway,  
follow the instruction of “Towing” in “EMER-  
GENCY SERVICE” section.  
WARNING  
Do not use the frame hooks to tow  
another vehicle or to have your vehi-  
cle towed on the road or highway.  
The hooks (1) and (2) are designed  
for use in emergency situations only,  
such as if your vehicle or another  
vehicle gets stuck in deep mud or  
snow.  
(3)  
EXAMPLE  
(2)  
80JC062  
EXAMPLE  
80JC061  
EXAMPLE  
SX4 SEDAN  
Rear (2)  
The hooks (3) are provided for trailer/  
train shipping purposes.  
CAUTION  
(3)  
Never use the hooks (1) and (2) for  
trailer/train shipping purposes to pre-  
vent damage to the vehicle.  
79J132  
(2)  
EXAMPLE  
56KN033  
5-57  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING  
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING  
Vehicle Loading ................................................................... 6-1  
Trailer Towing ...................................................................... 6-2  
Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing) ...................... 6-2  
6
54G215  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Exhaust Gas Warning: NO  
Daily Inspection Checklist: NO  
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING  
Vehicle Capacity Weight – Maximum per-  
missible load weight a vehicle can carry  
including the weight of all the occupants,  
accessories and cargo.  
Vehicle Loading  
WARNING  
Never overload your vehicle. The  
gross vehicle weight (sum of the  
weights of the loaded vehicle, driver  
and passengers) must never exceed  
the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating  
(GVWR) listed on the Safety Certifica-  
tion Label. In addition, never distrib-  
ute a load so that the weight on either  
the front or rear axle exceeds the  
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR)  
listed on the Safety Certification  
Label.  
The weight of any accessories already  
installed on your vehicle at the time of pur-  
chase, or that you or the dealer install after  
purchase, must be subtracted from the  
Vehicle Capacity Weight to determine how  
much capacity remains available for occu-  
pants and cargo. Contact your dealer for  
further information.  
Actual weight of the loaded vehicle and  
actual loads at the front and rear axles can  
only be determined by weighing the vehicle  
using a vehicle scale. To measure the  
weight and load, try taking your vehicle to  
a highway weighing station, shipping com-  
pany or inspection station for trucks, etc.  
Compare these weights to the GVWR and  
GAWR (front and rear) listed on the Safety  
Certification Label. If the gross vehicle  
weight or the load on either axle exceeds  
these ratings, you must remove enough  
weight to bring the load down to the rated  
capacity.  
80JS025  
WARNING  
Your vehicle was designed for specific  
weight capacities. The weight capacities of  
your vehicle are indicated by the Gross  
Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR), the Gross  
Axle Weight Rating (GAWR, front and rear)  
and the Vehicle Capacity Weight. The  
GVWR and GAWR (front and rear) are  
listed on the Safety Certification Label  
which is located below the driver’s side  
door latch striker. The Vehicle Capacity  
Weight is listed on the Tire Information  
Label which is located below the Safety  
Certification Label.  
• Always distribute cargo evenly.  
• To avoid personal injury or damage  
to your vehicle, always secure  
cargo to prevent it from shifting if  
the vehicle moves suddenly.  
• Place heavier objects on the floor  
and as far forward in the trunk or in  
the cargo area as possible.  
• Never pile cargo higher than the  
top of the seat backs.  
GVWR – Maximum permissible overall  
weight of the fully loaded vehicle (including  
all the occupants, accessories and cargo).  
GAWR – (Front and Rear) Maximum per-  
missible weight on an individual axle.  
6-1  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Daily Inspection Checklist: NO  
Starting the Engine: 1  
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING  
TOWING INSTRUCTION TABLE  
Trailer Towing  
Towing Your Vehicle  
(recreational towing)  
DRIVE  
TRAIN  
TRANS-  
AXLE  
TOWING  
METHOD  
Your vehicle may be towed behind another  
vehicle (such as a motorhome), provided  
you use the proper towing method speci-  
fied for your vehicle. The towing method  
you must use depends on the specifica-  
tions of your vehicle: whether it is a 2-  
wheel drive (2WD) or intelligent All Wheel  
Drive (i-AWD) vehicle.  
CVT  
A
(AUTO)  
2WD  
M/T  
(MANUAL)  
A B  
i-AWD  
including  
2WD mode  
CVT  
none  
B
M/T  
Use the towing instruction table to select  
the proper towing method for your vehicle,  
and carefully follow the corresponding  
instructions. Be sure to use proper towing  
equipment designed for recreational tow-  
ing and make sure that towing speed does  
not exceed 90 km/h (55 mph).  
54G639  
Do not use your vehicle to tow a trailer. The  
vehicle is not designed or intended for  
such use. Towing a trailer can adversely  
affect handling, durability and fuel econ-  
omy.  
WARNING  
Always use a safety chain when tow-  
ing your vehicle and be sure to  
observe federal, state, and local  
requirements for trailer hitches, tow  
bars, lights, etc.  
80J2051  
CAUTION  
For the CVT of intelligent All Wheel  
Drive (i-AWD) models, don’t tow your  
vehicle behind another vehicle such  
as a motorhome, or the drive train  
may be seriously damaged.  
6-2  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Block Heater: 1  
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING  
TOWING METHOD A  
A: 2WD (except 2WD mode of i-AWD)  
VEHICLES WITH MANUAL TRANS-  
AXLE OR CVT  
FROM THE FRONT:  
FRONT WHEELS ON A DOLLY  
AND REAR WHEELS ON THE GROUND  
1) Secure the front wheels on a towing  
dolly according to the instructions pro-  
vided by the dolly manufacturer.  
2) Release the parking brake.  
80J2053  
CAUTION  
Towing the 2WD or i-AWD CVT vehi-  
cles with four wheels on the ground  
can result in damage to the CVT.  
80J2052  
6-3  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Transaxle: 10  
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING  
B: 2WD or i-AWD (including 2WD mode)  
VEHICLES WITH MANUAL TRANSAXLE  
1) Shift the manual transaxle lever into  
neutral.  
2) Turn the ignition key to the “ACC” posi-  
tion to unlock the steering wheel.  
3) Release the parking brake.  
TOWING METHOD B  
FROM THE FRONT:  
FOUR WHEELS ON THE GROUND  
CAUTION  
The steering column is not strong  
enough to withstand shocks trans-  
mitted from the front wheels during  
towing. Always unlock the steering  
wheel before towing.  
80J2054  
CAUTION  
Towing the 2WD or i-AWD CVT vehi-  
cles with four wheels on the ground  
can result in damage to the CVT.  
80J2079  
6-4  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Transaxle: 10  
VEHICLE LOADING AND TOWING  
MEMO  
6-5  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Maintenance Schedule ....................................................... 7-2  
Periodic Maintenance Schedule ........................................ 7-3  
Maintenance Recommended under Severe Driving  
Conditions ........................................................................... 7-7  
Drive Belt ............................................................................. 7-11  
Engine Oil and Filter ........................................................... 7-11  
Engine Coolant .................................................................... 7-14  
Air Cleaner ........................................................................... 7-16  
Spark Plugs ......................................................................... 7-16  
Gear Oil ................................................................................ 7-18  
Clutch Pedal ........................................................................ 7-19  
Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT) Fluid .................. 7-20  
Brakes .................................................................................. 7-21  
Steering Wheel .................................................................... 7-23  
Tires ...................................................................................... 7-24  
Battery .................................................................................. 7-35  
Fuses .................................................................................... 7-36  
Headlight Aiming ................................................................. 7-39  
Bulb Replacement ............................................................... 7-40  
Wiper Blades ....................................................................... 7-46  
Windshield Washer Fluid ................................................... 7-50  
Air Conditioning System .................................................... 7-50  
7
60G410  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Highway Driving: NO  
Driving on Hills: NO  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
WARNING  
WARNING  
(Continued)  
(Continued)  
• Do not leave the engine running in  
garages or other confined areas.  
• When the engine is running, keep  
hands, clothing, tools and other  
objects away from the moving fan  
and drive belt.  
• Be careful not to cause accidental  
short circuits between the positive  
and negative battery terminals.  
• Keep used oil, engine coolant and  
other fluids away from children and  
pets. Dispose of used fluids prop-  
erly; never pour them on the  
ground, into sewers, etc.  
• When it is necessary to do service  
work with the engine running, make  
sure that the parking brake is set  
fully and the transaxle is in Neutral  
(for manual transaxle vehicles) or  
Park (for CVT vehicles).  
60A187S  
• Do not touch ignition wires or other  
ignition system parts when starting  
the engine or when the engine is  
running, or you could receive an  
electric shock.  
• Be careful not to touch a hot  
engine, exhaust manifold and  
pipes, muffler, radiator and water  
hoses.  
• Do not allow smoking, sparks or  
flames around fuel or the battery.  
Flammable fumes are present.  
• Do not get under your vehicle if it is  
supported only with the portable  
jack provided in your vehicle.  
(Continued)  
WARNING  
You should take extreme care when  
working on your vehicle to prevent  
accidental injury. Here are a few pre-  
cautions that you should be espe-  
cially careful to observe:  
• To prevent damage or unintended  
inflation of the air bag system, be  
sure the battery is disconnected  
and the ignition switch has been in  
the “LOCK” position for at least 90  
seconds before performing any  
electrical service work on your  
SUZUKI. Do not touch air bag sys-  
tem components or wires. The  
wires are wrapped with yellow tape  
or yellow tubing, and the couplers  
are yellow for easy identification.  
(Continued)  
7-1  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving on Hills: NO  
Driving on Slippery Roads: NO  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
WARNING  
NOTICE (for U.S.A.)  
Maintenance Schedule  
Maintenance, replacement or repair of  
the emission control devices and sys-  
tems may be performed by any automo-  
bile repair establishment or individual  
using any part which has been certified  
under the provisions in the Clean Air  
Act sec. 207. (a) (2).  
The following table shows the times when  
you should perform regular maintenance  
on your vehicle. This table shows in miles,  
kilometers and months when you should  
perform inspections, adjustments, lubrica-  
tion and other services. These intervals  
should be shortened if driving is usually  
done under severe conditions (refer to  
The shock absorbers are filled with  
high pressure gas. Never attempt to  
disassemble them or throw them into  
a fire. Avoid storing them near a  
heater or heating device. When  
scrapping the absorber, the gas must  
be released from the absorber safely.  
Ask your dealer for assistance.  
“Maintenance  
Recommended  
Under  
Severe Driving Conditions”).  
WARNING  
SUZUKI recommends that mainte-  
nance on items marked with an aster-  
isk (*) be performed by your  
authorized SUZUKI dealer or a quali-  
fied service technician. If you are  
qualified, you may perform mainte-  
nance on the unmarked items by  
referring to the instructions in this  
section. If you are not sure whether  
you can successfully complete any of  
the unmarked maintenance jobs, ask  
your authorized SUZUKI dealer to do  
the maintenance for you.  
CAUTION  
Whenever it becomes necessary to  
replace parts on your vehicle, it is  
recommended that you use genuine  
SUZUKI replacement parts or their  
equivalent.  
7-2  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving on Slippery Roads: NO  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Periodic Maintenance Schedule  
R: Replace or change  
I : Inspect, clean, adjust, lubricate or replace as necessary  
miles (x 1000)  
7.5  
12.5  
7.5  
15  
25  
15  
22.5  
37.5  
22.5  
30  
50  
30  
37.5  
62.5  
37.5  
45  
75  
45  
52.5  
87.5  
52.5  
60  
100  
60  
67.5  
112.5  
67.5  
75  
125  
75  
Interval: This interval should be judged by  
odometer reading or months, whichever comes km (x 1000)  
first.  
months  
ENGINE & EMISSION CONTROL  
1. Drive belt  
Inspect for damage  
R
R
R
I
R
R
R
I
I
R
I
R
R
*2. Valve lash (clearance)  
3. Engine oil and oil filter  
*4. Cooling system hoses and connections  
5. Engine coolant  
R
I
SUZUKI LLC: Standard (Green)  
R
R
SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue) (#1) First time only: Replace at 150000 km (90000 miles) or 90 months  
Second time and after: Replace every 75000 km (45000 miles) or 45 months  
*6. Exhaust pipes and mountings  
*7. EVAP canister  
I
I
Replace every 250000 km (150000 miles) or 180 months  
*8. Emission-related hoses & tubes  
9. Spark plugs  
*10. Ignition coil (plug cap)  
*11. Fuel tank & cap  
12. Air cleaner filter element (paved road)  
*13. Fuel filter  
*14. Fuel lines and connections  
*15. Canister air suction filter  
I
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
I
R
I
R
I
Replace every 250000 km (150000 miles) or 180 months  
#1: Be sure to perform the engine coolant level check under the daily inspection in “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.  
If you replace the engine coolant other than the SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue), follow the schedule of SUZUKI LLC: Standard (Green).  
7-3  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving on Slippery Roads: NO  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
R: Replace or change  
I : Inspect, clean, adjust, lubricate or replace as necessary  
miles (x 1000)  
82.5  
137.5  
82.5  
90  
150  
90  
97.5  
162.5  
97.5  
105  
175  
105  
112.5  
187.5  
112.5  
120  
200  
120  
127.5  
212.5  
127.5  
135  
225  
135  
142.5  
237.5  
142.5  
150  
250  
150  
Interval: This interval should be judged by  
odometer reading or months, whichever comes km (x 1000)  
first.  
months  
ENGINE & EMISSION CONTROL  
1. Drive belt  
Inspect for damage  
R
I
R
R
R
I
I
R
I
R
R
R
I
*2. Valve lash (clearance)  
3. Engine oil and oil filter  
*4. Cooling system hoses and connections  
5. Engine coolant  
R
I
R
I
SUZUKI LLC: Standard (Green)  
R
R
R
SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue) (#1) First time only: Replace at 150000 km (90000 miles) or 90 months  
Second time and after: Replace every 75000 km (45000 miles) or 45 months  
*6. Exhaust pipes and mountings  
*7. EVAP canister  
I
I
I
Replace every 250000 km (150000 miles) or 180 months  
*8. Emission-related hoses & tubes  
9. Spark plugs  
*10. Ignition coil (plug cap)  
*11. Fuel tank & cap  
12. Air cleaner filter element (paved road)  
*13. Fuel filter  
*14. Fuel lines and connections  
*15. Canister air suction filter  
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
I (#2)  
R
R
R
I
R
I
I (#2)  
Replace every 250000 km (150000 miles) or 180 months  
#1: Be sure to perform the engine coolant level check under the daily inspection in “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.  
If you replace the engine coolant other than the SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue), follow the schedule of SUZUKI LLC: Standard (Green).  
#2: Inspect at 250000 km (150000 miles) or 180 months.  
NOTE:  
The maintenance services enclosed with rectangle are recommended maintenance items.  
The U.S. Environmental Protection Agency or the California Air Resources Board has determined that the failure to perform recom-  
mended maintenance items enclosed with a rectangle will not nullify the emission warranty or limit recall liability prior to the completion  
of the vehicle’s useful life. SUZUKI, however, urges that all recommended maintenance services be performed at the indicated inter-  
vals and the maintenance recorded.  
7-4  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
R: Replace or change  
I : Inspect, clean, adjust, lubricate or replace as necessary  
miles (x 1000)  
km (x 1000)  
7.5  
12.5  
7.5  
15  
25  
15  
22.5  
37.5  
22.5  
30  
50  
30  
37.5  
62.5  
37.5  
45  
75  
45  
52.5  
87.5  
52.5  
60  
100  
60  
67.5  
112.5  
67.5  
75  
125  
75  
Interval: This interval should be judged by odometer  
reading or months, whichever comes first.  
months  
CHASSIS AND BODY  
1. Clutch (for manual transaxle)  
Pedal and fluid level  
*2. Brake discs and pads  
Brake drums and shoes  
*3. Brake hoses and pipes  
4. Brake fluid level check, *replacement  
5. Brake pedal stroke check, *adjustment  
6. Parking brake lever and *cable  
Lever movement check, *adjustment  
7. Tires (including tire rotation)  
8. Wheel discs  
*9. Suspension system  
*10. Propeller shafts (i-AWD)/Drive axle boots  
*11. Manual transaxle oil  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
(front, rear)  
(rear)  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Level check, *replacement  
12. Continuously variable transaxle (CVT)  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
I
Fluid level  
*Fluid hose  
*13. Transfer oil (i-AWD)  
*14. Rear differential oil (i-AWD)  
15. Steering system  
R
I
I
Steering wheel movement,  
*linkage  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
16. Power steering (if equipped)  
17. All latches, hinges and locks  
18. Air conditioner filter element (if equipped)  
R
R
7-5  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
R: Replace or change  
I : Inspect, clean, adjust, lubricate or replace as necessary  
miles (x 1000)  
km (x 1000)  
82.5  
137.5  
82.5  
90  
150  
90  
97.5  
162.5  
97.5  
105  
175  
105  
112.5  
187.5  
112.5  
120  
200  
120  
127.5  
212.5  
127.5  
135  
225  
135  
142.5  
237.5  
142.5  
150  
250  
150  
Interval: This interval should be judged by odometer  
reading or months, whichever comes first.  
months  
CHASSIS AND BODY  
1. Clutch (for manual transaxle)  
Pedal and fluid level  
*2. Brake discs and pads  
Brake drums and shoes  
*3. Brake hoses and pipes  
4. Brake fluid level check, *replacement  
5. Brake pedal stroke check, *adjustment  
6. Parking brake lever and *cable  
Lever movement check, *adjustment  
7. Tires (including tire rotation)  
8. Wheel discs  
*9. Suspension system  
*10. Propeller shafts (i-AWD)/Drive axle boots  
*11. Manual transaxle oil  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
(front, rear)  
(rear)  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Level check, *replacement  
12. Continuously variable transaxle (CVT)  
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Fluid level  
*Fluid hose  
*13. Transfer oil (i-AWD)  
*14. Rear differential oil (i-AWD)  
15. Steering system  
I
I
Steering wheel movement,  
*linkage  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
16. Power steering (if equipped)  
17. All latches, hinges and locks  
18. Air conditioner filter element (if equipped)  
R
R
R
NOTE:  
This table shows the service schedule up to 250000 km (150000 miles).  
Beyond 250000 km (150000 miles), perform the same services at the same intervals shown in the chart.  
Beyond 250000 km (150000 miles), the maintenance services enclosed with a rectangle are required.  
7-6  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Maintenance Recommended under Severe Driving Conditions  
Follow this schedule if your car is mainly operated under one or more of the following conditions:  
• When most trips are less than 6 kilometers (4 miles)  
• When most trips are less than 16 kilometers (10 miles) and outside temperature remain below freezing.  
• Idling and/or low-speed operation in stop-and-go traffic.  
• Operating in dusty areas.  
Schedule should also be followed if the car is used for delivery service, police, taxi or other commercial applications.  
R: Replace or change  
I : Inspect, clean, adjust, lubricate or replace as necessary  
miles (x 1000)  
3
5
3
6
10  
6
9
15  
9
12  
20  
12  
15  
25  
15  
18  
30  
18  
21  
35  
21  
24  
40  
24  
27  
45  
27  
30  
50  
30  
33  
55  
33  
36  
60  
36  
39  
65  
39  
Interval: This interval should be judged by  
odometer reading or months, whichever km (x 1000)  
comes first.  
months  
ENGINE & EMISSION CONTROL  
1. Drive belt  
Inspect for damage  
R
R
R
R
R
I
R
R
R
R
I
R
R
R
*2. Valve lash (clearance)  
3. Engine oil and oil filter  
*4. Cooling system hoses and connections  
5. Engine coolant  
R
I
SUZUKI LLC: Standard (Green)  
R
SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue) (#1) First time only: Replace at 150000 km (90000 miles) or 90 months  
Second time and after: Replace every 75000 km (45000 miles) or 45 months  
*6. Exhaust pipes and mountings  
*7. EVAP canister  
I
I
Replace every 250000 km (150000 miles) or 180 months  
*8. Emission-related hoses & tubes  
9. Spark plugs  
*10. Ignition coil (plug cap)  
*11. Fuel tank & cap  
12. Air cleaner filter element (paved road)  
*13. Fuel filter  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
I
Replace every 250000 km (150000 miles) or 150 months  
*14. Fuel lines and connections  
*15. Canister air suction filter  
I
I
#1: Be sure to perform the engine coolant level check under the daily inspection in “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.  
If you replace the engine coolant other than the SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue), follow the schedule of SUZUKI LLC: Standard (Green).  
7-7  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
R: Replace or change  
I : Inspect, clean, adjust, lubricate or replace as necessary  
miles (x 1000)  
42  
70  
42  
45  
75  
45  
48  
80  
48  
51  
85  
51  
54  
90  
54  
57  
95  
57  
60  
100  
60  
63  
105  
63  
66  
110  
66  
69  
115  
69  
72  
120  
72  
75  
125  
75  
Interval: This interval should be judged by  
odometer reading or months, whichever km (x 1000)  
comes first.  
months  
ENGINE & EMISSION CONTROL  
1. Drive belt  
Inspect for damage  
R
R
I
R
R
R
R
I
I
R
I
R
R
R
R
R
I
*2. Valve lash (clearance)  
3. Engine oil and oil filter  
*4. Cooling system hoses and connections  
5. Engine coolant  
SUZUKI LLC: Standard (Green)  
R
SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue) (#1) First time only: Replace at 150000 km (90000 miles) or 90 months  
Second time and after: Replace every 75000 km (45000 miles) or 45 months  
*6. Exhaust pipes and mountings  
*7. EVAP canister  
I
I
I
Replace every 250000 km (150000 miles) or 180 months  
*8. Emission-related hoses & tubes  
9. Spark plugs  
*10. Ignition coil (plug cap)  
*11. Fuel tank & cap  
12. Air cleaner filter element (paved road)  
*13. Fuel filter  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
I
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
Replace every 250000 km (150000 miles) or 150 months  
*14. Fuel lines and connections  
*15. Canister air suction filter  
I
I
I
R
#1: Be sure to perform the engine coolant level check under the daily inspection in “OPERATING YOUR VEHICLE” section.  
If you replace the engine coolant other than the SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue), follow the schedule of SUZUKI LLC: Standard (Green).  
7-8  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
R: Replace or change  
I : Inspect, clean, adjust, lubricate or replace as necessary  
miles (x 1000)  
km (x 1000)  
3
5
3
6
10  
6
9
15  
9
12  
20  
12  
15  
25  
15  
18  
30  
18  
21  
35  
21  
24  
40  
24  
27  
45  
27  
30  
50  
30  
33  
55  
33  
36  
60  
36  
39  
65  
39  
Interval: This interval should be judged by odometer  
reading or months, whichever comes first.  
months  
CHASSIS AND BODY  
1. Clutch (for manual transaxle)  
Pedal and fluid level  
*2. Brake discs and pads  
Brake drums and shoes  
*3. Brake hoses and pipes  
4. Brake fluid level check, *replacement  
5. Brake pedal stroke check, *adjustment  
6. Parking brake lever and *cable  
Lever movement check, *adjustment  
7. Tires (including tire rotation)  
8. Wheel discs  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
(front, rear)  
(rear)  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
*9. Wheel bearings  
*10. Suspension system  
*11. Propeller shafts (i-AWD)/Drive axle boots  
*12. Manual transaxle oil  
I
I
I
Level check, *replacement  
13. Continuously variable transaxle (CVT)  
I
I
I
R
R
I
I
I
R
R
Fluid level  
*Fluid deterioration check*  
*Fluid hose  
2
*14. Transfer oil (i-AWD)  
*15. Rear differential oil (i-AWD)  
16. Steering system  
Steering wheel movement,  
*linkage  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
17. Power steering (if equipped)  
18. All latches, hinges and locks  
19. Air conditioner filter element (if equipped)*  
1
R
7-9  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
R: Replace or change  
I : Inspect, clean, adjust, lubricate or replace as necessary  
miles (x 1000)  
km (x 1000)  
42  
70  
42  
45  
75  
45  
48  
80  
48  
51  
85  
51  
54  
90  
54  
57  
95  
57  
60  
100  
60  
63  
105  
63  
66  
110  
66  
69  
115  
69  
72  
120  
72  
75  
125  
75  
Interval: This interval should be judged by odometer  
reading or months, whichever comes first.  
months  
CHASSIS AND BODY  
1. Clutch (for manual transaxle)  
Pedal and fluid level  
*2. Brake discs and pads  
Brake drums and shoes  
*3. Brake hoses and pipes  
4. Brake fluid level check, *replacement  
5. Brake pedal stroke check, *adjustment  
6. Parking brake lever and *cable  
Lever movement check, *adjustment  
7. Tires (including tire rotation)  
8. Wheel discs  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
(front, rear)  
(rear)  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
*9. Wheel bearings  
*10. Suspension system  
*11. Propeller shafts (i-AWD)/Drive axle boots  
*12. Manual transaxle oil  
I
I
Level check, *replacement  
13. Continuously variable transaxle (CVT)  
R
I
I
I
R
R
I
I
I
R
R
I
I
I
R
R
Fluid level  
*Fluid deterioration check*  
*Fluid hose  
2
*14. Transfer oil (i-AWD)  
*15. Rear differential oil (i-AWD)  
16. Steering system  
Steering wheel movement,  
*linkage  
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
17. Power steering (if equipped)  
18. All latches, hinges and locks  
19. Air conditioner filter element (if equipped)*  
1
R
NOTE:  
This table shows the service schedule up to 125000 km (75000 miles).  
Beyond 125000 km (75000 miles), perform the same services at the same intervals shown in the chart.  
1
2
* Clean more frequently if the air flow from the air conditioner decreases.  
* Check or replace as necessary if you usually drive with high speed or high engine revolutions.  
7-10  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Oil Level Check  
Engine oil dipstick  
Drive Belt  
Engine Oil and Filter  
Specified Oil  
WARNING  
When the engine is running, keep  
hands, hair, clothing, tools, etc. away  
from the moving fan and drive belts.  
Check the accessory drive belt only for  
damage. You do not need check it for ten-  
sion as it has an automatic tensioner.  
“Starburst”  
If you need to replace or adjust the belt  
have it done by your SUZUKI dealer.  
L4 2.0L  
80G064  
80JC103  
It is important to keep the engine oil at the  
correct level for proper lubrication of your  
vehicle’s engine. Check the oil level with  
the vehicle on a level surface. The oil level  
indication may be inaccurate if the vehicle  
is on a slope. The oil level should be  
checked either before starting the engine  
or at least 5 minutes after stopping the  
engine.  
Use engine oil with the American Petro-  
leum Institute Certified For Gasoline  
Engines “Starburst” symbol.  
ADB  
GE  
We highly recommend you use SAE 5W-  
30 oil.  
AC  
CAUTION  
: 100 N (10 kg, 22 lbs) press  
ADB: Accessory drive belt  
GE: Generator  
Failure to use the recommended oil  
can result in engine damage.  
DEF: Deflection  
AC: Air conditioner compressor  
80J2055  
7-11  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Refilling  
Changing Engine Oil and Filter  
EXAMPLE  
FULL  
ADD  
EXAMPLE  
EXAMPLE  
Open  
Close  
52D084  
81A147  
60G306  
The handle of the engine oil dipstick is col-  
ored yellow for easy identification.  
Remove the oil filler cap and pour oil slowly  
through the filler hole to bring the oil level  
to the upper limit on the dipstick. Be careful  
not to overfill. Too much oil is almost as  
bad as too little oil. After refilling, start the  
engine and allow it to idle for about a  
minute. Stop the engine, wait about 5 min-  
utes and check the oil level again.  
Drain the engine oil while the engine is still  
warm.  
Pull out the oil dipstick, wipe oil off with a  
clean cloth, insert the dipstick all the way  
into the engine, then remove it again. The  
oil on the stick should be between the  
upper and lower limits shown on the stick.  
1) Remove the oil filler cap.  
2) Place a drain pan under the drain plug.  
3) Using a wrench, remove the drain plug  
and drain out the engine oil.  
If the oil level indication is near the lower  
limit, add enough oil to raise the level to the  
upper limit.  
WARNING  
The engine oil temperature may be  
high enough to burn your fingers  
when the drain plug is loosened. Wait  
until the drain plug is cool enough to  
touch with your bare hands.  
7-12  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
WARNING  
Replace the Oil Filter  
EXAMPLE  
New and used oil and solvent can be  
hazardous. Children and pets may be  
harmed by swallowing new or used  
oil or solvent. Repeated, prolonged  
contact with used engine oil may  
cause [skin] cancer. Brief contact  
with used oil or solvent may irritate  
skin.  
• Keep new and used oil and solvent  
away from children and pets.  
• Wear a long-sleeve shirt and water-  
proof gloves.  
• Wash with soap if oil or solvent  
contacts your skin.  
54G093  
60A198  
(1) Oil filter  
(2) 3/4 turn  
1) Remove the engine under cover.  
2) Using an oil filter wrench, turn the oil fil-  
ter counterclockwise and remove it.  
3) Using a clean rag, wipe off the mount-  
ing surface on the engine where the  
new filter will be seated.  
4) Smear a little engine oil around the rub-  
ber gasket of the new oil filter.  
5) Screw on the new filter by hand until the  
filter gasket contacts the mounting sur-  
face.  
4) Reinstall the drain plug and gasket.  
Tighten the plug with a wrench to the  
specified torque.  
6) Tighten the filter 3/4 turn from the point  
of contact with the mounting surface (or  
to the specified torque) using an oil filter  
wrench.  
Tightening torque specification  
35 Nm (25.3 lb-ft, 3.5 kg-m)  
Tightening torque specification  
14 Nm (10.0 lb-ft, 1.4 kg-m)  
CAUTION  
CAUTION  
To prevent oil leakage, make sure  
that the oil filter is tight, but do not  
overtighten it.  
To tighten the oil filter properly, it is  
important to accurately identify the  
position at which the filter gasket  
first contacts the mounting surface.  
7-13  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
NOTE:  
Engine Coolant  
When it is difficult to remove the oil filter,  
we recommend you take your vehicle to  
your SUZUKI dealer for oil filter replace-  
ment.  
EXAMPLE  
Selection of Coolant  
CAUTION  
SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue) coolant;  
SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue) coolant is  
already diluted to the proper percent-  
age. Do not dilute with distilled water  
additionally. Doing so may result in  
the possibility of freezing coolant  
and/or overheating.  
Refill with Oil and Check for Leaks  
1) Pour oil through the filler hole and  
install the filler cap.  
For the approximate capacity of the oil,  
refer to the “Capacities” item in the  
“SPECIFICATIONS” section.  
2) Start the engine and look carefully for  
leaks at the oil filter and drain plug. Run  
the engine at various speeds for at least  
5 minutes.  
3) Stop the engine and wait about 5 min-  
utes. Check the oil level again and add  
oil if necessary. Check for leaks again.  
To maintain optimum performance and  
durability of your engine, use SUZUKI  
Genuine Coolant or equivalent.  
80J014  
CAUTION  
NOTE:  
Oil leaks from around the oil filter or  
drain plug indicate incorrect installa-  
tion or gasket damage. If you find any  
leaks or are not sure that the filter  
has been properly tightened, have  
the vehicle inspected by your SUZUKI  
dealer.  
If you replace the engine coolant other  
than the SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue), follow  
the schedule of SUZUKI LLC: Standard  
(Green). To see the detail of the mainte-  
nance schedule, refer to “Periodic Mainte-  
nance Schedule” in this section.  
CAUTION  
When replacing the oil filter, it is rec-  
ommended that you use a genuine  
SUZUKI replacement filter. If you use  
an after-market filter, make sure it is  
of equivalent quality and carefully fol-  
low the manufacturer’s instructions  
and precautions.  
This type of coolant is best for your cooling  
system as it:  
• Helps maintain proper engine tempera-  
ture.  
• Gives proper protection against freezing  
and boiling.  
• Gives proper protection against corro-  
sion and rust.  
7-14  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Failure to use the proper coolant can dam-  
age your cooling system. Your authorized  
SUZUKI dealer can help you select the  
proper coolant.  
Coolant Level Check  
Check the engine coolant level at the  
reserve tank, not at the radiator. With the  
engine cool, the engine coolant level  
should be between the “FULLand “LOW”  
marks.  
WARNING  
Engine coolant is harmful or fatal if  
swallowed or inhaled. Do not drink  
antifreeze or coolant solution. If swal-  
lowed, do not induce vomiting. Imme-  
CAUTION  
To avoid damaging your cooling sys-  
tem:  
diately contact  
a
poison control  
Adding Coolant  
center or a physician. Avoid inhaling  
mist or hot vapors; if inhaled, remove  
to fresh air. If coolant gets in eyes,  
flush eyes with water and seek medi-  
cal attention. Wash thoroughly after  
handling. Solution can be poisonous  
to animals. Keep out of the reach of  
children and animals.  
• Always use a high quality ethylene  
glycol base phosphate type coolant  
diluted with distilled water at the  
correct mixture concentration.  
• Make sure that the proper mix is 50/  
50 coolant to distilled water and in  
no case higher than 70/30. Concen-  
trations greater than 70/30 coolant  
to distilled water will cause over-  
heating conditions.  
CAUTION  
• Do not use straight coolant nor  
plain water (except SUZUKI LLC:  
Super (Blue)).  
• Do not add extra inhibitors or addi-  
tives. They may not be compatible  
with your cooling system.  
• Do not mix different types of base  
coolants. Doing so may result in  
accelerated seal wear and/or the  
possibility of severe overheating  
and extensive engine/CVT damage.  
SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue) coolant;  
SUZUKI LLC: Super (Blue) coolant is  
already diluted to the proper percent-  
age. Do not dilute with distilled water  
additionally. Doing so may result in  
the possibility of freezing coolant  
and/or overheating.  
56KN090  
If the engine coolant level is below the  
“LOW” mark, more engine coolant should  
be added. Remove the reserve tank cap  
and add engine coolant until the reserve  
tank level reaches the “FULLmark. Never  
fill the reserve tank above the “FULLmark.  
7-15  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Air Cleaner  
Spark Plugs  
CAUTION  
You should inspect spark plugs periodically  
for carbon deposits. When carbon accu-  
mulates on a spark plug, a strong spark  
may not be produced. Remove carbon  
deposits with a wire or pin and adjust the  
spark plug gap.  
SUZUKI LLC: Standard (Green)  
coolant;  
• The mixture you use should con-  
tain 50% concentration of anti-  
freeze.  
• If the lowest ambient temperature  
in your area is expected to be  
–35°C (–31°F) or below, use higher  
concentrations up to 60% following  
the instructions on the antifreeze  
container.  
To access the spark plugs,  
(3)  
(2)  
CAUTION  
80J2056  
If the air cleaner is clogged with dust, there  
will be greater intake resistance, resulting  
in decreased power output and increased  
fuel consumption.  
When putting the cap on the reser-  
voir tank, line up the mark on the cap  
and the mark on the tank. Failure to  
follow this can result in coolant leak-  
age.  
Unclamp the side clamps, and remove the  
element from the air cleaner case. If it  
appears to be dirty, replace it with a new  
one.  
(1)  
80J2069  
Coolant Replacement  
1) Remove the air cleaner inlet hose (1).  
Remove the front part (2), then remove  
the rear part (3) of the air cleaner case.  
Since special procedures are required, we  
recommend you take your vehicle to your  
SUZUKI dealer for coolant replacement.  
CAUTION  
The air cleaner element should be  
replaced every 50000 km (30000  
miles). More frequent replacement is  
necessary when you drive under  
dusty conditions.  
CAUTION  
When remove the engine cover, make  
sure the cover does not interfere the  
vehicle to avoid damage to the cover.  
7-16  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
EXAMPLE  
CAUTION  
• When servicing the iridium/plati-  
num spark plugs (slender center  
electrode type plugs), do not touch  
the center electrode, as it is easy to  
damage.  
1.0 – 1.1 mm  
(0.039 – 0.043 in.)  
(4)  
• When installing the spark plugs,  
screw them in with your fingers to  
avoid stripping the threads. Tighten  
with a torque wrench to 25 Nm (2.5  
kg-m, 18.0 lb-ft). Do not allow con-  
taminants to enter the engine  
through the spark plug holes when  
the plugs are removed.  
80J2070  
80G093  
2) Disconnect the coupler (4) while push-  
ing the release lever,  
• Never use spark plugs with the  
wrong thread size.  
3) Remove the bolt, and  
4) Pull the ignition coil out.  
CAUTION  
When replacing spark plugs, you  
should use the brand and type speci-  
fied for your vehicle. For the speci-  
fied  
plugs,  
refer  
to  
the  
“SPECIFICATIONS” section at the  
end of this book. If you wish to use a  
brand of spark plug other than the  
specified plugs, consult your SUZUKI  
dealer.  
7-17  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Manual transaxle  
EXAMPLE  
Gear Oil  
API GRADE  
GL-4  
Specified Gear Oil  
Manual transaxle  
When replacing gear oil, use gear oil with  
the appropriate viscosity and grade as  
shown in the charts below.  
Rear differential oil  
(i-AWD)/Transfer oil  
(i-AWD CVT)  
GL-5 (Hypoid  
gear oil)  
We highly recommend you use:  
“SUZUKI GEAR OIL 75W-80” for manual  
transaxle gear oil  
(1)  
Manual transaxle (API GL-4)  
75W-80, 75W-85, 75W-90  
80J2083  
o
-30 -20 -10  
0
32  
10  
50  
20  
68  
30  
86 104  
40  
C
F
Transfer case (i-AWD)  
o
-22  
-4  
14  
80J2087  
We highly recommend you use:  
API GL-5 hypoid gear oil SAE 80W-90 for  
rear differential oil (i-AWD) and transfer oil  
of CVT model (i-AWD)  
(1)  
Rear differential oil (i-AWD)/Transfer oil  
of CVT model (i-AWD)  
(API GL-5 Hypoid)  
80J007  
(1) Oil filler and level plug  
54G096  
7-18  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Rear differential (i-AWD)  
Gear Oil Level Check  
Clutch Pedal  
The manual transaxle, transfer gears (i-  
AWD CVT) and rear differential (i-AWD)  
are lubricated with gear oil. To check the  
gear oil level in any of the above locations,  
use the following procedure:  
(1)  
1) Park the vehicle on a level surface. Set  
parking brake and stop the engine.  
2) Remove the oil filler plug (1).  
For the manual transaxle;  
3) If gear oil flow from the plug hole, the oil  
level is correct. Reinstall the plug.  
If gear oil do not flow from the plug  
hole, add oil through the filler plug hole  
until a little oil flow from the plug hole.  
80J015  
80J004  
(1) Oil filler and level plug  
For the transfer and rear differential;  
3) Check the inside of the hole with your  
finger. If the oil level comes up to the  
bottom of the plug hole, the oil level is  
correct. If so, reinstall the plug.  
4) If the oil level is low, add gear oil  
through the filler plug hole (1) until the  
oil level reaches the bottom of the filler  
hole.  
Check the clutch pedal for smooth opera-  
tion and clutch fluid level from time to time.  
If clutch dragging is felt with the pedal fully  
depressed, have the clutch inspected by  
your SUZUKI dealer. If the clutch fluid level  
is near the “MIN” line, fill it up to the “MAX”  
line with SAE J1703 or DOT3 brake fluid.  
Tightening torque  
Oil Filler Plug  
27 Nm  
(19.5 lb-ft)  
(2.7 kg-m)  
Manual transaxle  
Transfer  
23 Nm  
(16.6 lb-ft)  
(2.3 kg-m)  
Gear Oil Replacement  
Rear differential  
Since special procedures, materials and  
tools are required, it is recommended that  
you trust this job to your authorized  
SUZUKI dealer.  
7-19  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
EXAMPLE  
hot weather. Wait until the fluid cools down  
(about 30 minutes), or the fluid level indica-  
tion will not be correct.  
Continuously Variable  
Transaxle (CVT) Fluid  
Specified Fluid  
3) Park your vehicle on level ground.  
4) Apply the parking brake and then start  
the engine in “P” (Park). Let it idle for  
two minutes and keep it running during  
the fluid level check.  
5) With your foot on the brake pedal, move  
the gearshift lever through each gear,  
pausing for about three seconds in  
each range. Then move it back to the  
“P” (Park) position.  
Use a CVT fluid SUZUKI CVT FLUID  
GREEN-1 or Shell GREEN-1V.  
Fluid Level Check  
CAUTION  
Driving with too much or too little  
fluid can damage the transaxle.  
80J2071  
You must check the fluid level with the CVT  
fluid at normal operating temperature.  
WARNING  
EXAMPLE  
Be sure to depress the brake pedal  
when moving the gearshift lever, or  
the vehicle can move suddenly.  
To check the fluid level:  
1) To warm up the transaxle fluid, drive the  
vehicle or idle the engine until the tem-  
perature gauge indicates normal oper-  
ating temperature.  
(3)  
(1)  
EXAMPLE  
(2)  
2) Then drive for ten more minutes.  
CAUTION  
Be sure to use the specified CVT  
fluid. Using CVT fluid other than  
SUZUKI CVT FLUID GREEN-1 or Shell  
GREEN-1V may damage the CVT of  
your vehicle.  
80J2072  
(1) FULL  
NOTE:  
(2) LOW  
Do not check the fluid level if you have just  
driven the vehicle for a long time at high  
speed, or if you have driven in city traffic in  
(3) The lowest point = Fluid level  
75F086  
7-20  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
6) The handle of the CVT fluid dipstick is  
colored red or orange for easy identifi-  
cation.  
Brakes  
Brake Fluid  
Remove the dipstick, clean it and push  
it back in until the cap seats. Pull out  
the dipstick and read the fluid level.  
The fluid level should be between the  
two marks in the “HOT” range on the  
dipstick.  
or  
EXAMPLE  
80J104  
7) Add just enough specified fluid through  
the dipstick hole to fill the transaxle to  
the proper level. It takes only 0.6 liters  
(1.27 US pt) for CVT to raise the level  
from “LOW” to “FULL.  
WARNING  
Failure to follow the guidelines below  
can result in personal injury or seri-  
ous damage to the brake system.  
• If the brake fluid in the reservoir  
drops below a certain level, the  
brake warning light on the instru-  
ment panel will come on (the  
engine must be running with the  
parking brake fully disengaged.)  
Should the light come on, immedi-  
ately ask your SUZUKI dealer to  
inspect the brake system.  
CAUTION  
After checking or adding oil, be sure  
to insert the dipstick securely.  
80J004  
Check the brake fluid level by looking at  
the reservoir in the engine compartment.  
Check that the fluid level is between the  
“MAX” and “MIN” lines. If the brake fluid  
level is near the “MIN” line, fill it up to the  
“MAX” line with SAE J1703 or DOT3 brake  
fluid.  
Deterioration Checking or Chang-  
ing Oil  
Since special procedures, materials and  
tools are required to check the deteriora-  
tion of CVT oil or change, it is recom-  
mended that you trust this job to your  
authorized SUZUKI dealer.  
• A rapid fluid loss indicates a leak in  
the brake system which should be  
inspected by your SUZUKI dealer  
immediately.  
• Brake fluid can harm your eyes and  
damage painted surfaces. Use cau-  
tion when refilling the reservoir.  
(Continued)  
7-21  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
NOTE:  
measured above is less than the minimum  
distance required, have your vehicle  
inspected by your SUZUKI dealer.  
With disc brakes, the fluid level can be  
expected to gradually fall as the brake  
pads wear.  
WARNING  
(Continued)  
• Do not use any fluid other than SAE  
J1703 or DOT3 brake fluid. Do not  
use reclaimed fluid or fluid that has  
been stored in old or open contain-  
ers. It is essential that foreign parti-  
cles and other liquids are kept out  
of the brake fluid reservoir.  
NOTE:  
When measuring the distance between the  
brake pedal and floor wall, be sure not to  
include the floor mat or rubber on the floor  
wall in your measurement.  
Brake Pedal  
WARNING  
Brake fluid is harmful or fatal if swal-  
lowed, and harmful if it comes in con-  
tact with skin or eyes. If swallowed,  
do not induce vomiting. Immediately  
contact a poison control center or a  
physician. If brake fluid gets in eyes,  
flush eyes with water and seek medi-  
cal attention. Wash thoroughly after  
handling. Solution can be poisonous  
to animals. Keep out of the reach of  
children and animals.  
“a”  
Floor carpet  
65D345  
Pedal to floor carpet minimum distance  
“a”  
60G104  
40 mm (1.6 in.)  
CAUTION  
With the engine running and the parking  
brake set, measure the distance between  
the brake pedal and floor carpet when the  
pedal is depressed with approximately 300  
N (66 lbs, 30 kg) of force. The minimum  
distance required is as specified. Since  
your vehicle’s brake system is self-adjust-  
ing, there is no need for pedal adjustment.  
If the pedal to floor carpet distance as  
The brake fluid should be replaced  
according to the maintenance sched-  
ule. Have the brake fluid replaced by  
your SUZUKI dealer.  
7-22  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
WARNING  
Parking Brake Lever  
Steering Wheel  
If you experience any of the following  
problems with your vehicle’s brake  
system, have the vehicle inspected  
immediately by your SUZUKI dealer.  
• Poor braking performance  
• Uneven braking (brakes not work-  
ing uniformly on all wheels.)  
• Excessive pedal travel  
EXAMPLE  
200 N (44 lbs, 20 kg)  
“c”  
• Brake dragging  
“b”  
• Excessive noise  
• (Except ABS equipped vehicle)  
Pedal pulsation (pedal pulsates  
when pressed for braking.)  
60A226  
80J005  
Ratchet tooth specification “b”  
4th – 9th  
Steering wheel play “c”  
0 – 30 mm (0.0 – 1.2 in.)  
Check the parking brake for proper adjust-  
ment by counting the number of clicks  
made by the ratchet teeth as you slowly  
pull up on the parking brake lever to the  
point of full engagement. The parking  
brake lever should stop between the speci-  
fied ratchet teeth and the rear wheels  
should be securely locked. If the parking  
brake is not properly adjusted or the  
brakes drag after the lever has been fully  
released, have the parking brake inspected  
and/or adjusted by your SUZUKI dealer.  
Check the play of the steering wheel by  
gently turning it from left to right and mea-  
suring the distance that it moves before  
you feel slight resistance. The play should  
be between the specified values. Check  
that the steering wheel turns easily and  
smoothly without rattling by turning it all the  
way to the right and to the left while driving  
very slowly in an open area. If the amount  
of free play is outside the specification or  
you find anything else to be wrong, an  
inspection must be performed by your  
SUZUKI dealer.  
7-23  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Power Steering (if equipped)  
EXAMPLE  
B. Tire Name/Model  
Tires  
The tire name or model is shown  
here.  
For safe operation of your vehicle, it is  
important that the tires be the correct  
type and size, in good condition, and  
properly inflated. Be sure to follow the  
requirements and recommendations in  
this section.  
C. Tire Size  
The tire size code is a combina-  
tion of letters and numbers used  
to define a particular tire’s width,  
height, aspect ratio, construction  
type, and service description. See  
the “Tire Size” explanation later in  
this section for more details.  
D. U.S. DOT Tire Identification Num-  
ber  
Tire Sidewall Labeling  
Useful information about a tire is  
molded into its sidewall. The example  
below shows a typical passenger car  
tire.  
The Department of Transportation  
(DOT) marking indicates that the  
tire is in compliance with the U.S.  
Department of Transportation  
Motor Vehicle Safety Standards.  
The letters and numbers following  
the DOT marking is the Tire Iden-  
tification Number (TIN). The TIN  
identifies the tire manufacturer  
and plant, tire size, and date the  
tire was manufactured.  
54G225  
Typical Passenger Car Tire Sidewall  
(1) UPPER  
(2) LOWER  
I
C
D
J
Check the steering box case, vane pump  
and hose connections for leaks or damage.  
B
H
Power Steering Fluid  
Check the fluid level by looking at the res-  
ervoir in the engine compartment when the  
fluid is cold (about room temperature).  
G
E. Uniform Tire Quality Grading  
(UTQG)  
A
Check that the fluid level is between the (1)  
and (2) lines. If the fluid level is near the (2)  
line, fill it up to the (1) line with an auto-  
matic transaxle fluid equivalent to ATF  
E
Tire manufacturers are required to  
grade tires based on three perfor-  
mance factors: treadwear, traction  
F
67D027  
®
®
and  
temperature  
resistance.  
DEXRON -II (Esso JWS 2326) or  
A. Tire Manufacturer  
Refer to the “Uniform Tire Quality  
Grading” section for more details.  
DEXRON -III. Do not overfill.  
The name of the tire manufacturer  
is shown here.  
7-24  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
F. Load Rating  
Tire Size  
U
H
V
124 mph  
130 mph  
149 mph  
168 mph*  
186 mph*  
Load rating is the maximum  
weight a tire is designed to sup-  
port in normal service.  
The following illustration shows an  
example of a typical passenger car tire  
size.  
G. Max Inflation Pressure  
Max inflation pressure is the max-  
imum inflation pressure a tire is  
designed for.  
W
Y
H. Tire Ply Material  
These tire markings describe the  
type of cord and number of plies  
in the sidewall and under the  
tread.  
*The letters ZR may be used on tires  
with a maximum speed capability over  
149 mph and will always be used on  
tires with a maximum speed capability  
over 186 mph.  
A
B
C
D
E
I. Load Index and Speed Rating  
The two- or three-digit number is  
the tire’s load index, the maximum  
load a tire can carry at the speed  
indicated by its speed symbol at  
the maximum inflation pressure.  
The higher the number is, the  
greater the load carrying capacity.  
The letter symbol denotes the  
speed at which a tire is designed  
to be driven for extended periods  
of time. (Ratings are listed below.)  
J. M+S Marking  
This marking indicates the tire  
has some mud and snow capabili-  
ties and is designed for all-season  
use.  
67D028  
A. Tire Type  
This letter code indicates the pri-  
mary intended use of the tire. The  
letter “P” identifies a tire primarily  
intended for use on a passenger  
vehicle.  
B. Tire Width  
This three-digit number indicates  
the tire section width in millime-  
ters from sidewall to sidewall.  
C. Aspect Ratio  
Letter Rating  
Speed Rating  
99 mph  
Q
R
S
T
106 mph  
112 mph  
118 mph  
This two-digit number represents  
the tire section height divided by  
the tire section width.  
7-25  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
D. Construction Code  
Tire Inflation Pressure  
• Seating Capacity  
This letter code is used to indicate Tire inflation pressure should be • Maximum  
Allowed  
Combined  
the type of ply construction in the checked when the tire is cold. “Cold  
Weight of Occupants and Cargo  
tire. The letter “R” means radial tire inflation pressure” is the pressure • Original Tire Size  
ply tire construction, the letter “D” in a tire that has been driven less than • Recommended Cold Tire Inflation  
means diagonal or bias ply con- 1 mile (1.6 km) or has been standing  
struction, and the letter “B” means for three hours or more.  
belted-bias ply construction.  
Pressure of Original Tires  
• Size of Compact Spare Tire  
• Recommended Cold Tire Inflation  
Pressure of Compact Spare Tire  
E. Rim Diameter  
This two-digit number is the wheel  
Recommended Cold Tire Inflation  
Pressures  
or rim diameter in inches.  
WARNING  
230 kPa  
Front Tires  
Your SUZUKI is equipped with  
tires which are all the same type  
and size. This is important to  
ensure proper steering and han-  
dling of the vehicle. Never mix  
tires of different size or type on  
the four wheels of your vehicle.  
33 psi  
230 kPa  
Rear Tires  
33 psi  
420 kPa  
Compact Spare Tire  
60 psi  
80JS025  
Mixing tires could cause you to  
lose control while driving which  
may lead to an accident. The size  
and type of tires used should be  
only those approved by SUZUKI  
Motor Corporation as standard or  
optional equipment for your vehi-  
cle.  
The front and rear tire pressure speci-  
fications for your vehicle are shown  
below and are listed on the Tire and  
Loading Information Label, which is  
located on the driver’s door lock pillar.  
The Tire and Loading Information  
Label contains the following informa-  
tion:  
7-26  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
NOTE:  
Measuring Air Pressure  
WARNING  
pressures should  
The tire inflation pressure will change Use the following steps to achieve  
due to changes in atmospheric pres- proper tire inflation:  
• Air  
be  
sure, temperature or tire temperature 1) Identify the recommended tire pres-  
checked when the tires are cold  
or you may get inaccurate read-  
ings.  
when driving. To reduce the chance that  
the low tire pressure warning light will  
come on due to normal changes in tem-  
sure on the vehicle’s Tire and Load-  
ing Information Label or in the  
owner’s manual.  
• Check the inflation pressure  
from time to time while inflating  
the tire gradually, until the spec-  
ified pressure is obtained.  
• Never underinflate or overin-  
flate the tires.  
perature and atmospheric pressure, it is 2) Remove the valve cap from the tire  
important to check and adjust the tire valve stem.  
pressures when the tires are cold. Tires 3) Using a reliable pressure gauge,  
that appear to be at the specified pres-  
sure when checked after driving, when  
the tires are warm, could have pressure  
below the specification when the tires  
cool down. Also, tires that are inflated to  
the specified pressure in a warm  
garage may have pressure below the  
specification when the vehicle is driven  
outside in very cold temperature. If you  
adjust the tire pressure in a garage that  
measure the tire inflation pressure  
by pressing the tire gauge firmly  
onto the valve to get a pressure  
measurement. Remember that  
inflation pressures should be  
checked when the tires are “cold”,  
meaning before they have been  
driven one mile or after sitting for  
three hours or more allowing the tire  
to cool to ambient air temperature.  
Underinflation  
can  
cause  
unusual handling characteristics  
or can cause the rim to slip on  
the tire bead, resulting in an acci-  
dent or damage to the tire or rim.  
Underinflation can also cause  
tires to overheat, leading to tire  
failure.  
is warmer than the outside tempera- 4) If the air pressure is too high, slowly  
Overinflation can cause the tire  
to burst, resulting in personal  
injury.  
Overinflation can also cause  
unusual handling characteristics  
which may result in an accident.  
ture, you should add 1 psi to the recom-  
mended cold tire inflation pressure for  
every 10°F difference between garage  
temperature and outside temperature.  
release the air by pressing on the  
tire valve stem with the edge of the  
tire gauge until you reach the cor-  
rect pressure.  
5) If the air pressure is too low, fill the  
tire with air at a service station until  
it reaches the recommended pres-  
sure.  
6) Make sure all tires have the same  
air pressure (unless the owner’s  
manual indicates otherwise).  
7-27  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
WARNING  
Tire Inspection  
1.6 mm (0.06 in.) or less and the  
tire should be replaced.  
Inspect your vehicle’s tires at least  
once a month by performing the fol- 3) Check for abnormal wear, cracks  
lowing checks:  
1) Measure the air pressure with a tire  
gauge. Adjust the pressure if nec-  
essary. Remember to check the  
spare tire, too. Refer to the “Mea-  
suring Air Pressure” section.  
Your SUZUKI is equipped with  
tires which are all the same type  
and size. This is important to  
ensure proper steering and han-  
dling of the vehicle. Never mix  
tires of different size or type on  
the four wheels of your vehicle.  
The size and type of tires used  
should be only those approved by  
SUZUKI Motor Corporation as  
standard or optional equipment  
for your vehicle.  
and damage. Any tires with cracks  
or other damage should be  
replaced. If any tires show abnor-  
mal wear, have them inspected by  
your SUZUKI dealer.  
WARNING  
Hitting curbs and running over  
rocks can damage tires and affect  
wheel alignment. Be sure to have  
tires  
and  
wheel  
alignment  
checked periodically by your  
SUZUKI dealer.  
CAUTION  
4) Check for loose wheel nuts.  
5) Check that there are no nails,  
stones or other objects sticking into  
the tires.  
For intelligent All Wheel Drive (i-  
AWD) models, replacing a tire  
with one of a different size, or  
using different brands among the  
four tires can result in damage to  
the drive train.  
54G136  
(1) Tread wear indicator  
(2) Indicator location mark  
2) Check that the depth of the tread  
groove is more than 1.6 mm (0.06  
in.). To help you check this, the tires  
have molded-in tread wear indica-  
tors in the grooves. When the indi-  
cators appear on the tread surface,  
the remaining depth of the tread is  
7-28  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
WARNING  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading  
Treadwear  
The U.S. National Highway Traffic The treadwear grade is a comparative  
Safety Administration has developed a rating based on the wear rate of the tire  
grading system for evaluating the per- when tested under controlled condi-  
formance of passenger car tires. The tions on a specified government test  
following information will help you course. For example, a tire graded 150  
understand the grading system, which would wear one and one-half (1 1/2)  
applies to vehicles sold in the U.S. times as well on the government course  
Consult your SUZUKI dealer or tire as a tire graded 100. The relative per-  
retailer for help in choosing the correct formance of tires depends upon the  
Replacing the wheels and tires  
equipped on your vehicle with  
certain combinations of aftermar-  
ket wheels and tires can signifi-  
cantly change the steering and  
handling characteristics of your  
vehicle. Oversized tires may also  
rub against the fender over  
bumps, causing vehicle damage  
or tire failure. Therefore, use only  
those wheel and tire combina-  
tions approved by SUZUKI Motor  
Corporation as standard or  
optional equipment for your vehi-  
cle. For information regarding the  
specified tires, refer to the Tire  
Information Label located on the  
driver’s side door pillar or the  
“SPECIFICATIONS” section.  
replacement tires for your vehicle.  
actual conditions of their use, however  
and may depart significantly from the  
norm due to variations in driving habits,  
service practices and differences in  
road characteristics and climate.  
Quality grades can be found where  
applicable on the tire sidewall between  
tread shoulder and maximum section  
width. For example:  
Traction – AA, A, B, C  
Treadwear 200 Traction AA Tempera-  
ture A  
The traction grades, from highest to  
lowest, are AA, A, B and C. Those  
grades represent the tire’s ability to  
stop on wet pavement as measured  
under controlled conditions on speci-  
fied government test surfaces of  
DOT Quality Grades  
Treadwear  
Traction AA A B C  
Temperature A B C  
All Passenger Car Tires Must Conform asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C  
To Federal Safety Requirements in may have poor traction performance.  
Addition To These Grades  
CAUTION  
Replacing the original tires with  
tires of a different size may result  
in false speedometer or odometer  
readings. Check with your  
SUZUKI dealer before purchas-  
ing replacement tires that differ in  
size from the original tires.  
WARNING  
The traction grade assigned to  
this tire is based on straight-  
ahead braking traction tests, and  
does not include acceleration,  
cornering, hydroplaning or peak  
traction characteristics.  
7-29  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
WARNING  
Temperature – A, B, C  
Tire Rotation  
The temperature grades are A (the  
highest), B and C, representing the  
tire’s resistance to the generation of  
heat and its ability to dissipate heat  
when tested under controlled condi-  
tions on a specified indoor laboratory  
test wheel. Sustained high tempera-  
ture can cause the material of the tire  
to degenerate and reduce tire life, and  
excessive temperature can lead to  
sudden tire failure. The grade C corre-  
sponds to a level of performance  
which all passenger car tires must  
meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle  
Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B  
and A represent higher levels of per-  
formance on the laboratory test wheel  
than the minimum required by law.  
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the  
parts to which it is fastened, can  
make wheel nuts become loose  
after a time. The wheel could  
come off and cause an accident.  
When you change  
a
wheel,  
remove any rust or dirt from  
places where the wheel attaches  
to the vehicle. In an emergency,  
you can use a cloth or a paper  
towel to do this; but be sure to  
use a scraper or wire brush later,  
if you need to, to get all the rust  
or dirt off.  
54G114  
To avoid uneven wear of your tires and  
to prolong their life, rotate the tires as  
illustrated. Tires should be rotated as  
recommended in the periodic mainte-  
nance schedule. After rotation, adjust  
front and rear tire pressures to the  
specification listed on your vehicle’s  
Tire and Loading Information Label.  
WARNING  
The temperature grade for this  
tire is established for a tire that is  
properly inflated and not over-  
loaded. Excessive speed, under-  
inflation or excessive loading,  
either separately or in combina-  
tion, can cause heat buildup and  
possible tire failure.  
7-30  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Compact Spare Tire (if equipped)  
Note that two or more compact spare  
tires should not be used on one vehi-  
cle simultaneously.  
WARNING  
(Continued)  
• The compact spare tire has a  
much shorter tread life than the  
conventional tires on your vehi-  
cle. Replace the tire as soon as  
WARNING  
The compact spare tire and wheel  
are intended for temporary emer-  
gency use only. Continuous use  
of this spare can result in tire fail-  
ure and loss of control. Always  
observe these precautions when  
using this spare:  
Your vehicle will handle differ-  
ently with this temporary spare.  
• Do not exceed 80 km/h (50 mph)  
speed.  
• Replace this spare with a stan-  
dard tire and wheel as soon as  
possible.  
• Use of this spare will reduce  
ground clearance.  
the  
tread  
wear  
indicator  
appears.  
• When replacing the compact  
tire, use a replacement tire with  
the exact same size and con-  
struction.  
54G115  
CAUTION  
(1) Wear indicator  
(2) Indicator location mark  
For intelligent All Wheel Drive (i-  
AWD) models, driving with an  
underinflated compact spare tire  
or over 80 km/h (50 mph) while  
using a compact spare tire can  
result in damage to the drive  
train.  
Your vehicle comes equipped with the  
compact spare tire. The compact  
spare is designed to save space in  
your storage area, and its lighter  
weight makes it easier to install if a flat  
tire occurs. It is only intended for tem-  
porary emergency use, until the con-  
ventional tire can be repaired or  
replaced. The inflation pressure of the  
compact spare tire should be checked  
at least monthly. Use a quality pocket-  
type inflation pressure gauge and set  
at 420 kPa (60 psi). At the same time,  
check that the tire is stored securely. If  
it is not, tighten it.  
• Recommended air pressure for  
this spare is 420 kPa (60 psi).  
• Do not use tire chains on the  
compact spare. If you must use  
tire chains, rearrange the  
wheels so standard tires and  
wheels are fitted to the front  
axle.  
(Continued)  
7-31  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Snow Tires  
GLOSSARY OF TIRE TERMINOL-  
Maximum Inflation Pressure – the max-  
imum cold inflation pressure a tire is  
Your vehicle is equipped with all-sea- OGY  
son tires which are designed for use in Accessory Weight – the combined designed to support in normal service.  
summer and most winter conditions. weight (in excess of those standard  
Maximum Loaded Vehicle Weight –  
For improved traction in severe winter items which may be replaced) of CVT,  
the sum of curb weight, accessory  
conditions, SUZUKI recommends power steering, power brakes, power  
weight, vehicle capacity weight (total  
mounting radial snow tires on all four windows, power seats, radio, and  
load capacity), and production options  
wheels. Snow tires must be the same heater, to the extent that these items  
weight.  
size as the standard tires. Also be sure are available as factory-installed  
to use the tires of the same type and equipment (whether installed or not).  
Normal Occupant Weight – 68 kilo-  
grams times the number of occupants  
specified in the second column of  
Table 1 (shown below).  
brand on all four wheels of your vehi-  
Cold Tire Inflation Pressure – the pres-  
cle.  
sure in a tire that has been driven less  
than 1 mile or has been standing for  
three hours or more.  
Occupant distribution – distribution of  
occupants in a vehicle as specified in  
the third column of Table 1 (shown  
below).  
Curb Weight – the weight of a motor  
vehicle with standard equipment  
including the maximum capacity of  
fuel, oil, and coolant, and, if so Production Options Weight – the com-  
equipped, air conditioning and addi- bined weight of those installed regular  
tional weight optional engine.  
production options weighing over 2.3  
kilograms in excess of those standard  
items which they replace, not previ-  
ously considered in curb weight or  
accessory weight, including heavy  
duty brakes, ride levelers, roof rack,  
heavy duty battery, and special trim.  
Intended Outboard Sidewall – (1) the  
sidewall that contains a whitewall,  
bears white lettering or bears manu-  
facturer, brand, and/or model name  
molding that is higher or deeper than  
the same molding on the other side-  
wall of the tire, or (2) the outward fac- Recommended Inflation Pressure –  
ing sidewall of an asymmetrical tire the cold tire inflation pressure recom-  
that has a particular side that must mended by a manufacturer.  
always face outward when mounted  
Rim – metal support for a tire or tire  
on a vehicle.  
and tube assembly upon which the tire  
beads are seated.  
7-32  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Vehicle Capacity Weight – the rated Vehicle Loading  
GVWR – Maximum permissible overall  
cargo and luggage load plus 68 kilo- Your vehicle was designed for specific weight of the fully loaded vehicle  
grams (150 lbs) times the vehicle’s load capacities. The load capacities of (including all the occupants, accesso-  
designated seating capacity.  
your vehicle are indicated by the ries and cargo plus the trailer tongue  
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR), weight if towing a trailer).  
Vehicle Maximum Load on the Tire –  
the load on an individual tire that is  
determined by distributing to each axle  
its share of the maximum loaded vehi-  
cle weight and dividing by two.  
the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR,  
GAWR – (Front and Rear) Maximum  
front and rear), and the total load  
permissible weight on an individual  
capacity, the seating capacity, and the  
axle.  
cargo load capacity. The GVWR and  
GAWR (front and rear) are listed on Seating Capacity – Maximum number  
Vehicle Normal Load on the Tire – the the Safety Certification Label which is of occupants the vehicle is designed to  
load on an individual tire that is deter- located below the driver’s side door carry.  
mined by distributing to each axle its latch striker. The total load capacity  
NOTE:  
share of the curb weight, accessory and seating capacity are listed on the  
weight, and normal occupant weight Tire and Loading Information Label  
(distributed in accordance with Table 1 which is located below the Safety Cer-  
Even though the number of occupants  
is within the seating capacity, you still  
must make sure that you do not  
exceed the total load capacity of the  
vehicle.  
shown below) and dividing by 2.  
tification Label. The cargo load capac-  
ity can be determined as described  
below.  
TABLE 1 – Occupant Loading and  
Distribution For Vehicle Normal  
Load For Various Designated Seat-  
ing Capacities  
Cargo Load Capacity – Maximum  
weight of cargo and luggage that the  
vehicle can safely carry. Cargo load  
capacity is the difference between the  
total load capacity of the vehicle and  
the total combined weight of all vehicle  
occupants. Refer to “Steps for Deter-  
mining Correct Load Limit” for details  
on how to determine cargo load  
capacity.  
Total Load Capacity – Maximum per-  
missible weight a vehicle can carry  
including the weight of all the occu-  
pants, accessories, cargo, plus trailer  
tongue weight (if towing a trailer).  
Designated Vehicle nor- Occupant  
seating  
mal load,  
distribution  
capacity,  
number of in a nor-  
The weight of any accessories already  
installed on your vehicle at the time of  
purchase, or that you or the dealer  
install after purchase, must be sub-  
tracted from the total load capacity to  
determine how much capacity remains  
available for occupants, cargo, and  
trailer tongue weight (if towing a  
number of occupants mallyloaded  
occupants  
vehicle  
2 through 4  
2
3
2 in front  
2 in front,  
1 in second  
seat  
5 through 10  
7-33  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
trailer). Contact your dealer for further  
information.  
Steps for Determining Correct Load  
Limit  
1) Locate the statement “The com-  
bined weight of occupants and  
cargo should never exceed XXX kg  
or XXX lbs” on your vehicle’s plac-  
ard.  
2) Determine the combined weight of  
the driver and passengers that will  
be riding in your vehicle.  
3) Subtract the combined weight of  
the driver and passengers from  
XXX kg or XXX lbs.  
4) The resulting figure equals the  
available amount of cargo and lug-  
gage load capacity. For example, if  
the “XXX” amount equals 1400 lbs  
and there will be five 150 lb passen-  
gers in your vehicle, the amount of  
available cargo and luggage load  
capacity is 650 lbs (1400 – 750 (5 x  
150) = 650 lbs).  
5) Determine the combined weight of  
luggage and cargo being loaded on  
the vehicle. That weight may not  
safely exceed the available cargo  
and luggage load capacity calcu-  
lated in Step 4.  
6) If your vehicle will be towing a  
trailer, load from your trailer will be  
transferred to your vehicle. Consult  
this manual to determine how this  
reduces the available cargo and lug-  
gage load capacity of your vehicle.  
WARNING  
Never overload your vehicle. Over-  
loading your vehicle can cause  
damage to your tires and lead to  
poor steering and braking which  
can result in an accident. The  
gross vehicle weight (sum of the  
weights of the loaded vehicle,  
driver and passengers) must  
never exceed the Gross Vehicle  
Weight Rating (GVWR) listed on  
the Safety Certification Label. In  
addition, never distribute a load so  
that the weight on either the front  
or rear axle exceeds the Gross  
Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) listed  
on the Safety Certification Label.  
Actual weight of the loaded vehicle  
and actual loads at the front and rear  
axles can only be determined by  
weighing the vehicle using a vehicle  
scale. To measure the weight and  
load, try making your vehicle to a high-  
way weighing station, shipping com-  
pany or inspection station for trucks,  
etc. Compare these weights to the  
GVWR and GAWR (front and rear)  
listed on the Safety Certification Label.  
If the gross vehicle weight or the load  
on either axle exceeds these ratings,  
you must remove enough weight to  
bring the load down to the rated  
capacity.  
WARNING  
• Always distribute cargo evenly.  
• To avoid personal injury or  
damage to your vehicle, always  
secure cargo to prevent it from  
shifting if the vehicle moves  
suddenly.  
• Place heavier objects on the  
floor and as far forward in the  
cargo area as possible. Never  
pile cargo higher than the top of  
the seatbacks.  
7-34  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Vehicle Loading Example  
Determining Compatibility of Tire  
Battery  
As an example, suppose that the Tire and Vehicle Load Limits  
and Loading Information label on your The tires on your vehicle, when they  
vehicle indicates that your vehicle’s are inflated to the recommended tire  
total load capacity is 950 lbs. If you inflation pressure, have a load-carry-  
were to drive your vehicle with one ing capacity that is greater than the  
passenger, and the total combined load that will be on the tires when the  
weight of you and your passenger was vehicle is at its GVWR or GAWR limit.  
350 lbs, then the cargo and luggage Never use replacement tires that have  
capacity of your vehicle would be 600 a load-carrying capacity less than the  
EXAMPLE  
lbs (950 – 350 = 600 lbs).  
original tires on your vehicle. Tire load-  
If you later added 2 more passengers, carrying capacity information is  
having a combined weight of 325 lbs, molded into the tire sidewall typically  
the cargo and luggage capacity of shown as “Max. Load”. Use of replace-  
your vehicle would be reduced from ment tires with a lower load-carrying  
600 lbs to 275 lbs (600 – 325 = 275 capacity than the original tires, or fail-  
lbs). As you can see, as the number ure to keep the tires inflated to recom-  
and combined weight of vehicle occu- mended tire pressure, may reduce the  
pants increase, the vehicle’s cargo GVWR or GAWR limit of your vehicle.  
and luggage capacity decreases.  
60A269  
WARNING  
Batteries produce flammable hydro-  
gen gas. Keep flames and sparks  
away from the battery or an explosion  
may occur. Never smoke when work-  
ing near the battery.  
NOTE:  
Suppose again, that you were to take  
a trip in your vehicle with the same  
three passengers described above,  
and you decided to tow a trailer having  
a trailer tongue weight of 75 lbs. The  
cargo and luggage capacity would be  
reduced again, to 200 lbs (275 – 75 =  
200 lbs).  
Use of replacement tires with a higher  
load-carrying capacity than the origi-  
nal tires, or using a tire inflation pres-  
sure higher than the recommended  
tire inflation pressure, will not increase  
the GVWR or GAWR limit of your vehi-  
cle.  
WARNING  
When checking or servicing the bat-  
tery, disconnect the negative cable.  
Be careful not to cause a short circuit  
by allowing metal objects to contact  
the battery posts and the vehicle at  
the same time.  
7-35  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Fuses in the Engine Compartment  
Fuses  
WARNING  
Your vehicle has three types of fuses, as  
described below:  
To avoid harm to yourself or damage  
to your vehicle or battery, follow the  
jump starting instructions in the  
“EMERGENCY SERVICE” section of  
this manual if it is necessary to jump  
start your vehicle.  
Main Fuse – The main fuse takes current  
directly from the battery.  
(1)  
(2)  
(3)  
Primary Fuses – These fuses are between  
the main fuse and individual fuses, and are  
for electrical load groups.  
Individual Fuses – These fuses are for indi-  
vidual electrical circuits.  
WARNING  
Battery posts, terminals and related  
accessories contain lead and lead  
compounds. Wash hands after han-  
dling.  
For details on protected circuits, refer to  
the “Fuses and Protected Circuits” section  
in this manual.  
80J051  
To remove a fuse, use the fuse puller pro-  
vided in the fuse box.  
Your vehicle is equipped with a battery that  
requires infrequent maintenance. You will  
never have to add water. You should, how-  
ever, periodically check the battery, battery  
terminals and battery hold-down bracket  
for corrosion. Remove corrosion using a  
stiff brush and ammonia mixed with water,  
or baking soda mixed with water. After  
removing corrosion, rinse with clean water.  
(4) (5) (6) (7) (8)  
(12) (13) (14) (15)  
(9) (10) (11)  
(16) (17) (18) (19)  
(30)  
(20)  
(23)  
(21)  
(24)  
(22)  
(25)  
(26)  
(27)  
(29)  
(28)  
The test indicator on the top of the battery  
provides information on the condition of  
the battery.  
If your vehicle is not going to be driven for  
a month or longer, disconnect the cable  
from the negative terminal of the battery to  
help prevent discharge.  
80J052  
63J095  
7-36  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
(20)  
(21)  
(22)  
(23)  
(24)  
(25)  
(26)  
(27)  
(28)  
(29)  
(30)  
Automatic transaxle relay  
Air compressor relay  
Fuel pump relay  
MAIN FUSE / PRIMARY FUSE  
(1)  
80A All electric load  
Power window, Ignition,  
Wiper, Starter  
(2)  
50A  
OK  
Condenser fan relay  
Front fog light relay  
Throttle motor relay  
FI MAIN relay  
Tail light, Rear defogger,  
50A Door lock, Hazard/Horn,  
Dome  
(3)  
BLOWN  
(4)  
(5)  
Blank  
Blank  
Starting motor relay  
Radiator fan relay  
Radiator fan relay 2  
Radiator fan relay 3  
(6)  
15A Head light (Right) fuse  
15A Head light (Left) fuse  
20A Front fog light fuse  
60A243  
(7)  
WARNING  
(8)  
If the main fuse or a primary fuse  
blows, be sure to have your vehicle  
inspected by an authorized SUZUKI  
dealer. Always use a genuine SUZUKI  
replacement. Never use a substitute  
such as a wire even for a temporary  
fix, or extensive electrical damage  
and a fire can result.  
(9)  
Blank  
The main fuse, primary fuses and some of  
the individual fuses are located in the  
engine compartment. If the main fuse  
blows, no electrical component will func-  
tion. If a primary fuse blows, no electrical  
component in the corresponding load  
group will function. When replacing the  
main fuse, a primary fuse or an individual  
fuse, use a genuine SUZUKI replacement.  
To remove a fuse, use the fuse puller pro-  
vided in the fuse box. The amperage of  
each fuse is shown in the back of the fuse  
box cover.  
(10)  
(11)  
(12)  
(13)  
(14)  
(15)  
(16)  
(17)  
(18)  
(19)  
40A ABS motor fuse  
30A Radiator fan fuse  
30A ABS solenoid fuse  
30A Starting motor fuse  
50A Ignition switch fuse  
30A Blower fan fuse  
NOTE:  
Make sure that the fuse box always carries  
spare fuses.  
20A Air compressor fuse  
15A Throttle motor fuse  
15A Automatic transaxle fuse  
15A Fuel injection fuse  
7-37  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Fuses under the Dash Board  
(21)  
(22)  
(23)  
30A Rear defogger  
15A Horn / Hazard  
MAIN FUSE / PRIMARY FUSE  
(1)  
(2)  
15A Rear wiper  
15A Ignition coil  
10A Back-up light  
10A Meter  
Blank  
(3)  
SX4 SEDAN  
(4)  
(21)  
(5)  
15A Accessory  
15A Accessory 2  
30A Power window  
30A Wiper  
(24)  
(6)  
(7)  
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6)  
(8) (9) (10) (11) (12)(13) (14) (15) (16)  
(17) (18) (19) (20) (22) (23)  
(7)  
(8)  
79J093  
(9)  
10A IG1 SIG  
SX4  
(10)  
(11)  
(12)  
(13)  
(14)  
(15)  
(16)  
(17)  
(18)  
(19)  
(20)  
15A Air bag  
10A Anti-lock brake system  
15A 4WD  
80JC003  
10A Stop light  
20A Door lock  
10A Rear fog light  
10A ST SIG  
(7)  
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6)  
MAIN FUSE / PRIMARY FUSE  
(8) (9) (10) (11) (12)(13) (14) (15) (16)  
(17) (18) (19) (20)(21) (22) (23)  
(1)  
(2)  
(3)  
(4)  
(5)  
(6)  
(7)  
15A Rear wiper  
15A Ignition coil  
10A Back-up light  
10A Meter  
15A Seat heater  
10A IG 2 SIG  
10A Tail light  
80J053  
15A Accessory  
15A Accessory 2  
30A Power window  
15A Dome  
7-38  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Headlight Aiming  
(8)  
30A Wiper  
Since special procedures are required, we  
recommend you take your vehicle to your  
SUZUKI dealer for headlight alignment.  
(9)  
10A IG1 SIG  
(10)  
(11)  
(12)  
(13)  
(14)  
(15)  
(16)  
(17)  
(18)  
(19)  
(20)  
(21)  
(22)  
(23)  
(24)  
15A Air bag  
10A Anti-lock brake system  
Blank  
10A Stop light  
20A Door lock  
10A Rear fog light  
10A ST SIG  
OK  
BLOWN  
65D046  
15A Seat heater  
10A IG 2 SIG  
10A Tail light  
WARNING  
Always be sure to replace a blown  
fuse with a fuse of the correct amper-  
age. Never use a substitute such as  
aluminum foil or wire to replace a  
blown fuse. If you replace a fuse and  
the new one blows in a short period  
of time, you may have a major electri-  
cal problem. Have your vehicle  
inspected immediately by your  
SUZUKI dealer.  
15A Dome  
30A Rear defogger  
15A Horn / Hazard  
Blank  
30A Rear defogger  
The fuses are also located under the  
driver’s side of the dashboard. Remove the  
fuse box cover by pulling it off. The amper-  
age of each fuse is shown on the top of the  
fuse box cover.  
7-39  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Spot light  
Center Interior Light (if equipped)  
Bulb Replacement  
WARNING  
• Light bulbs can be hot enough to  
burn your finger right after being  
turned off. This is true especially  
for halogen headlight bulbs.  
Replace the bulbs after they  
become cool enough.  
• The headlight bulbs are filled with  
pressurized halogen gas. They can  
burst and injure you if they are hit  
or dropped. Handle them carefully.  
80JM068  
60G115  
CAUTION  
Pull down the lens by using a flat blade  
screwdriver covered with a soft cloth as  
shown. To install it, simply push it back in.  
Pull down the lens by using a flat blade  
screwdriver covered with a soft cloth as  
shown. To install it, simply push it back in.  
The oils from your skin may cause a  
halogen bulb to overheat and burst  
when the lights are on. Grasp a new  
bulb with a clean cloth.  
The bulb can be removed by simply pulling  
it out. When replacing the bulb, make sure  
that the contact springs are holding the  
bulb securely.  
CAUTION  
Frequent replacement of a bulb indi-  
cates the need for an inspection of  
the electrical system. This should be  
carried out by your SUZUKI dealer.  
NOTE:  
If it is difficult to replace headlight bulbs or  
position light bulbs due to under-hood  
components trust this job to your dealer.  
7-40  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Headlights  
Bulb  
EXAMPLE  
Other General Lights  
Bulb holder  
EXAMPLE  
(1)  
(2)  
(1)  
(1)  
(3)  
(4)  
(2)  
(1)  
(2)  
54G124  
(2)  
(3) Removal  
54G123  
(4) Installation  
(1) Removal  
(2) Installation  
There are two types of bulb, “Full glass  
type” (1) and “Glass/metal type” (2).  
To remove a bulb holder from a light hous-  
ing, turn the holder counterclockwise and  
pull it out. To install the holder, push the  
holder in and turn it clockwise.  
To remove and install a full glass type bulb  
(1), simply pull out or push in the bulb.  
To remove a glass metal type bulb (2) from  
a bulb holder, push in the bulb and turn it  
counterclockwise. To install a new bulb,  
push it in and turn it clockwise.  
You can access the individual bulb or bulb  
holders as follows.  
80J2084  
Open the engine food. Disconnect the cou-  
pler (1). Then remove the socket cover (2)  
and replace the bulb. Install a new bulb in  
the reverse order of removal.  
7-41  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
EXAMPLE  
Front turn signal light (1)  
Front position light (2)  
Front fog light (if equipped)  
1) Start the engine. Turn the steering  
wheel to the opposite side of the replac-  
ing fog light to replace the bulb easily.  
Then turn off the engine.  
(1)  
(2)  
EXAMPLE  
(1)  
(3)  
(2)  
80JM115  
3) Remove the bolts (3).  
80JM123  
80JM114  
2) Insert a flat blade screwdriver into the  
hole (2) and remove the clips (1) by  
twist the driver as shown in the illustra-  
tion.  
7-42  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
SX4  
5) Remove the front fog light. Turn the  
bulb holder counterclockwise and  
remove it.  
Rear combination light  
(tail, stop, turn signal, etc.)  
(4)  
SX4  
SX4 SEDAN  
EXAMPLE  
(5)  
80JM116  
4) Open the fender cover. Disconnect the  
coupler by pushing the lock release.  
Pinch both side of the clips (4) and (5),  
and push them in.  
80JM131  
SX4 SEDAN  
80JM071  
4) Open the fender cover. Disconnect the  
coupler with pushing the lock release.  
Turn the bulb holder counterclockwise  
and remove it.  
(1)  
(2)  
80JM072  
80JM117  
7-43  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
To open the trim (1), insert a flat blade  
screwdriver between the trim and the clips  
(2) and remove the clips by twist the driver  
as shown in the illustration.  
License plate light  
SX4  
To open the trim (1), insert a flat blade  
screwdriver into the hole (3) and remove  
the clips (2) by twist the driver as shown in  
the illustration.  
80JM079  
SX4 SEDAN  
80JM073  
80JM075  
(3)  
(1)  
(2)  
80JM074  
7-44  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Luggage compartment light (SX4)  
High-mount stop light (if equipped)  
SX4  
(2)  
(1)  
63J127  
79J015  
2) Close the tailgate. Remove a high-  
mounted stop light housing (2) from the  
tailgate.  
Trunk room light (SX4 SEDAN)  
80J100  
To remove a high-mounted stop light hous-  
ing the following procedure:  
1) Open the tailgate, and remove the nuts  
(1) as shown in the illustration.  
56KN004  
7-45  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
SX4 SEDAN  
Wiper Blades  
(3)  
(4)  
(3)  
80JM076  
3) Pushing the unguiform prongs (3)  
toward inside and remove the bulb  
holder (4).  
80G083  
If the wiper blades become brittle or dam-  
aged, or make streaks when wiping,  
replace the wiper blades.  
4) Replace the bulbs.  
To install a high-mounted stop light  
housing in the reverse order of removal.  
(1)  
To install new wiper blades, follow the pro-  
cedures below.  
CAUTION  
To avoid scratching or breaking the  
window, do not let the wiper arm  
strike the window while replacing the  
wiper blade.  
80JM132  
To remove the high-mounted stop light  
housing, pinch both side of the clip (1) and  
push it in.  
NOTE:  
Some wiper blades may be different from  
the ones described here depending on  
vehicle specifications. If so, consult your  
SUZUKI dealer for proper replacement  
method.  
7-46  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
For windshield wipers and some rear  
wipers:  
52D102  
60A260  
2) Squeeze lock lever (1) towards wiper  
arm (2) and remove the wiper frame  
from the arm as shown.  
3) Pull the locked end of the wiper blade  
firmly to unlock the blade and slide the  
blade out as shown.  
70G119  
1) Hold the wiper arm away from the win-  
dow.  
NOTE:  
When raising both of the front wiper arms,  
pull the driver’s side wiper arm up first.  
When returning the wiper arms, lower the  
passenger’s side wiper arm first. Other-  
wise, the wiper arms may interfere with  
each other.  
7-47  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Installation  
To remove some types of rear wiper  
frame from the wiper arm:  
1) Hold the arm away from the window.  
52D124  
52D125  
(3) Retainer  
(4) Locked end  
4) If the new blade is provided without the  
two metal retainers, move them from  
the old blade to the new one.  
5) Install the new blade in the reverse  
order of removal, with the locked end  
positioned toward the wiper arm. Make  
sure the blade is properly retained by  
all the hooks. Grasp the blade near the  
locked end and pull in the direction of  
the arrows to lock the end into place.  
6) Reinstall wiper frame to arm, making  
sure that the lock lever is snapped  
securely into the arm.  
80G146  
2) Remove the wiper frame from the arm  
as shown.  
7-48  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
3) When reinstalling wiper frame to arm,  
install the wiper frame in the reverse  
order of removal.  
Installation  
To remove and install some types of  
rear wiper blade from and to the wiper  
frame.  
To remove and install some types of  
rear wiper blade from and to the wiper  
frame.  
Removal  
60A265  
2) Install the new blade in the reverse  
order of removal. Make sure that the  
blade is properly retained by all the  
hooks and the end is locked in place.  
65D151  
1) Flex the ends of blade and frame, and  
slide the blade out as shown.  
But do not flex the frame end more than  
necessary.  
If you do, it can break off.  
52D104  
2) Install the new blade in the reverse  
order of removal. Make sure that the  
blade is properly retained by all the  
hooks and both ends are in place.  
1) Flex the locked end of blade (3) away  
from retainer (4) to unlock it and slide  
the blade out as shown.  
7-49  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
Check that there is washer fluid in the tank  
by looking at the washer fluid level gauge  
which is attached to the cap of the washer  
fluid tank. If the fluid level is near “E” mark,  
refill it.  
Use a good quality windshield washer  
fluid, diluted with water as necessary.  
Windshield Washer Fluid  
Air Conditioning System  
If you do not use the air conditioner for a  
long period, such as during winter, it may  
not give the best performance when you  
start using it again. To help maintain opti-  
mum performance and durability of your air  
conditioner, it needs to be run periodically.  
Operate the air conditioner at least once a  
month for one minute with the engine  
idling. This circulates the refrigerant and oil  
and helps protect the internal components.  
WARNING  
Do not use “anti-freeze” solution in  
the windshield washer reservoir. This  
can severely impair visibility when  
sprayed on the windshield, and also  
damage your vehicle’s paint.  
(or opposite side)  
80JM078  
CAUTION  
Damage may result if the washer  
motor is operated with no fluid in the  
washer tank.  
80J008  
7-50  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE  
MEMO  
7-51  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
EMERGENCY SERVICE  
EMERGENCY SERVICE  
Tire Changing Tool ............................................................. 8-1  
Jacking Instructions ........................................................... 8-2  
Changing Wheels ................................................................ 8-4  
Jump Starting Instructions ................................................ 8-5  
Towing a Disabled Vehicle ................................................. 8-6  
If the Starter Does Not Operate .......................................... 8-6  
If the Engine is Flooded ...................................................... 8-7  
If the Engine Overheats ...................................................... 8-7  
8
60G411  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Loading: 11  
EMERGENCY SERVICE  
SX4  
Tire Changing Tool  
SX4  
EXAMPLE  
(1)  
80J048  
79J086  
To remove the spare tire, turn its bolt (1)  
counterclockwise and remove it.  
80JC014  
SX4 SEDAN  
SX4 SEDAN  
EXAMPLE  
EXAMPLE  
80JC015  
79J085  
80JC045  
To stow the jack, place it in the storage  
bracket and turn the shaft clockwise until  
the jack is securely held in place.  
To remove the jack, turn its shaft counter-  
clockwise and pull the jack out of the stor-  
age bracket.  
The jack, wheel brace, jack handle are  
stowed in the luggage compartment.  
8-1  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Trailer Towing: 5, 11, 13  
Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing): 13  
EMERGENCY SERVICE  
4) Block the front and rear of the wheel  
diagonally opposite of the wheel being  
lifted.  
5) Place the spare wheel near the wheel  
being lifted as shown in the illustration  
in case that the jack slips.  
Jacking Instructions  
WARNING  
The jack should be used only to  
change wheels. It is important to read  
the jacking instructions in this sec-  
tion before attempting to use the  
jack.  
WARNING  
After using the jack, jack handle and  
wheel wrench, be sure to stow them  
securely or they can cause injury if  
an accident occurs.  
75F062  
1) Place the vehicle on level, hard ground.  
2) Set the parking brake firmly and shift  
into “P” (Park) if your vehicle has a CVT,  
or shift into “R” (Reverse) if your vehicle  
has a manual transaxle.  
54G253  
WARNING  
• Be sure to shift into “P” (Park) for a  
CVT vehicle, or into “R” (Reverse)  
for  
a
manual transaxle vehicle  
when you jack up the vehicle.  
• Never jack up the vehicle with the  
transaxle in “N” (Neutral). Other-  
wise, an unstable jack may cause  
an accident.  
3) Turn on the hazard warning flasher if  
your vehicle is near traffic.  
8-2  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing): 13  
EMERGENCY SERVICE  
Front wheel  
WARNING  
• Use the jack only to change wheels  
on level, hard ground.  
• Never jack up the vehicle on an  
inclined surface.  
• Never raise the vehicle with the  
jack in a location other than the  
specified jacking point (shown in  
the illustration) near the wheel to  
be changed.  
front  
• Make sure that the jack is raised at  
least 51 mm (2 inches) before it  
contacts the flange. Use of the jack  
when it is within 51 mm (2 inches)  
of being fully collapsed may result  
in failure of the jack.  
80J085  
80J086  
6) Position the jack at an angle as shown  
in the illustration and raise the jack by  
turning the jack handle clockwise until  
the jack-head groove fits around the  
jacking bar beneath the vehicle body.  
7) Continue to raise the jack slowly and  
smoothly until the tire clears the  
ground. Do not raise the vehicle more  
than necessary.  
Rear wheel  
• Never get under the vehicle when it  
is supported by the jack.  
• Never run the engine when the  
vehicle is supported by the jack  
and never allow passengers to  
remain in the vehicle.  
80J087  
8-3  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing): 13  
EMERGENCY SERVICE  
Full Wheel Cover (if equipped)  
EXAMPLE  
Changing Wheels  
To change a wheel, use the following pro-  
cedure:  
1) Remove the jack, tools and spare wheel  
from the vehicle.  
2) Loosen, but do not remove the wheel  
nuts.  
3) Jack up the vehicle (follow the jacking  
instructions in this section).  
WARNING  
• Be sure to shift into “P” (Park) in  
CVT, or shift into “R” (Reverse) in  
manual transaxle when you jack up  
the vehicle.  
81A057  
60G309  
• Never jack up the vehicle with the  
transaxle in “N” (Neutral). Other-  
wise, unstable jack may cause an  
accident.  
Wheel tightening torque  
85 Nm (61.5 lb-ft, 8.5 kg-m)  
(1) or (2) Flat end tool  
Your vehicle includes two tools, a wheel  
brace and a jack crank, one of which has a  
flat end.  
Use the tool with the flat end to remove the  
full wheel cap, as shown above.  
7) Lower the jack and fully tighten the nuts  
in a crisscross fashion with a wrench as  
shown in the illustration.  
4) Remove the wheel nuts and wheel.  
5) Before installing the new wheel, clean  
any mud or dirt off from the surface of  
the wheel and hub with a clean cloth.  
Clean the hub carefully; it may be hot  
from driving.  
6) Install the new wheel and replace the  
wheel nuts with their cone shaped end  
facing the wheel. Tighten each nut  
snugly by hand until the wheel is  
securely seated on the hub.  
WARNING  
EXAMPLE  
Use genuine wheel nuts and tighten  
them to the specified torque as soon  
as possible after changing wheels.  
Incorrect wheel nuts or improperly  
tightened wheel nuts may come  
loose or fall off, which can result in  
an accident. If you do not have a  
torque wrench, have the wheel nut  
torque checked by an authorized  
SUZUKI dealer.  
54G117  
When installing the cover, make sure that it  
is positioned so that it does not cover or  
foul the air valve.  
8-4  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
EMERGENCY SERVICE  
2) Turn off all vehicle accessories, except  
those necessary for safety reasons (for  
example, headlights or hazard lights).  
Jump Starting Instructions  
CAUTION  
WARNING  
Your vehicle should not be started by  
pushing or towing. This starting  
method could result in permanent  
damage to the catalytic converter.  
Use jumper cables to start a vehicle  
with a weak or run-down battery.  
• Never attempt to jump start your  
vehicle if the battery appears to be  
frozen. Batteries in this condition  
may explode or rupture if jump  
starting is attempted.  
• When making jumper cable con-  
nections, be certain that your  
hands and the jumper cables  
remain clear from pulleys, belts or  
fans.  
When jump starting your vehicle, use  
the following procedure:  
(1)  
12V BATTERY  
(3)  
• Batteries  
produce  
flammable  
hydrogen gas. Keep flames and  
sparks away from the battery or an  
explosion may occur. Never smoke  
when working near the battery.  
• If the booster battery you use for  
jump starting is installed in another  
vehicle, make sure the two vehicles  
are not touching each other.  
• If your battery discharges repeat-  
edly, for no apparent reason, have  
your vehicle inspected by an autho-  
rized SUZUKI dealer.  
• To avoid harm to yourself or dam-  
age to your vehicle or battery, fol-  
low the jump starting instructions  
below precisely and in order. If you  
are in doubt, call for qualified road  
service.  
(2)  
EXAMPLE  
54G079  
3) Make jumper cable connections as fol-  
lows:  
1. Connect one end of the first jumper  
cable to the positive (+) terminal of  
the discharged battery (1).  
2. Connect the other end to the positive  
(+) terminal of the booster battery  
(2).  
3. Connect one end of the second  
jumper cable to the negative (–) ter-  
minal of the booster battery (2).  
4. Make the final connection to an  
unpainted, heavy metal part (i.e.  
engine hook (3)) of the engine of the  
vehicle with the discharged battery  
(1).  
60A269  
1) Use only a 12-volt battery to jump start  
your vehicle. Position the good 12-volt  
battery close to your vehicle so that the  
jumper cables will reach both batteries.  
When using a battery installed on  
another vehicle, DO NOT LET THE  
VEHICLES TOUCH. Set the parking  
brakes fully on both vehicles.  
8-5  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
EMERGENCY SERVICE  
Towing a Disabled Vehicle  
If the Starter Does Not  
Operate  
WARNING  
Emergency Towing  
Never connect the jumper cable  
directly to the negative (–) terminal of  
the discharged battery, or an explo-  
sion may occur.  
1) Try turning the ignition switch to the  
“START” position with the headlights  
turned on to determine the battery con-  
dition. If the headlights go excessively  
dim or go off, it usually means that  
either the battery has run down or bat-  
tery terminal contact is poor. Recharge  
the battery or correct battery terminal  
contact if necessary.  
If your vehicle is disabled, it may be towed  
by a tow truck using one of the following  
methods:  
1) Tow the vehicle with two wheels lifted  
by the tow truck and the other two  
wheels on a towing dolly.  
4) If the booster battery you are using is  
installed on another vehicle, start the  
engine of the vehicle with the booster  
battery. Run the engine at moderate  
speed.  
5) Start the engine of the vehicle with the  
discharged battery.  
6) Remove the jumper cables in the exact  
reverse order in which you connected  
them.  
2) Use the appropriate towing method  
specified for your vehicle in the “Towing  
Your Vehicle (recreational towing)” sec-  
tion, but with the wheels lifted by the  
tow truck instead of on a towing dolly.  
Be sure to carefully follow the specific  
instructions provided in the “Towing  
Your Vehicle (recreational towing)” sec-  
tion.  
2) If the headlights remain bright, check  
the fuses. If the reason for failure of the  
starter is not obvious, there may be a  
major electrical problem. Have the vehi-  
cle inspected by your authorized  
SUZUKI dealer.  
CAUTION  
If vehicle damage (such as steering  
or drivetrain damage, etc.) prevents  
normal use of the towing procedures  
for your vehicle described in the  
“Towing Your Vehicle (recreational  
towing)” section, have your vehicle  
towed with two wheels lifted by the  
tow truck and the other two wheels  
on a towing dolly.  
8-6  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
EMERGENCY SERVICE  
If the temperature indication does not  
come down to within the normal, accept-  
able range:  
If the Engine is Flooded  
If the Engine Overheats  
If the engine is flooded with gasoline, it  
may be hard to start. If this happens, press  
the accelerator pedal all the way to the  
floor and hold it there while cranking the  
engine. (Do not operate the starter motor  
for more than 15 seconds).  
The engine could overheat temporarily  
under severe driving conditions. If the  
engine coolant temperature gauge indi-  
cates overheating during driving:  
1) Turn off the engine and check that the  
water pump belt and pulleys are not  
damaged or slipping. If any abnormality  
is found, correct it.  
2) Check the coolant level in the reservoir.  
If it is found to be lower than the “LOW”  
line, look for leaks at the radiator, water  
pump and radiator and heater hoses. If  
you locate any leaks that may have  
caused the overheating, do not run the  
engine until these problems have been  
corrected.  
3) If you do not find a leak, carefully add  
coolant to the reservoir and then the  
radiator, if necessary. (Refer to “Engine  
Coolant” in the “INSPECTION AND  
MAINTENANCE” section.)  
1) Turn off the air conditioner, if equipped.  
2) Take the vehicle to a safe place and  
park.  
3) Let the engine run at normal idle speed  
for a few minutes until the indicator is  
within the normal, acceptable tempera-  
ture range shown by the white band  
between “H” and “C”.  
WARNING  
If you see or hear escaping steam,  
stop the vehicle in a safe place and  
immediately turn off the engine to let  
it cool. Do not open the hood when  
steam is present. When the steam  
can no longer be seen or heard, open  
the hood to see if the coolant is still  
boiling. If it is, you must wait until it  
stops boiling before you proceed.  
Also, be careful not to touch hot  
engine parts (radiator, water hoses,  
engine etc.).  
8-7  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
EMERGENCY SERVICE  
65D614  
WARNING  
• It is hazardous to remove the radia-  
tor cap when the water temperature  
is high, because scalding fluid and  
steam may be blown out under  
pressure. The cap should only be  
taken off when the coolant temper-  
ature has lowered.  
• To prevent personal injury, keep  
hands, tools and clothing away  
from the engine cooling fan and air-  
conditioner fan (if equipped). These  
electric fans can automatically turn  
on without warning.  
8-8  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
EMERGENCY SERVICE  
MEMO  
8-9  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
APPEARANCE CARE  
APPEARANCE CARE  
Corrosion Prevention ......................................................... 9-1  
Vehicle Cleaning ................................................................. 9-3  
9
60G412  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
APPEARANCE CARE  
vehicle which are not well ventilated to  
permit quick drying.  
If you frequently drive on salted roads, your  
vehicle should be washed at least once a  
month during the winter. If you live near the  
ocean, your vehicle should be washed at  
least once a month throughout the year.  
Corrosion Prevention  
It is important to take good care of your  
vehicle to protect it from corrosion.  
Listed below are instructions for how to  
maintain your vehicle to prevent corrosion.  
Please read and follow these instructions  
carefully.  
For washing instructions, refer to the “Vehi-  
cle Cleaning” section.  
Remove foreign material deposits  
Important Information About  
Corrosion  
Foreign material such as salts, chemicals,  
road oil or tar, tree sap, bird droppings and  
industrial fall-out may damage the finish of  
your vehicle if it is left on painted surfaces.  
Remove these types of deposits as quickly  
as possible. If these deposits are difficult to  
wash off, an additional cleaner may be  
required. Be sure that any cleaner you use  
is not harmful to painted surfaces and is  
specifically intended for your purposes.  
Follow the manufacturer’s directions when  
using these special cleaners.  
Common causes of corrosion  
1) Accumulation of road salt, dirt, moisture  
or chemicals in hard-to-reach areas of  
the vehicle underbody or frame.  
2) Chipping, scratches and any damage to  
treated or painted metal surfaces  
resulting from minor accidents or  
impact from stones and gravel.  
52D151  
This information illustrates the necessity of  
keeping your vehicle (particularly the  
underbody) as clean and dry as possible. It  
is equally important to repair any damage  
to the paint or protective coatings as soon  
as possible.  
Environmental conditions which accel-  
erate corrosion  
1) Road salt, dust control chemicals, sea  
air or industrial pollution will all acceler-  
ate the corrosion of metal.  
2) High humidity will increase the rate of  
corrosion particularly when the temper-  
ature range is just above the freezing  
point.  
3) Moisture in certain areas of a vehicle  
for an extended period of time may pro-  
mote corrosion even though other body  
sections may be completely dry.  
Repair finish damage  
Carefully examine your vehicle for damage  
to the painted surfaces, especially if it is  
used off-road. Should you find any chips or  
scratches in the paint, touch them up  
immediately to prevent corrosion from  
starting. If the chips or scratches have  
gone through to the bare metal, have a  
qualified body shop make the repair.  
How to Help Prevent Corrosion  
Wash your vehicle frequently  
The best way to preserve the finish on your  
vehicle and to help avoid corrosion is to  
keep it clean with frequent washing.  
Wash your vehicle at least once during the  
winter and once immediately after the win-  
ter. Keep your vehicle, particularly the  
underside, as clean and dry as possible.  
4) High temperatures will cause an accel-  
erated rate of corrosion to parts of the  
9-1  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Schedule: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10  
APPEARANCE CARE  
Keep passenger and cargo compart-  
ments clean  
Cover your vehicle  
WARNING  
Moisture, dirt or mud can accumulate  
under the floor mats and may cause corro-  
sion. Occasionally, check under these  
mats to ensure that this area is clean and  
dry. More frequent checks are necessary if  
the vehicle is used off road or in wet  
weather.  
Do not apply additional undercoating  
or rust preventive coating on or  
around exhaust system components  
such as the catalytic converter,  
exhaust pipes, etc. A fire could be  
started if the undercoating substance  
becomes overheated.  
Certain cargo such as chemicals, fertiliz-  
ers, cleaners, salts, etc. are extremely cor-  
rosive by nature. These products should  
be transported in sealed containers. If a  
spill or leak does occur, clean and dry the  
area immediately.  
50G203  
If you cannot regularly park your vehicle in  
a garage, we recommend you use a vehi-  
cle cover. Years of exposure to midday sun  
can cause the colors in paint, plastic parts  
and fabrics to fade. Covering your vehicle  
with a high-quality, breathable” vehicle  
cover can help protect the finish from the  
harmful UV rays in sunlight, and can  
reduce the amount of dust and air pollution  
reaching the surface. Your SUZUKI dealer  
can help you select the right cover for your  
vehicle.  
Use the body trim  
The use of the body trim will help protect  
your vehicle, especially if you frequently  
drive on gravel or salted roads. The fittings  
for such guards should also be corrosion  
resistant. Please check with your autho-  
rized SUZUKI dealer for information on  
these guards.  
Store your vehicle in a dry, well-venti-  
lated area  
Do not park your vehicle in a damp, poorly  
ventilated area. If you often wash your  
vehicle in the garage or if you frequently  
drive it in when wet, your garage may be  
damp. The high humidity in the garage  
may cause or accelerate corrosion. A wet  
vehicle may corrode even in a heated  
garage if the ventilation is poor.  
9-2  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Periodic Maintenance Schedule: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10  
APPEARANCE CARE  
damp cloth to remove dirt and the soap  
solution. If some dirt still remains on the  
surface, repeat this procedure.  
Vinyl floor mats  
Vehicle Cleaning  
Ordinary dirt can be removed from vinyl  
with water or mild soap. Use a brush to  
help loosen dirt. After dirt is loosened,  
rinse the mat thoroughly with water and  
dry it in the shade.  
Fabric upholstery  
Remove loose dirt with a vacuum cleaner.  
Using a mild soap solution, rub stained  
areas with a clean damp cloth. To remove  
soap, rub the areas again with a cloth  
dampened with water. Repeat this until the  
stain is removed, or use a commercial fab-  
ric cleaner for tougher stains. If you use a  
fabric cleaner, carefully follow the manu-  
facturer’s instructions and precautions.  
Carpets  
Remove dirt and soil as much as possible  
with a vacuum cleaner. Using a mild soap  
solution, rub stained areas with a clean  
damp cloth. To remove soap, rub the areas  
again with a cloth dampened with water.  
Repeat this until the stain is removed, or  
use  
a
commercial carpet cleaner for  
Leather upholstery  
tougher stains. If you use a carpet cleaner,  
carefully follow the manufacturer’s instruc-  
tions and precautions.  
76G044S  
Remove loose dirt with a vacuum cleaner.  
Using a mild soap or saddle soap solution,  
wipe dirt off with a clean damp soft cloth.  
To remove soap, wipe the areas again with  
a soft cloth dampened with water. Wipe the  
areas dry with a soft dry cloth. Repeat this  
until the dirt or stain is removed, or use a  
commercial leather cleaner for tougher dirt  
or stains. If you use a leather cleaner, care-  
fully follow the manufacture’s instructions  
and precautions. Do not use solvent type  
cleaners or abrasive cleaners.  
WARNING  
Cleaning the Exterior  
CAUTION  
When cleaning the interior or exterior  
of the vehicle, NEVER USE flammable  
solvents such lacquer thinners, gas-  
oline, benzene or cleaning materials  
such as bleaches and strong house-  
hold detergents. The materials could  
cause personal injury or damage to  
the vehicle.  
It is important that your vehicle be  
kept clean and free from dirt. Failure  
to keep your vehicle clean may result  
in fading of the paint or corrosion to  
various parts of the vehicle body.  
Cleaning Interior  
Seat belts  
Clean seat belts with a mild soap and  
water. Do not use bleach or dye on the  
belts. They may weaken the fabric in the  
belts.  
Vinyl upholstery  
Prepare a solution of soap or mild deter-  
gent mixed with warm water. Apply the  
solution to the vinyl with a sponge or soft  
cloth and let it soak for a few minutes to  
loosen dirt. Rub the surface with a clean,  
9-3  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Periodic Maintenance Schedule: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10  
APPEARANCE CARE  
2) Rinse the body to loosen the dirt.  
6) Check carefully for damage to painted  
surfaces. If there is any damage,  
“touch-up” the damage following the  
procedure below:  
Washing  
Remove dirt and mud from the body  
exterior with running water. You may  
use a soft sponge or brush. Do not use  
hard materials which can scratch the  
paint or plastic. Remember that the  
headlight covers or lenses are made of  
plastic in many cases.  
WARNING  
• Never attempt to wash and wax  
your vehicle with the engine run-  
ning.  
• When cleaning the underside of the  
body and fender, where there may  
be sharp-edged parts, you should  
wear gloves and a long-sleeved  
shirt to protect your hands and  
arms from being cut.  
• After washing your vehicle, care-  
fully test the brakes before driving  
to make sure they have maintained  
their normal effectiveness.  
1. Clean all damaged spots and allow  
them to dry.  
2. Stir the paint and “touch-up” the  
damaged spots lightly using a small  
brush.  
3. Allow the paint to dry completely.  
CAUTION  
To avoid damage to the paint or plas-  
tic surface, do not wipe the dirt off  
without ample water. Be sure to fol-  
low above procedure.  
CAUTION  
If you use an automatic car wash,  
make sure that your vehicle’s body  
parts, such as spoilers, cannot be  
damaged. If you are in doubt, consult  
the car wash operator for advice.  
3) Wash the entire exterior with a mild  
detergent or car wash soap using a  
sponge or soft cloth. The sponge or  
cloth should be frequently soaked in the  
soap solution.  
When washing the vehicle, follow the  
instructions below:  
1) Flush the underside of body and wheel  
housings with pressurized water to  
remove mud and debris. Use plenty of  
water.  
CAUTION  
When using a commercial car wash  
product, observe the cautions speci-  
fied by the manufacturer. Never use  
strong household detergents or  
soaps.  
CAUTION  
• When washing the vehicle, avoid  
directing steam or hot water of  
more than 80°C (176°F) on plastic  
parts.  
• To avoid damaging engine compo-  
nents, do not use pressurized  
water in the engine compartment.  
4) Once the dirt has been completely  
removed, rinse off the detergent with  
running water.  
5) After rinsing, wipe off the vehicle body  
with a wet chamois or cloth and allow it  
to dry in the shade.  
9-4  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Recommended under Severe Driving Condi-  
tions: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10  
APPEARANCE CARE  
Waxing  
60B211S  
After washing the vehicle, waxing and pol-  
ishing are recommended to further protect  
and beautify the paint.  
• Only use waxes and polishes of good  
quality.  
• When using waxes and polishes,  
observe the precautions specified by the  
manufacturers.  
9-5  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GENERAL INFORMATION  
GENERAL INFORMATION  
Identification Numbers ....................................................... 10-1  
Safety Certification Label ................................................... 10-2  
Emission Compliance Label (for U.S.A.) ........................... 10-2  
Warranties ............................................................................ 10-2  
On-Board Vehicle Computers and Event Data  
Recorders ............................................................................ 10-3  
Reporting Safety Defects ................................................... 10-4  
54G072  
10  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Jacking Instructions: 5  
GENERAL INFORMATION  
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)  
may be found in the location shown in the  
above illustrations. This number is used to  
register the vehicle. It is also used to assist  
your dealer when ordering parts or refer-  
ring to special service information.  
Engine Serial Number  
Identification Numbers  
Vehicle Identification Number  
EXAMPLE (for some vehicles)  
60G128  
The engine serial number is stamped on  
the cylinder block as shown in the above  
illustration.  
80JC090  
79J019  
10-1  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Jacking Instructions: 5  
GENERAL INFORMATION  
Safety Certification Label  
Emission Compliance Label  
(for U.S.A.)  
Warranties  
The warranties covering your vehicle are  
explained in a separate New Vehicle War-  
ranty Information booklet given to you at  
the time of sale. Please read this booklet  
carefully so you can understand your rights  
and responsibilities.  
EXAMPLE  
For U.S.A.  
The following warranties are provided with  
your vehicle:  
• New Vehicle Limited Warranty  
• Limited Warranty For SUZUKI Parts or  
Accessories  
• Emission Components Defect Warranty  
• Emission Performance Warranty  
52D059  
This label contains important safety-  
related information about your vehicle. The  
label is located on the driver’s door lock pil-  
lar.  
60A412  
The EPA emission compliance label is  
located under the hood.  
10-2  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Jacking Instructions: 5  
GENERAL INFORMATION  
operation of the vehicle. This stored In addition, once SUZUKI collects or  
information can assist technicians in receives data, SUZUKI may use the  
repairing the vehicle when malfunc- data for research conducted by  
tions occur. Other information is stored SUZUKI, make the data available for  
only in the event of crash, by computer outside research if need is shown and  
systems that are commonly called confidentiality is assured, or make  
On-Board Vehicle Computers  
and Event Data Recorders  
Your vehicle is equipped with on-board  
computer systems which monitor and  
control several aspects of vehicle per-  
formance, including the following:  
• Emission-related components and  
engine parameters such as engine  
speed and throttle position are moni-  
tored to provide emissions control  
and to provide optimum fuel econ-  
omy. Your vehicle also has an on-  
board diagnostic system which mon-  
itors and records information about  
emission-related malfunctions.  
Event Data Recorders (EDRs).  
summary data which does not identify  
specific vehicles available for outside  
research.  
In a crash event, EDRs such as the  
Airbag Sensing and Diagnostic Mod-  
ule (SDM) in your vehicle may record Others, such as law enforcement per-  
information about the condition of the sonnel, may have access to the spe-  
vehicle and how it was operated, such cial equipment that can read the  
as data related to airbag readiness, information if they have access to the  
airbag performance, safety belt usage, vehicle or storage device.  
and the severity of the collision. These  
data can help provide a better under-  
• Signals from various sensors are  
monitored to provide air bag deploy-  
ment.  
standing of the circumstances in which  
crashes and injuries occur and lead to  
the designing of safer vehicles. The  
• If your vehicle is equipped with  
antilock brakes, conditions such as  
vehicle speed and brake perfor-  
mance are monitored, so that the  
ABS system can provide effective  
antilock braking. If your vehicle has  
an Electronic Stability Program  
SDM in your vehicle does not collect  
or store personal information.  
To read the stored information, special  
equipment is needed and access to  
the vehicle or storage device is  
required. SUZUKI will not access infor-  
mation about a crash event or share it  
with others other than with the consent  
of the vehicle owner or lessee, in  
response to an official request from  
the police or similar government office,  
as part of SUZUKI’s defense of litiga-  
tion through the discovery process, or  
as required by law.  
®
(ESP ) system, conditions such as  
yaw rate, lateral acceleration, and  
brake fluid pressure are monitored,  
®
so that the ESP system can help  
the driver control the vehicle in diffi-  
cult driving situations.  
Some information may be stored by  
the on-board computers during normal  
10-3  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Jacking Instructions: 5  
Jump Starting Instructions: 7  
GENERAL INFORMATION  
To contact American Suzuki, owners  
in the continental United States can  
call toll-free 1-800-934-0934, or write  
to:  
Reporting Safety Defects  
If you believe that your vehicle has a  
defect which could cause a crash or  
could cause injury or death, you  
should  
immediately  
inform  
the  
American Suzuki Motor Corporation  
Automotive Customer Relations  
3251 East Imperial Highway  
Brea, CA 92821-6795  
National Highway Traffic Safety  
Administration (NHTSA) in addition to  
notifying American Suzuki Motor Corp.  
If NHTSA receives similar complaints,  
it may open an investigation, and if it  
finds that a safety defect exists in a  
group of vehicles, it may order a recall  
and remedy campaign. However,  
NHTSA cannot become involved in  
individual problems between you, your  
dealer, or American Suzuki Motor  
Corp.  
For owners outside the continental  
United States, please refer to the dis-  
tributor’s address listed in your War-  
ranty Information booklet.  
For vehicles registered for use and  
principally operated in Canada please  
contact Suzuki Canada Inc. at 1-905-  
889-2677 extension 2254 or write to:  
Suzuki Canada Inc.  
Customer Relations  
100 East Beaver Creek Road  
Richmond Hill, On  
L4B 1J6  
To contact NHTSA, you may call the  
Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-  
888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153);  
go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write  
to: Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 New  
Jersey Ave., SE., Washington, D.C.  
20590. You can also obtain other infor-  
mation about motor vehicle safety  
from http://www.safercar.gov.  
10-4  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Jump Starting Instructions: 7  
Towing a Disabled Vehicle: 6  
GENERAL INFORMATION  
MEMO  
10-5  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuses and Protected Circuits: 7  
FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS  
FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS  
(4) (5) (6) (7) (8)  
(12) (13) (14) (15)  
(9) (10) (11)  
(1)  
(2)  
(3)  
(16) (17) (18) (19)  
(30)  
(20)  
(23)  
(21)  
(24)  
(22)  
(25)  
(26)  
(27)  
(29)  
(28)  
80J101  
COLOR/SIZE (AMPS)  
BLACK (80)  
RED (50)  
RED (50)  
PROTECTED CIRCUIT  
(1)  
(2)  
(3)  
(4)  
(5)  
(6)  
(7)  
(8)  
(9)  
(10)  
All electric load  
Power window, Ignition, Wiper, Starter  
Tail light, Rear defogger, Door lock, Hazard/Horn, Dome  
Blank  
11  
In engine  
compartment  
MAIN  
FUSE  
BOX  
Blank  
BLUE (15)  
BLUE (15)  
YELLOW (20)  
Head light (Right) fuse  
Head light (Left) fuse  
Front fog light fuse  
Blank  
GREEN (40)  
ABS motor fuse  
11-1  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuses and Protected Circuits: 7  
FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS  
(4) (5) (6) (7) (8)  
(12) (13) (14) (15)  
(9) (10) (11)  
(1)  
(2)  
(3)  
(16) (17) (18) (19)  
(30)  
(20)  
(23)  
(21)  
(24)  
(22)  
(25)  
(26)  
(27)  
(29)  
(28)  
80J101  
COLOR/SIZE (AMPS)  
PROTECTED CIRCUIT  
(11)  
(12)  
(13)  
(14)  
(15)  
(16)  
(17)  
(18)  
(19)  
(20)  
PINK (30)  
PINK (30)  
PINK (30)  
RED (50)  
PINK (30)  
YELLOW (20)  
BLUE (15)  
BLUE (15)  
BLUE (15)  
Radiator fan fuse  
ABS solenoid fuse  
Starting motor fuse  
Ignition switch fuse  
Blower fan fuse  
In engine  
compartment  
MAIN  
FUSE  
BOX  
Air compressor fuse  
Throttle motor fuse  
Automatic transaxle fuse  
Fuel injection fuse  
Automatic transaxle relay  
11-2  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuses and Protected Circuits: 7  
FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS  
(4) (5) (6) (7) (8)  
(12) (13) (14) (15)  
(9) (10) (11)  
(1)  
(2)  
(3)  
(16) (17) (18) (19)  
(30)  
(20)  
(23)  
(21)  
(24)  
(22)  
(25)  
(26)  
(27)  
(29)  
(28)  
80J101  
COLOR/SIZE (AMPS)  
PROTECTED CIRCUIT  
(21)  
(22)  
(23)  
(24)  
(25)  
(26)  
(27)  
(28)  
(29)  
(30)  
Air compressor relay  
Fuel pump relay  
Condensor fan relay  
Front fog light relay  
Throttle motor relay  
FI MAIN relay  
In engine  
compartment  
MAIN  
FUSE  
BOX  
Starting motor relay  
Radiator fan relay  
Radiator fan relay 2  
Radiator fan relay 3  
11-3  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuses and Protected Circuits: 7  
FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS  
SX4  
(7)  
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6)  
(8) (9) (10) (11) (12)(13) (14) (15) (16)  
(17) (18) (19) (20)(21) (22) (23)  
80J053  
COLOR/SIZE (AMPS)  
FUSE NAME  
PROTECTED CIRCUIT  
(1)  
(2)  
BLUE (15)  
BLUE (15)  
RED (10)  
RED (10)  
BLUE (15)  
BLUE (15)  
PINK (30)  
GREEN (30)  
RED (10)  
BLUE (15)  
RED (10)  
RR WIP  
IG COIL  
BACK  
MTR  
Rear wiper  
Ignition coil  
Back-up light  
Meter  
(3)  
(4)  
(5)  
ACC  
Accessory  
Accessory 2  
Power window  
Wiper  
Under the  
dashboard  
FUSE  
BOX  
(6)  
ACC2  
P/W  
(7)  
(8)  
WIP  
(9)  
IG1 SIG  
A/B  
IG1 SIG  
(10)  
(11)  
Air bag  
ABS  
Anti-lock brake system  
11-4  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS  
(7)  
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6)  
(8) (9) (10) (11) (12)(13) (14) (15) (16)  
(17) (18) (19) (20)(21) (22) (23)  
80J053  
COLOR/SIZE (AMPS)  
BLUE (15)  
RED (10)  
FUSE NAME  
PROTECTED CIRCUIT  
(12)  
(13)  
(14)  
(15)  
(16)  
(17)  
(18)  
(19)  
(20)  
(21)  
(22)  
(23)  
4WD  
4WD  
STOP  
D/L  
Stop light  
Door lock  
Rear fog light  
ST SIG  
YELLOW (20)  
RED (10)  
RR FOG  
ST SIG  
S/H  
RED (10)  
Under the  
dashboard  
BLUE (15)  
RED (10)  
Seat heater  
IG2 SIG  
FUSE  
BOX  
IG2 SIG  
TAIL  
RED (10)  
Tail light  
BLUE (15)  
GREEN (30)  
BLUE (15)  
DOME  
RR DEF  
HORN HAZ  
Dome  
Rear defogger  
Horn/Hazard  
Blank  
11-5  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS  
SX4 SEDAN  
(21)  
(24)  
(7)  
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6)  
(8) (9) (10) (11) (12)(13) (14) (15) (16)  
(17) (18) (19) (20) (22) (23)  
80JC003  
COLOR/SIZE (AMPS)  
FUSE NAME  
RR WIP  
PROTECTED CIRCUIT  
(1)  
(2)  
BLUE (15)  
BLUE (15)  
RED (10)  
RED (10)  
BLUE (15)  
BLUE (15)  
PINK (30)  
GREEN (30)  
RED (10)  
BLUE (15)  
RED (10)  
Rear wiper  
IG COIL  
BACK  
MTR  
ACC  
ACC2  
P/W  
Ignition coil  
Back-up light  
Meter  
(3)  
(4)  
(5)  
Accessory  
Accessory 2  
Power window  
Wiper  
Under the  
dashboard  
(6)  
FUSE  
BOX  
(7)  
(8)  
WIP  
(9)  
IG1 SIG  
A/B  
IG1 SIG  
(10)  
(11)  
(12)  
Air bag  
ABS  
Anti-lock brake system  
Blank  
11-6  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS  
(21)  
(24)  
(7)  
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6)  
(8) (9) (10) (11) (12)(13) (14) (15) (16)  
(17) (18) (19) (20) (22) (23)  
80JC003  
COLOR/SIZE (AMPS)  
RED (10)  
FUSE NAME  
STOP  
PROTECTED CIRCUIT  
(13)  
(14)  
(15)  
(16)  
(17)  
(18)  
(19)  
(20)  
(21)  
(22)  
(23)  
(24)  
Stop light  
Door lock  
YELLOW (20)  
RED (10)  
D/L  
RR FOG  
ST SIG  
S/H  
Rear fog light  
ST SIG  
RED (10)  
BLUE (15)  
RED (10)  
Seat heater  
IG2 SIG  
Under the  
dashboard  
IG2 SIG  
TAIL  
FUSE  
BOX  
RED (10)  
Tail light  
BLUE (15)  
GREEN (30)  
BLUE (15)  
DOME  
RR DEF  
HORN HAZ  
Dome  
Rear defogger  
Horn/Hazard  
Blank  
GREEN (30)  
RR DEF  
Rear defogger  
11-7  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS  
MEMO  
11-8  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifications: 1, 2, 5, 6, 7, 10, 11  
SPECIFICATIONS  
SPECIFICATIONS  
NOTE:  
Specifications are subject to change with-  
out notice.  
M/T: Manual transaxle  
CVT: Continuously variable transaxle  
2WD: 2-wheel drive  
i-AWD: intelligent All Wheel Drive  
ITEM: Dimensions  
Overall length  
Overall width  
UNIT: mm (in.)  
SX4  
SX4 SEDAN  
4115 – 4135 (162.0 – 162.8)  
1730 – 1755 (68.1 – 69.1)  
1575 (62.0)  
4490 – 4510 (176.8 – 177.6)  
1730 (68.1)  
Overall height  
195 tire  
205 tire  
1545 (60.8)  
1605 (63.2)  
1545 (60.8)  
Wheelbase  
Track  
2500 (98.4)  
I
Front  
1500 (59.1)  
I
I
Rear  
1495 (58.9)  
Ground clearance  
195 tire  
205 tire  
165 (6.5)  
I
175 (6.9)  
160 (6.3)  
ITEM: Weight  
Gross axle weight rating  
Gross vehicle weight rating  
Vehicle capacity weight  
See the safety certification label and the tire information label which  
are located on the driver’s door lock pillar.  
12  
12-1  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifications: 1, 2, 5, 6, 7, 10, 11  
SPECIFICATIONS  
ITEM: Engine  
Type  
J20B (16V DOHC)  
4
Number of cylinders  
Bore  
84.0 mm (3.31 in.)  
90.0 mm (3.54 in.)  
Stroke  
3
Piston displacement  
Compression ratio  
1995 cm (1995cc, 121.7 cu.in)  
10.2 : 1  
ITEM: Electrical  
Ignition timing  
Standard spark plug  
Battery  
3° – 17° B.T.D.C. at idle speed  
NGK SILFR5A11  
DELKOR 24-700 12V  
Fuses  
See “INSPECTION AND MAINTENANCE” and “FUSES AND PRO-  
TECTED CIRCUITS” sections.  
12-2  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifications: 1, 2, 5, 6, 7, 10, 11  
SPECIFICATIONS  
ITEM: Light  
WATTAGE  
12V 65/55W  
12V 55W  
12V 21W  
12V 21W  
12V 5W  
BULB No.  
HB5  
Headlight  
Front fog light  
H11  
Front turn signal light  
Rear turn signal light  
Position light  
WY21W  
WY21W  
168  
Brake/tail light  
12V 21/5W  
12V 5W  
W21/5W  
W5W  
W21W  
License plate light  
Reversing light  
Dome light  
12V 21W  
12V 10W  
12V 5W  
Luggage compartment light  
Spot light  
12V 8W  
High mount stop light  
SX4  
12V 5W  
W5W  
W16W  
168  
SX4 SEDAN  
12V18W  
12V 5W  
Side marker light  
12-3  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Specifications: 1, 2, 5, 6, 7, 10, 11  
SPECIFICATIONS  
ITEM: Wheel  
Tire size, front and rear  
SX4  
P195/65R15, P205/60R16, P205/50R17  
P195/65R15, P205/50R17  
SX4 SEDAN  
Tire pressure  
For the specified tire pressure, see the Tire Information Label located  
on the driver’s door lock pillar.  
ITEM: Steering  
Toe  
IN 1.0 1.0 mm (0.0393 0.0393 in.)  
Camber angle  
P195/65R15, P205/60R16  
P205/50R17  
–0° 10’ 1°  
–0° 17’ 1°  
3° 40’ 2°  
3° 46’ 2°  
Caster angle  
P195/65R15, P205/60R16  
P205/50R17  
ITEM: Capacities  
Coolant (including reserve tank)  
M/T  
7.1 L (15.0 US pt)  
CVT  
2WD  
i-AWD  
7.0 L (14.8 US pt)  
Fuel tank  
50 L (13.2 US gal)  
45 L (11.9 US gal)  
Engine oil (replaced with filter)  
Transaxle oil  
4.5 L (4.7 quarts)  
Manual transaxle: 2.5 L (5.3 US pt)  
CVT: 9.44 L (19.9 US pt) (when overhauling)  
0.8 L (1.7 US pt)  
Rear differential oil  
Transfer gear box oil  
0.6 L (1.2 US pt)  
12-4  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
Brake Assist System............................................................3-21  
Brake Fluid............................................................................7-21  
Brake Pedal....................................................................3-8, 7-22  
Brake System Warning Light ..............................................2-61  
Brakes ...................................................................................7-21  
Braking..................................................................................3-20  
Break-In...................................................................................4-1  
Bulb Replacement................................................................7-40  
C
Catalytic Converter ................................................................4-1  
Changing Engine Oil and Filter...........................................7-12  
Changing Wheels...................................................................8-4  
Charging Light......................................................................2-64  
Child Lock System (rear doors)............................................2-3  
Child Restraint Systems......................................................2-36  
Cigarette Lighter and Ashtray.............................................5-47  
Clock .....................................................................................2-75  
Clutch Pedal ..................................................................3-8, 7-19  
Compact Spare Tire .............................................................7-31  
Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT).............................3-11  
Continuously Variable Transaxle (CVT) Fluid ...................7-20  
Coolant Level Check............................................................7-15  
Coolant Replacement ..........................................................7-16  
Corrosion Prevention ............................................................9-1  
Cruise Control ......................................................................3-18  
Cup Holder and Storage Area.............................................5-49  
D
INDEX  
Symbols  
“CRUISE” Indicator Light.................................................... 2-66  
“ESP OFF” Indicator Light......................................... 2-63, 3-25  
“ESP” (Electronic Stability Program) Warning Light ....... 2-63  
“ESP” Warning Light........................................................... 3-25  
“SET” Indicator Light .......................................................... 2-66  
A
Accelerator Pedal .................................................................. 3-8  
Accessory Socket................................................................ 5-47  
Adding Coolant.................................................................... 7-15  
Adjusting Seat Position ...................................................... 2-21  
Adjusting Seatbacks ........................................................... 2-22  
AIR BAG Light...................................................................... 2-65  
Air Cleaner............................................................................ 7-16  
Air Conditioning System..................................................... 7-50  
All Seat Belts........................................................................ 2-31  
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) .......................................... 3-21  
Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Warning Light ................. 2-62  
Anti-Lock Braking System (ABS)....................................... 3-24  
Armrest................................................................................. 5-51  
Assist Grips.......................................................................... 5-48  
Audio Systems..................................................................... 5-15  
Automatic Heating and Air Conditioning System  
(Climate Control).................................................................... 5-9  
Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)................................... 2-30  
Average fuel consumption.................................................. 2-72  
B
Basic Operations ................................................................. 5-18  
Battery .................................................................................. 7-35  
13  
Daily Inspection Checklist.....................................................3-1  
Daytime Running Light (D.R.L.) Indicator Light................2-68  
Daytime Running Light (D.R.L.) System ............................2-76  
Door Locks .............................................................................2-1  
13-1  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
Drive Belt.............................................................................. 7-11  
Driver’s Seat Belt Reminder Light...................................... 2-64  
Driving on Hills ...................................................................... 4-3  
Driving on Slippery Roads.................................................... 4-4  
Driving range........................................................................ 2-72  
E
FUSES AND PROTECTED CIRCUITS .................................11-1  
Fuses in the Engine Compartment.....................................7-36  
Fuses under the Dash Board ..............................................7-38  
G
Gasoline Containing MTBE...................................................1-1  
Gasoline/Ethanol blends .......................................................1-1  
Gasoline/Methanol blends.....................................................1-1  
Gear Oil .................................................................................7-18  
Gear Oil Level Check ...........................................................7-19  
Gear Oil Replacement..........................................................7-19  
GLOSSARY OF TIRE TERMINOLOGY................................7-32  
Glove Box .............................................................................5-49  
H
Hazard Warning Switch .......................................................2-78  
Head Restraints...........................................................2-22, 2-24  
Headlight Aiming..................................................................7-39  
Heated Rear Window and Heated Outside Rearview  
Mirrors Switch ......................................................................2-81  
Heating and Air Conditioning System..................................5-1  
Heating System ......................................................................5-2  
High Beam Indicator Light ..................................................2-67  
Highway Driving.....................................................................4-3  
Horn.......................................................................................2-81  
How the ABS Works.............................................................3-23  
I
Identification Numbers ........................................................10-1  
If the Engine is Flooded.........................................................8-7  
If the Engine Overheats.........................................................8-7  
If the Starter Does Not Operate.............................................8-6  
If You Cannot Shift CVT Gearshift Lever Out of  
®
Electronic Stability Program (ESP ).................................. 3-23  
Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR)................................. 2-30  
Emission Compliance Label (for U.S.A.) ........................... 10-2  
Engine Block Heater.............................................................. 3-9  
Engine Coolant .................................................................... 7-14  
Engine Hood......................................................................... 5-44  
Engine Oil and Filter............................................................ 7-11  
Engine Serial Number ......................................................... 10-1  
Exhaust Gas Warning............................................................ 3-1  
F
Floor Mats............................................................................. 5-51  
Fluid Level Check ................................................................ 7-20  
Folding Rear Seats .............................................................. 2-26  
Frame Hooks........................................................................ 5-56  
Front Air Bags...................................................................... 2-49  
Front Fog Light Switch........................................................ 2-77  
Front Seat Back Pocket....................................................... 5-50  
Front Seat Heater................................................................. 2-23  
Front Seats........................................................................... 2-21  
Fuel Filler Cap...................................................................... 5-43  
Fuel Gauge ........................................................................... 2-69  
Fuel Pump Labeling............................................................... 1-1  
Fuel Recommendation .......................................................... 1-1  
Full Wheel Cover.................................................................... 8-4  
Fuses .................................................................................... 7-36  
“P” (PARK)............................................................................3-15  
13-2  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
If Your Vehicle Gets Stuck.................................................... 4-4  
Ignition Key Reminder........................................................... 2-1  
Ignition Switch ....................................................................... 3-2  
Illumination control setting................................................. 2-74  
Illumination Indicator Light................................................. 2-67  
Improving Fuel Economy...................................................... 4-2  
Information display.............................................................. 2-70  
Inside Rearview Mirror ........................................................ 2-19  
Installation of Child Restraint with Top Strap................... 2-44  
Installation with Lap-Shoulder Seat Belts  
(child restraint with no top strap)....................................... 2-38  
Installation with the LATCH System .................................. 2-40  
Instantaneous Fuel Consumption...................................... 2-70  
Instrument Cluster............................................................... 2-59  
intelligent All Wheel Drive (i-AWD) AUTO Indicator  
Light...................................................................................... 2-67  
intelligent All Wheel Drive (i-AWD) LOCK Indicator  
Light...................................................................................... 2-68  
Interior Light Switch............................................................ 5-45  
J
Jacking Instructions.............................................................. 8-2  
Jump Starting Instructions................................................... 8-5  
K
Keyless Entry System Transmitter .................................... 2-13  
Keyless Start System Indicator Light ................................ 2-66  
Keyless Start System Remote Controller............................ 2-6  
Keys ........................................................................................ 2-1  
L
Lights “On” reminder ..........................................................2-76  
Listening to a CD..................................................................5-22  
Listening to a CD from an External CD Changer  
(Option) .................................................................................5-34  
Listening to a XM Satellite Radio (Option).........................5-31  
Listening to Audio for AUX (Option) ..................................5-33  
Listening to the Radio .........................................................5-20  
Low Fuel Warning Light ......................................................2-66  
Low Tire Pressure Warning Light..............................2-60, 3-26  
Luggage Compartment Board ............................................5-53  
Luggage Compartment Cover.............................................5-52  
Luggage Compartment Light..............................................5-46  
M
Maintenance Recommended under Severe Driving  
Conditions ..............................................................................7-7  
Maintenance Schedule ..........................................................7-2  
Malfunction Indicator Light.................................................2-65  
Manual Heating and Air Conditioning System ....................5-5  
Manual Transaxle.................................................................3-10  
Mirrors...................................................................................2-19  
O
Odometer ..............................................................................2-74  
Oil Level Check ....................................................................7-11  
Oil Pressure Light ................................................................2-64  
On-Board Vehicle Computers and Event Data  
Recorders .............................................................................10-3  
Open Door Warning Light ...................................................2-66  
Outside Rearview Mirrors....................................................2-20  
P
Lap-Shoulder Belt................................................................ 2-30  
Lighting Control Lever ........................................................ 2-75  
Lighting Operation............................................................... 2-76  
Parking Brake Lever .....................................................3-6, 7-23  
Pedals......................................................................................3-7  
13-3  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
Periodic Maintenance Schedule........................................... 7-3  
Power Door Locking System................................................ 2-2  
Power Mirror Control........................................................... 2-20  
Power Steering..................................................................... 7-24  
Power Steering Fluid........................................................... 7-24  
Power Window Controls ..................................................... 2-17  
Power-Assisted Brakes....................................................... 3-21  
R
Radio Antenna ..................................................................... 5-15  
Rear Seats ............................................................................ 2-24  
Rear Window Wiper/Washer Switch .................................. 2-80  
Refill with Oil and Check for Leaks.................................... 7-14  
Refilling................................................................................. 7-12  
Remote Audio Controls....................................................... 5-37  
Replace the Oil Filter........................................................... 7-13  
Replacing Tires and/or Wheels .......................................... 3-29  
Reporting Safety Defects.................................................... 10-4  
Roof Rails or Roof Rack Anchors...................................... 5-55  
S
Safety Certification Label.................................................... 10-2  
Seat Adjustment .................................................................. 2-21  
Seat Belt Extender............................................................... 2-45  
Seat Belt Hanger.................................................................. 2-34  
Seat Belt Inspection ............................................................ 2-35  
Seat Belt Pretensioner System........................................... 2-46  
Seat Belt Reminder.............................................................. 2-32  
Seat Belts and Child Restraint Systems............................ 2-28  
Selection of Coolant............................................................ 7-14  
Shopping Hook .................................................................... 5-51  
Shoulder Anchor Height Adjuster...................................... 2-34  
Side Air Bags and Side Curtain Air Bags.......................... 2-50  
Side Door Locks.....................................................................2-1  
SLIP Indicator Light ....................................................2-62, 3-25  
Snow Tires............................................................................7-32  
Spark Plugs ..........................................................................7-16  
SPECIFICATIONS.................................................................12-1  
Specified Fluid......................................................................7-20  
Specified Gear Oil ................................................................7-18  
Specified Oil .........................................................................7-11  
Speedometer ........................................................................2-68  
Spot Light .............................................................................5-47  
Stability Control System......................................................3-24  
Starting the Engine ................................................................3-8  
Steering Wheel .....................................................................7-23  
Sun Visor ..............................................................................5-45  
Supplemental Restraint System (air bags)........................2-47  
T
Tachometer...........................................................................2-69  
Tailgate....................................................................................2-3  
Temperature Gauge .............................................................2-70  
Theft Deterrent Light............................................................2-17  
Thermometer ........................................................................2-73  
Tilt Steering Lock Lever ......................................................2-81  
Tire Chains..............................................................................4-5  
Tire Changing Tool ................................................................8-1  
Tire Inflation Pressure .........................................................7-26  
Tire Inspection......................................................................7-28  
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) .........................3-26  
Tire Rotation.........................................................................7-30  
Tire Sidewall Labeling .........................................................7-24  
Tire Size ................................................................................7-25  
Tires.......................................................................................7-24  
13-4  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
Towing a Disabled Vehicle.................................................... 8-6  
Towing Your Vehicle (recreational towing)......................... 6-2  
Traction Control System..................................................... 3-24  
Trailer Towing ........................................................................ 6-2  
Transaxle selector position indicator................................ 2-73  
Trip meter ............................................................................. 2-72  
Troubleshooting .................................................................. 5-41  
Trunk Lid ................................................................................ 2-4  
Trunk Light........................................................................... 5-46  
Turn Signal Control Lever................................................... 2-77  
Turn Signal Indicators......................................................... 2-67  
Turn Signal Operation......................................................... 2-77  
U
Windshield Wiper and Washer Lever.................................2-78  
Windshield Wipers...............................................................2-79  
Wiper Blades ........................................................................7-46  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading ............................................. 7-29  
Using the 2WD/i-AWD (intelligent All Wheel Drive)  
Switch ................................................................................... 3-16  
Using the Transaxle............................................................. 3-10  
V
Vehicle Cleaning.................................................................... 9-3  
Vehicle Identification Number ............................................ 10-1  
Vehicle Loading ............................................................ 6-1, 7-33  
Vehicle With Keyless Start System...................................... 3-4  
Vehicle Without Keyless Start System ................................ 3-3  
W
Warning and Indicator Lights............................................. 2-60  
Warranties ............................................................................ 10-2  
Washing.................................................................................. 9-4  
Waxing.................................................................................... 9-5  
Windows............................................................................... 2-17  
Windshield Washer.............................................................. 2-79  
Windshield Washer Fluid.................................................... 7-50  
13-5  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
INDEX  
MEMO  
13-6  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Prepared by  
June, 2009  
Part No. 99011-80J23-03E  
Printed in Japan  
TP294  
80J23-03E  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Sony Camcorder XC 555 555P User Manual
Sony Cell Phone ST26a User Manual
Sony Computer Monitor LMD1510W User Manual
Sony CRT Television KD 27FS170 KD 32FS170 KD 36FS170 User Manual
Sony DVR ICD P520 User Manual
Sony Portable CD Player WM EX570 User Manual
Sterilite Baby Accessories S12Q User Manual
Stiga Snow Blower 8218 2218 70 User Manual
Tanaka Trimmer TED 270PFL PFLS User Manual
TANDBERG Network Router D13187 03 User Manual